SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Amendment No. 1
American Reprographics Company
Delaware
|
7334 | 20-1700361 | ||
(State or other jurisdiction of | (Primary Standard Industrial | (I.R.S. Employer | ||
incorporation or organization) | Classification Code Number) | Identification Number) |
700 North Central Avenue, Suite 550
Sathiyamurthy Chandramohan
Teresa V. Pahl
|
Brett E. Cooper | Frank H. Golay, Jr. | ||
Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus,
|
Orrick, Herrington & Sutcliffe LLP | Sullivan & Cromwell LLP | ||
Vlahos & Rudy, LLP
|
The Orrick Building | 1888 Century Park East | ||
333 Market Street, Suite 2100
|
405 Howard Street | Los Angeles, California 90067 | ||
San Francisco, California 94105
|
San Francisco, California 94105 | (310) 712-6600 | ||
(415) 777-3200
|
(415) 773-5700 |
Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act, check the following box. o
If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering. o
If delivery
of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to
Rule 434, please check the following
box.
o
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
The
registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such
date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date
until the registrant shall file a further amendment which
specifically states that this Registration Statement shall
thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a)
of the Securities Act of 1933 or until this Registration
Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission,
acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Amount of
Title of Each Class of
Offering
Registration
Securities to be Registered
Price(1)(2)
Fee
$230,000,000
$29,141(3)
(1)
Includes shares to be sold upon exercise of the
underwriters over-allotment option.
(2)
Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating
the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(o) under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
(3)
Previously paid.
The information in this
preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. These
securities may not be sold until the registration statement
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective.
This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it
seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where
the offer or sale is not permitted.
Subject to Completion. Dated December 6, 2004.
Shares
This is an initial public offering of shares of common stock of American Reprographics Company (ARC).
ARC is offering of the shares to be sold in the offering. The selling stockholders identified in this prospectus are offering an additional shares. ARC will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of the shares being sold by the selling stockholders.
Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the common stock. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price will be between $ and $ per share. ARC intends to list the common stock on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol ARP.
See Risk Factors beginning on page 11 to read about factors you should consider before buying shares of the common stock.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any other regulatory body has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
Per Share | Total | |||||||
|
|
|||||||
Initial public offering price
|
$ | $ | ||||||
Underwriting discount
|
$ | $ | ||||||
Proceeds, before expenses, to ARC
|
$ | $ | ||||||
Proceeds, before expenses, to the selling
stockholders
|
$ | $ |
To the extent the underwriters sell more than shares of common stock, the underwriters have the option to purchase up to an additional shares of common stock from the selling stockholders at the initial public offering price less the underwriting discount.
The underwriters expect to deliver the shares against payment in New York, New York on .
Goldman, Sachs & Co. | JPMorgan |
Robert W. Baird & Co. | CIBC World Markets |
Prospectus dated .
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
This summary highlights only selected information contained elsewhere in this prospectus and does not contain all of the information you should consider before investing in our common stock. You should read this entire prospectus carefully, including Risk Factors, Forward-Looking Statements, and the consolidated financial statements and related notes.
Our Company
We are the leading reprographics company in the United States providing business-to-business document management services to the architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry. We also provide these services to companies in non-AEC industries, such as technology, financial services, retail, entertainment, and food and hospitality that also require sophisticated document management services. We provide our core services through our suite of reprographics technology products, a network of 174 locally branded reprographics service centers in 133 cities, and more than 1,560 facilities management programs at our customers locations throughout the country. Our service centers are arranged in a hub and satellite structure and are digitally connected as a cohesive network, allowing us to provide our services both locally and nationally. We service more than 65,000 active customers and employ over 3,450 people, including a sales force of approximately 270 employees. In terms of revenue, number of service facilities and number of customers, we believe we are the largest company in our industry, operating in more than eight times as many cities and with more than five times the number of service facilities as our next largest competitor.
Reprographics services typically encompass the management and reproduction of construction documents or other graphics-related material and the corresponding finishing and distribution services. We provide these business-to-business services to our customers in three major categories: document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand . We also sell reprographics equipment and supplies to complement these offerings. We also serve other independent reprographers by licensing our suite of reprographics technology products, including our flagship internet-based application, PlanWell. In addition, we operate PEiR (Profit and Education in Reprographics), a privately held trade organization through which we charge membership fees and provide purchasing, technology and educational benefits to other reprographers, while promoting our reprographics technology as the industry standard.
For the year ended December 31, 2003, our net sales were $416.0 million, our income from operations was $62.5 million, and our net income was $4.9 million. For the nine months ended September 30, 2004, our net sales were $336.3 million, our income from operations was $58.4 million, and our net income was $27.4 million. Based on our year to date net sales, we believe that the AEC market accounted for approximately 80% of our net sales, with the remaining 20% consisting of sales to non-AEC markets.
Industry Overview
According to the International Reprographics Association, or IRgA, and other industry sources, the reprographics industry in the United States is estimated to be approximately $5 billion in size. The IRgA indicates that the reprographics industry is highly fragmented, consisting of approximately 3,000 firms with average annual sales of approximately $1.5 million and 20 to 25 employees. Since construction documents are the primary medium of communication for the AEC industry, demand for reprographics services in the AEC market is closely tied to the level of activity in the construction industry, which in turn is driven by macroeconomic trends such as GDP growth, interest rates, job creation, office vacancy rates, and tax revenues. According to FMI Corporation, or FMI, a consulting firm to the construction industry, construction industry spending in the United States for 2004 is estimated at $975 billion, with expenditures divided between residential construction (55%) and
1
Market opportunities for business-to-business document management services such as ours are rapidly expanding into non-AEC industries. For example, non-AEC customers are increasingly using large and small format color imaging for point-of-purchase displays, digital publishing, presentation materials, educational materials and marketing materials as these services have become more efficient and available on a short-run, on-demand basis through digital technology. As a result, we believe that our addressable market is substantially larger than the core AEC reprographics market. We believe that the growth of non-AEC industries is generally tied to growth in the U.S. gross domestic product, or GDP, which is projected to grow 4.3% in 2004 and 3.6% in 2005 according to Wall Streets consensus estimates.
Our Competitive Strengths
We believe that our growth will be driven by our competitive strengths, which include the following:
| Leading Market Position in Fragmented Industry. Our size and national footprint provide us with significant purchasing power, economies of scale, the ability to invest in industry leading technologies, and the resources to service large, national customers. |
| Leader in Technology and Innovation. We believe our PlanWell online planrooms are well positioned to become the industry standard for managing and procuring reprographics services within the AEC industry. In addition, we have developed other proprietary software applications that complement PlanWell and have enabled us to improve the efficiency of our services, add complementary services and increase our revenue. |
| Extensive National Footprint with Regional Expertise. Our national network of service centers maintains local customer relationships while benefiting from our centralized corporate functions and national scale. Our service facilities are organized as hub and satellite structures within individual markets, allowing us to balance production capacity and minimize capital expenditures through technology sharing among our service centers within each market. In addition, we serve our national and regional customers under a single contract through our Premier Accounts business unit, while offering centralized access to project specific services, billing, and tracking information. |
| Flexible Operating Model. By promoting regional decision making for marketing, pricing, and selling practices, we remain responsive to our customers while benefiting from the cost structure advantages of our centralized administrative functions. Our flexible operating model also allows us to capitalize on an improving business environment. |
| Consistent, Strong Cash Flow. Through management of our inventory and receivables and our low capital expenditure requirements, we have consistently generated strong cash flow from operations after capital expenditures regardless of industry and economic conditions. |
| Low Cost Operator. We believe we are one of the lowest cost operators in the reprographics industry, which we have accomplished by minimizing branch level expenses and capitalizing on our significant scale for purchasing efficiencies. |
| Experienced Management Team and Highly Trained Workforce. Our senior management team has an average of over 20 years of industry experience. We have also successfully retained approximately 93% of the managers of the 81 businesses we have acquired since 1997. |
2
Our Business Strategy
Our objective is to continue to strengthen our competitive position as the preferred provider of business-to-business document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services . Our key strategies to accomplish this objective include:
| Continue to Increase Our Market Penetration and Expand Our Nationwide Footprint. We intend to increase our existing presence in key U.S. markets while expanding into under-penetrated regions through our facilities management contracts, targeted branch openings, strategic acquisitions, and national accounts. |
Õ | Facilities Management Contracts. We expect to capitalize on the continued trend of our customers to outsource their document management services, including their in-house operations, thus building our base of recurring revenue while increasing our presence in local markets. | |
Õ | Targeted Branch Openings. We seek to expand our geographic coverage, capture new customers and increase our market share by opening additional satellite branches at relatively low cost in regions near our established operations. | |
Õ | Strategic Acquisitions. Because our industry consists primarily of small, privately-held companies that serve only local markets, we believe that we can continue to grow our business by successfully acquiring additional reprographics companies at reasonable prices. | |
Õ | National Accounts. We will continue to pursue large customers that operate on regional and national levels through our Premier Accounts business unit, which offers a comprehensive suite of local reprographics services and centralized administrative functions to regional and national companies through our national network of reprographics service centers. | |
| Promote PlanWell as the Industry Standard for Procuring Reprographics Services Online. Through continuing sales efforts and product enhancements, we plan to increase the market penetration of PlanWell and create a standardized, internet-based portal to manage, store, and retrieve documents. In order to achieve greater market share and build industry standardization, we will continue to license our PlanWell technology to other reprographics companies, including members of PEiR. |
| Expand Our Non-AEC and Ancillary Product and Service Offerings. By leveraging advances in digital production equipment and our expertise in providing highly customized, quick-turn services to the AEC industry, we will continue to actively pursue customers from non-AEC industries that require rapid production of educational and training materials, short-run publishing materials, and marketing materials. |
In addition to expanding our non-AEC revenues, we continue to focus on creating new value-added services beyond traditional reprographics to offer all of our customers. We are actively engaged in services such as bid facilitation, print network management for offices and on-site production facilities, and on-demand color publishing. We seek to capitalize on our technological innovation to enhance our existing services and to create new reprographics technologies.
Corporate Reorganization
Our predecessor, Ford Graphics, was founded in Los Angeles, California in 1960. We are currently organized as American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., a California limited liability company, or Holdings. We conduct our operations through our wholly-owned operating subsidiary, American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., a California limited liability company, or Opco, and its subsidiaries. Immediately prior to the closing of this offering, we will be reorganized as a Delaware corporation, American Reprographics Company. In this prospectus, unless the context indicates
3
Our principal executive offices are located at 700 North Central Avenue, Suite 550, Glendale, California 91203 and our telephone number at that address is (818) 500-0225. Our website address is www.e-arc.com. The information found on our website, however, is not a part of this prospectus.
4
The Offering
Unless otherwise noted, the information in this
prospectus, including the information above:
5
Common stock offered by us
shares
Common stock offered by the selling stockholders
shares
Total common stock offered
shares
( % of common stock to
be outstanding after this offering)
Common stock to be outstanding after this offering
shares
Use of proceeds
We expect to use approximately $27.3 million
of the net proceeds from this offering to repurchase our
preferred equity (including accrued interest); approximately
$49.9 million to repay a portion of our senior second
priority secured term loan facility; and the balance of
approximately $27.3 million to repay a portion of our
senior first priority secured term loan facility. We will not
receive any proceeds from the sale of shares by the selling
stockholders.
Dividend policy
We do not anticipate paying any dividends on our
common stock in the foreseeable future.
Proposed New York Stock Exchange symbol
ARP
assumes our conversion from a California limited
liability company to a Delaware corporation, which will occur
before the closing of this offering;
assumes 35,487,511 shares of common stock
outstanding at September 30, 2004;
excludes shares
of common stock subject to outstanding options at
September 30, 2004 issued at a weighted average exercise
price of $5.22 per share;
excludes 22,500 shares of common stock
issued upon option exercises since September 30, 2004;
excludes 5,000,000 shares of common stock
reserved for future issuance under our 2005 Stock Plan, and
750,000 shares of common stock reserved for future issuance
under our 2005 Employee Stock Purchase Plan;
excludes 1,168,842 shares of common stock
issuable upon the exercise of outstanding warrants at
September 30, 2004 issued at an exercise price of
$4.61 per share; and
assumes no exercise of the underwriters
option to purchase additional shares.
Summary Historical and Unaudited Pro Forma
Financial Data
The summary historical and unaudited pro forma
financial data presented below are derived from the audited
financial statements of Holdings for the fiscal years ended
December 31, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, and 2003, and the
unaudited financial statements of Holdings for the nine-month
periods ended September 30, 2003 and 2004. The summary
historical financial data for the nine-month periods ended
September 30, 2003 and 2004 are derived from unaudited
interim financial statements which, in the opinion of
management, include all normal, recurring adjustments necessary
to state fairly the data included therein in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles, or GAAP, for interim
financial information, except for pro forma data. Interim
results are not necessarily indicative of the results to be
expected for the entire fiscal year. The unaudited pro forma
financial data set forth below give effect to our conversion to
a Delaware corporation and the completion of this offering, as
described in Use of Proceeds. The unaudited pro
forma financial data are not necessarily indicative of our
financial position or results of operations that might have
occurred had the transactions they give effect to been completed
as of the dates indicated and do not purport to represent what
our financial position or results of operations might be for any
future period or date. For additional information see
Capitalization, Selected Historical and
Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Data,
Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations, and our audited
financial statements and unaudited financial statements included
elsewhere in this prospectus.
6
7
8
The following is a reconciliation of cash flows
provided by operating activities to EBIT, EBITDA, and pro forma
net income:
The following is a reconciliation of net income
to EBITDA and to adjusted EBITDA:
9
The following is a reconciliation of our net
income margin to Adjusted EBIT margin and Adjusted EBITDA margin:
10
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(Dollars in thousands)
$
198,774
$
287,995
$
338,124
$
324,402
$
315,995
$
242,507
$
253,367
14,745
24,624
39,875
52,290
59,311
42,719
53,736
10,317
38,480
42,702
42,232
40,654
31,112
29,195
223,836
351,099
420,701
418,924
415,960
316,338
336,298
134,531
201,390
243,710
247,778
252,028
190,266
196,668
89,305
149,709
176,991
171,146
163,932
126,072
139,630
53,730
85,371
102,576
101,805
101,252
76,127
81,167
2,823
3,966
5,731
218
131
99
69
20,544
4,000
1,428
1,500
3,438
32,752
35,828
63,818
67,623
62,549
49,846
58,394
638
713
304
541
1,024
1,080
574
(9,215
)
(29,238
)
(47,530
)
(39,917
)
(39,390
)
(28,958
)
(24,506
)
(1,195
)
(14,921
)
24,175
6,108
16,592
28,247
9,262
21,968
34,462
4,068
4,784
5,802
6,304
4,321
4,417
7,076
20,107
1,324
10,790
21,943
4,941
17,551
27,386
(2,158
)
(3,107
)
(3,291
)
(1,730
)
(1,730
)
20,107
(834
)
7,683
18,652
3,211
15,821
27,386
5,304
2,618
2,622
6,275
1,407
5,568
8,375
$
14,803
$
(3,452
)
$
5,061
$
12,377
$
1,804
$
10,253
$
19,011
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(In thousands, except per unit amounts)
$
0.82
$
(0.02
)
$
0.21
$
0.51
$
0.09
$
0.45
$
0.77
$
0.82
$
(0.02
)
$
0.21
$
0.51
$
0.09
$
0.42
$
0.73
$
0.60
$
(0.10
)
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.29
$
0.54
$
0.60
$
(0.10
)
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.27
$
0.51
24,571
35,308
36,629
36,406
35,480
35,478
35,488
24,571
35,371
36,758
36,723
37,298
37,307
37,489
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(Dollars in thousands)
$
33,390
$
35,346
$
64,122
$
68,164
$
48,652
$
50,926
$
58,968
$
42,932
$
50,288
$
89,494
$
86,062
$
67,011
$
64,975
$
72,109
$
42,932
$
72,027
$
89,494
$
86,062
$
81,932
$
64,975
$
72,109
14.9
%
16.3
%
15.2
%
16.3
%
15.3
%
16.1
%
17.5
%
19.2
%
20.5
%
21.3
%
20.5
%
19.7
%
20.5
%
21.4
%
$
9,542
$
14,942
$
25,372
$
17,898
$
18,359
$
14,049
$
13,141
$
3,877
$
5,228
$
8,659
$
5,209
$
4,992
$
3,348
$
4,772
$
9,215
$
29,238
$
47,530
$
39,917
$
39,390
$
28,958
$
24,506
As of September 30,
2004,
Pro
As of December 31,
Forma
As
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
Actual
Adjusted(4)
(Unaudited)
(Dollars in thousands)
$
15,814
$
31,565
$
29,110
$
24,995
$
17,315
$
12,008
$
910
$
204,464
$
358,026
$
371,948
$
395,677
$
376,843
$
381,209
$
368,482
$
123,951
$
359,746
$
371,515
$
378,102
$
360,008
$
347,700
$
243,634
$
32,422
$
(80,478
)
$
(78,900
)
$
(59,784
)
$
(57,329
)
$
(33,861
)
$
73,370
$
15,379
$
34,742
$
24,338
$
24,371
$
16,809
$
28,333
$
17,235
(1)
Until our reorganization, which will be effective
prior to the closing of this offering, a substantial portion of
our business will continue to operate as a limited liability
company, or LLC, and taxed as a partnership. As a result, the
members of the LLC pay the income taxes on the earnings. The
unaudited pro forma incremental income tax provision amounts
reflected in the table above were calculated as if our
reorganization became effective on January 1, 1999.
(2)
Non-GAAP Measures.
EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related
ratios presented in this prospectus) are supplemental measures
of our performance that are not required by, or presented in
accordance with GAAP. These measures are not measurements of our
financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as
alternatives to net income, income from operations, or any other
performance measures derived in accordance with GAAP or as an
alternative to cash flow from operating, investing or financing
activities as a measure of liquidity.
EBIT is a non-GAAP measure that represents
earnings before interest expense and income taxes. EBITDA is a
non-GAAP measure that represents earnings before interest
expense, income taxes, depreciation, and amortization. Adjusted
EBITDA represents EBITDA adjusted to exclude the impact of costs
incurred in connection with our recapitalization in 2000 and
loss on early extinguishment of debt. Adjusted EBIT margin is a
non-GAAP measure that is calculated by subtracting depreciation
and amortization from adjusted EBITDA and dividing the result by
net sales. Adjusted EBITDA margin is a non-GAAP measure that is
calculated by dividing adjusted EBITDA by net sales.
We calculate Adjusted EBITDA by adjusting EBITDA
to eliminate the impact of a number of items we do not consider
indicative of our ongoing operations and for the other reasons
noted below. You are encouraged to evaluate each adjustment and
whether you consider it appropriate. In addition, in evaluating
Adjusted EBITDA, you should be aware that in the future we may
incur expenses similar to the adjustments in the presentation of
Adjusted EBITDA. Our presentation of Adjusted EBITDA should not
be construed as an inference that our future results will be
unaffected by unusual or non-recurring items.
We present EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and
related ratios presented in this prospectus) because we consider
them important supplemental measures of our performance and
liquidity and believe that such measures are meaningful to
investors for the reasons discussed below.
We use EBIT as a metric to measure and compare
the performance of our divisions. We operate our
42 divisions as separate business units, but manage debt
and taxation at the corporate level. As a result, EBIT is the
best measure of divisional profitability and the most useful
metric by which to measure and compare the performance of our
divisions. We also use EBIT as a metric to measure performance
for the purpose of determining compensation at the division
level and use EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to measure performance
and determine compensation at the consolidated level. We also
use EBITDA as a metric to manage cash flow from our divisions to
the corporate level and to determine the financial health of
each division. As noted above, because our divisions do not
incur interest or income tax expense, the cash flow from each
division should be equal to the corresponding EBITDA of each
division, assuming no other changes to a divisions balance
sheet. As a result, we reconcile EBITDA to cash flow on a
monthly basis as one of our key internal controls. We also use
EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to evaluate potential
acquisitions and to evaluate whether to incur capital
expenditures. In addition, certain covenants in our credit
agreements require compliance with financial ratios based on
Adjusted EBITDA (as defined in our credit agreements).
EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related
ratios presented in this prospectus) have limitations as
analytical tools, and you should not consider them in isolation,
or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under
GAAP. Because of these limitations, EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted
EBITDA should not be considered as measures of discretionary
cash available to us to invest in the growth of our business or
reduce our indebtedness. We compensate for these limitations by
relying primarily on our GAAP results and using EBIT, EBITDA and
Adjusted EBITDA only supplementally. For more information, see
our consolidated financial statements and related notes included
elsewhere in this prospectus.
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(Dollars in thousands)
$
28,569
$
28,054
$
53,151
$
56,413
$
48,237
$
46,909
$
42,579
712
632
2,399
4,040
(1,102
)
(3,878
)
3,299
(9,174
)
(27,362
)
(44,760
)
(30,430
)
(42,194
)
(25,480
)
(18,492
)
4,068
4,784
5,802
6,304
4,321
4,417
7,076
9,215
29,238
47,530
39,917
39,390
28,958
24,506
33,390
35,346
64,122
68,164
48,652
50,926
58,968
9,542
14,942
25,372
17,898
18,359
14,049
13,141
42,932
50,288
89,494
86,062
67,011
64,975
72,109
(9,215
)
(29,238
)
(47,530
)
(39,917
)
(39,390
)
(28,958
)
(24,506
)
(9,372
)
(7,402
)
(8,424
)
(12,579
)
(5,728
)
(9,985
)
(15,451
)
(9,542
)
(14,942
)
(25,372
)
(17,898
)
(18,359
)
(14,049
)
(13,141
)
(2,158
)
(3,107
)
(3,291
)
(1,730
)
(1,730
)
$
14,803
$
(3,452
)
$
5,061
$
12,377
$
1,804
$
10,253
$
19,011
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(Dollars in thousands)
$
20,107
$
1,324
$
10,790
$
21,943
$
4,941
$
17,551
$
27,386
9,215
29,238
47,530
39,917
39,390
28,958
24,506
4,068
4,784
5,802
6,304
4,321
4,417
7,076
9,542
14,942
25,372
17,898
18,359
14,049
13,141
42,932
50,288
89,494
86,062
67,011
64,975
72,109
20,544
1,195
14,921
$
42,932
$
72,027
$
89,494
$
86,062
$
81,932
$
64,975
$
72,109
Nine Months
Ended
Fiscal Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
9.0%
0.4%
2.6%
5.2%
1.2%
5.5%
8.1%
4.1%
8.3%
11.3%
9.5%
9.5%
9.2%
7.3%
1.8%
1.4%
1.4%
1.5%
1.0%
1.4%
2.1%
5.9%
0.3%
3.6%
14.9%
16.3%
15.2%
16.3%
15.3%
16.1%
17.5%
4.3%
4.3%
6.0%
4.3%
4.4%
4.4%
3.9%
19.2%
20.5%
21.3%
20.5%
19.7%
20.5%
21.4%
(3)
Depreciation and amortization includes a
write-off of intangible assets of $3.4 million for the year
ended December 31, 2001.
(4)
Prepared on the same basis as the capitalization
table. See Capitalization.
(5)
In July 2003, we adopted
SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial
Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and
Equity. In accordance with SFAS No. 150, the
redeemable preferred equity of Holdings has been reclassified in
our financial statements as a component of our total debt upon
our adoption of this new standard. The redeemable preferred
equity amounted to $25.8 million as of December 31,
2003 and $27.3 million as of September 30, 2004.
SFAS No. 150 does not permit the restatement of
financial statements for periods prior to the adoption of this
standard.
(6)
Redeemable common membership units amounted to
$6.0 million and $8.1 million at December 31,
2000 and 2001, respectively.
(7)
The decline in total members equity
(deficit) from December 31, 1999 to December 31, 2000
was a result of an $88.8 million cash distribution to
Holdings common unit holders in connection with the 2000
recapitalization and the reclassification of $20.3 million
of preferred equity issued in connection with the 2000
recapitalization upon the adoption of SFAS No. 150 in
July 2003.
RISK FACTORS
Investing in our common stock involves a number of risks. You should carefully consider all of the information contained in this prospectus, including the risk factors set forth below, before investing in the common stock offered pursuant to this prospectus. We may encounter risks in addition to those described below. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial may also impair or adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. In such case, you may lose all or part of your original investment.
Risks Related to Our Business
Future downturns in the architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry, could diminish demand for our products and services, which would impair our future revenue and profitability.
We believe that AEC markets accounted for approximately 80% of our year to date net sales. Our historical operating results reflect the cyclical and variable nature of the AEC industry. This industry historically experiences alternating periods of inadequate supplies of housing, commercial and industrial space coupled with low vacancies, causing a surge in construction activity and increased demand for reprographics services, followed by periods of oversupply and high vacancies and declining demand for reprographics services. In addition, existing and future government policies and programs may greatly influence the level of construction spending in the public sector, such as highways, schools, hospitals, sewers, and heavy construction. Since we derive a majority of our revenues from reprographics products and services provided to the AEC industry, our operating results are more sensitive to the nature of this industry than other companies who serve more diversified markets. Our experience has shown that the AEC industry generally experiences economic downturns six months after a downturn in the general economy. We expect that there may be a similar delay in the rebound of the AEC industry following a rebound in the general economy. Future economic and industry downturns may be characterized by diminished demand for our products and services and, therefore, any continued weakness in our customers markets and overall global economic conditions could adversely affect our future revenue and profitability.
In addition, because approximately 60% of our overall costs are fixed, changes in economic activity, positive or negative, affect our results of operations. As a result, our results of operations are subject to volatility and could deteriorate rapidly in an environment of declining revenues. Failure to maintain adequate cash reserves and effectively manage our costs could adversely affect our ability to offset our fixed costs and may have an adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
Competition in our industry and innovation by our competitors may hinder our ability to execute our business strategy and maintain our profitability.
The markets for our products and services are highly competitive, with competition primarily at a local and regional level. We compete primarily based on customer service, technological leadership, product performance and price. Our future success depends, in part, on our ability to continue to improve our service offerings, and develop and integrate technological advances. If we are unable to integrate technological advances into our service offerings to successfully meet the evolving needs of our customers in a timely manner, our operating results may be adversely affected. Technological innovation by our existing or future competitors could put us at a competitive disadvantage. In particular, our business could be adversely affected if any of our competitors develop or acquire superior technology that competes directly with or offers greater functionality than our technology, including PlanWell.
We also face the possibility that competition will continue to increase, particularly if copy and printing or business services companies choose to expand into the reprographics services industry.
11
The reprographics industry has undergone vast changes in the last six years and will continue to evolve, and our failure to anticipate and adapt to future changes in our industry could harm our competitive position.
In the past six years, the reprographics industry has undergone vast changes. The industrys main production technology has migrated from analog to digital. This has prompted a number of trends in the reprographics industry, including a rapid shift toward decentralized production and lower labor utilization. As digital output devices become smaller, less expensive, easier to use and interconnected, end users of construction drawings are placing these devices within their offices and other locations. On-site reprographics equipment allows a customer to print documents and review hard copies without the delays or interruptions associated with sending documents out for duplication. Also, as a direct result of advancements in digital technology, labor demands have decreased. Instead of producing one print at a time, reprographers now have the capability to produce multiple sets of documents with a single production employee. By linking output devices through a single print server, a production employee simply directs output to the device that is best suited for the job. As a result of these trends, reprographers have had to modify their operations to decentralize printing and shift costs from labor to technology.
Looking forward, we expect the reprographics industry to continue to evolve. Our industry will continue to embrace digital technology, not only in terms of production services, but also in terms of network technology, digital document storage and management, and information distribution, all of which will require investment in, and continued development of, technological innovation. If we fail to keep pace with current changes or fail to anticipate or adapt to future changes in our industry, our competitive position could be harmed.
If we fail to continue to develop and introduce new services successfully, our competitive positioning and our ability to grow our business could be harmed.
In order to remain competitive, we must continually invest in new technologies that will enable us to meet the evolving demands of our customers. We cannot assure you that we will be successful in the introduction and marketing of any new services, or that we will develop and introduce in a timely manner innovative services that satisfy customer needs or achieve market acceptance. Our failure to develop new services and introduce them successfully could harm our competitive position and our ability to grow our business, and our revenues and operating results could suffer.
In addition, as reprographics technologies continue to be developed, one or more of our current service offerings may become obsolete. In particular, digital technologies may significantly reduce the need for high volume printing. Digital technology may also make traditional reprographics equipment smaller and cheaper, which may cause larger AEC customers to discontinue outsourcing their reprographics needs. Any such developments could adversely affect our business and impair future revenue and profitability.
12
If we are unable to charge for our value-added services to offset potential declines in print volumes, our long term revenue could decline.
Our customers value the ability to view and order prints via the internet and print to output devices in their own offices and other locations throughout the country. In 2003, our reprographics services represented approximately 76% and our facilities management services represented approximately 14% of our total net sales, and both categories of revenue are generally derived via a charge per square foot of printed material. Future technological advances may further facilitate and improve our customers ability to print in their own offices or at a job site. As technology continues to improve, this trend toward consuming information on an as needed basis could result in decreasing printing volumes and declining revenues in the longer term. Failure to offset these potential declines in printing volumes by changing how we charge for our services and developing additional revenue sources could significantly affect our business and reduce our long term revenue, resulting in an adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
We derive a significant percentage of net sales from within the State of California and our business could be disproportionately harmed by an economic downturn or natural disaster affecting California.
We derived approximately half of our net sales in 2003, and in the nine months ended September 30, 2004, from our operations in California. As a result, we are dependent to a large extent upon the AEC industry in California and, accordingly, are sensitive to economic factors affecting California, including general and local economic conditions, macroeconomic trends, and natural disasters. Any adverse developments affecting California could have a disproportionately negative effect on our revenue, operating results and cash flows.
Our growth strategy depends in part on our ability to successfully identify and manage our acquisitions and branch openings. Failure to do so could impede our future growth and adversely affect our competitive position.
As part of our growth strategy, we intend to prudently pursue strategic acquisitions within the reprographics industry. Since 1997, we have acquired 81 businesses, most of which were long established in the communities in which they conduct their business. Our efforts to execute our acquisition strategy may be affected by our ability to continue to identify, negotiate, integrate, and close acquisitions. In addition, any governmental review or investigation of our proposed acquisitions, such as by the Federal Trade Commission, or FTC, may impede, limit or prevent us from proceeding with an acquisition. For example, our acquisition of Consolidated Reprographics in 2001, was investigated by the FTC. This investigation has since been concluded without any action being taken against us. We regularly evaluate potential acquisitions, although we currently have no agreements or active negotiations with respect to any material acquisitions.
Acquisitions involve a number of special risks. There may be difficulties integrating acquired personnel and distinct business cultures. Additional financing may be necessary and, if available, could increase our leverage, dilute our equity, or both. Acquisitions may divert managements time and our resources from existing operations. It is possible that there could be a negative effect on our financial statements from the impairment related to goodwill and other intangibles. We may experience the loss of key employees or customers of acquired companies. In addition, risks may include high transaction costs and expenses of integrating acquired companies, as well as exposure to unforeseen liabilities of acquired companies and failure of the acquired business to achieve expected results. These risks could hinder our future growth and adversely affect our competitive position and operating results.
In addition, we have recently begun to expand our geographic coverage by opening additional satellite branches in regions near our established operations to capture new customers and greater market share. Since September 2003, we have opened 17 new branches in areas that expand or
13
If we are unable to successfully monitor and manage the business operations of our subsidiaries, our business and profitability could suffer.
We operate our company under a dual operating structure of centralized administrative functions and regional decision making on marketing, pricing, and selling practices. Since 1997, we have acquired 81 businesses and, in most cases, have delegated the responsibility for marketing, pricing, and selling practices with the local and operational managers of these businesses. If we do not successfully manage our subsidiaries under this decentralized operating structure, we risk having disparate results, lost market opportunities, lack of economic synergies, and a loss of vision and planning, all of which could harm our business and profitability.
In August 2003, we restated our financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002 to correct accounting misstatements at one of our subsidiaries during 2001 due to fraud by certain managers at the subsidiary. The accounting misstatements at the subsidiary resulted in the overstatement of net income in 2001 by $1,461,000. In response to these accounting misstatements, we have strengthened our financial and management policies and procedures, established an internal audit group, and improved our accounting controls. However, we cannot assure that these new internal controls will be effective in preventing similar fraud in the future.
We depend on certain key vendors for reprographics equipment, maintenance services and supplies, making us vulnerable to supply shortages and price fluctuations.
We purchase reprographics equipment and maintenance services, as well as paper, toner and other supplies, from a limited number of vendors. Our four largest vendors, which supplied approximately 35% of our reprographics equipment, maintenance services, and production supplies in 2003, are Océ N.V., Xerox Corporation, Canon Inc., and Xpedx, a division of International Paper Company. Adverse developments concerning key vendors or our relationships with them could force us to seek alternate sources for our reprographics equipment, maintenance services and supplies or to purchase such items on unfavorable terms. An alternative source of supply of reprographics equipment, maintenance services and supplies may not be readily available. A delay in procuring reprographics equipment, maintenance services or supplies, or an increase in the cost to purchase such reprographics equipment, maintenance services or supplies could limit our ability to provide services to our customers on a timely and cost-effective basis.
Our failure to adequately protect the proprietary aspects of our technology, including PlanWell, may cause us to lose market share.
Our success depends on our ability to protect and preserve the proprietary aspects of our technologies, including PlanWell. We rely on a combination of copyright and trademark protection, confidentiality agreements, non-compete agreements, reseller agreements, customer contracts, and technical measures to establish and protect our rights in our proprietary technologies. Under our PlanWell license agreements, we grant other reprographers a non-exclusive, non-transferable, limited license to use our technology and receive our services. Our license agreements contain terms and conditions prohibiting the unauthorized reproduction or transfer of our products. These protections, however, may not be adequate to remedy harm we suffer due to misappropriation of our proprietary rights by third parties. In addition, U.S. law provides only limited protection of proprietary rights and the laws of some foreign countries may offer less protection than the laws of the United States. Unauthorized third parties may copy aspects of our products, reverse engineer our products or otherwise obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary. Others may develop non-infringing technologies that are similar or superior to ours. If competitors are able to develop such
14
We may be subject to intellectual property rights claims, which are costly to defend, could require us to pay damages and could limit our ability to use certain technologies in the future.
Other companies or individuals may pursue litigation against us with respect to intellectual property-based claims, including claims relating to the use of PlanWell and our other brands, trademarks, logos, technologies, trade secrets, and proprietary information. In the event of an adverse result in any litigation with respect to PlanWell and other intellectual property rights relevant to our business that could arise in the future, we could be required to obtain licenses to the infringing technology; begin using other brands, trademarks and logos; pay substantial damages under applicable law; or expend significant resources to develop non-infringing technology. There can be no assurance that suitable replacement technologies would be available to us on commercially reasonable terms. In addition, because we have a number of unregistered trademarks, we may be at greater risk of infringement by those who have pre-existing and superior rights in similar trademarks. Our insurance may not cover potential claims or may not be adequate to indemnify us for damages we incur. Also, litigation frequently involves substantial expenditures and can require significant management attention, even if we ultimately prevail.
Damage or disruption to our facilities, our technology centers, our vendors or a majority of our customers could impair our ability to effectively provide our services and may have a significant impact on our revenues, expenses and financial condition.
We currently store most of our customer data at our two technology centers located in Northern California near known earthquake fault zones. Damage or destruction of one or both of these technology centers or a disruption of our data storage processes resulting from sustained process abnormalities, human error, acts of terrorism, violence, war or a natural disaster, such as fire, earthquake or flood, could have a material adverse effect on the markets in which we operate, our business operations, our expectations and other forward-looking statements contained in this prospectus. In addition, such damage or destruction on a national scale resulting in a general economic downturn could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. We store and maintain critical customer data on computer servers at our technology centers that our customers access remotely through the internet and/or directly through telecommunications lines. If our back-up power generators fail during any power outage, if our telecommunications lines are severed or those lines on the internet are impaired for any reason, our remote access customers would be unable to access their critical data, causing an interruption in their operations. In such event, our remote access customers and their customers could seek to hold us responsible for any losses. We may also potentially lose these customers and our reputation could be harmed. In addition, such damage or destruction, particularly those that directly impact our technology centers or our vendors or customers could have an impact on our sales, supply chain, production capability, costs, and our ability to provide services to our customers.
Although we currently maintain general property damage insurance, we do not maintain insurance for loss from earthquakes, acts of terrorism or war. If we incur losses from uninsured events, we could incur significant expenses which would adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
15
If we lose key personnel or qualified technical staff, our ability to manage the day-to-day aspects of our business will be adversely affected.
We believe that the attraction and retention of qualified personnel is critical to our success. If we lose key personnel or are unable to recruit qualified personnel, our ability to manage the day-to-day aspects of our business will be adversely affected. Our operations and prospects depend in large part on the performance of our senior management team and the managers of our principal operating divisions. The loss of the services of one or more members of our senior management team, in particular, Mr. Chandramohan, our Chief Executive Officer, and Mr. Suriyakumar, our President and Chief Operating Officer, could disrupt our business and impede our ability to execute our business strategy. Because our executive and divisional management team has on average more than 20 years of experience within the reprographics industry, it would be difficult to replace them.
If we are required to write down our goodwill, our operations and stockholders equity would be adversely affected.
As described in the notes to our financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus, we have $246 million of goodwill recorded on our balance sheet as of September 30, 2004. Goodwill arises when we pay more for a business than the fair market value of the acquired tangible and separately measurable intangible net assets. Until January 1, 2002, we amortized this goodwill on a straight-line basis over 40 years. Under accounting rules that we adopted beginning January 1, 2002, we are no longer able to amortize goodwill on a yearly basis. Instead, we are required to periodically determine if our goodwill has become impaired, in which case we would be required to write off the impaired portion of goodwill. The amount of goodwill that we would write off in any given year is treated as a charge against earnings under generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. If we are required to write off our goodwill, we could incur significant charges against earnings, which would adversely affect our results of operations and stockholders equity.
We have substantial debt and have the ability to incur additional debt. The principal and interest payment obligations of such debt may restrict our future operations and adversely affect our business.
As of September 30, 2004, assuming that this offering and the application of the net proceeds from this offering as described under Use of Proceeds had been completed by that date, we would have had approximately $255 million of outstanding indebtedness. In addition, the credit agreements governing our credit facilities permit us to incur additional debt under certain circumstances.
The incurrence of substantial amounts of debt may make it more difficult for us to satisfy our financial obligations; require us to dedicate a substantial portion of any cash flow from operations to the payment of interest and principal due under our debt, which will reduce funds available for other business purposes; increase our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions; limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industries in which we operate; place us at a competitive disadvantage compared with some of our competitors that have less debt; and limit our ability to obtain additional financing required to fund working capital and capital expenditures and for other general corporate purposes.
Our ability to satisfy our obligations and to reduce our total debt depends on our future operating performance and on economic, financial, competitive and other factors, many of which are beyond our control. Our business may not generate sufficient cash flow, and future financings may not be available to provide sufficient net proceeds to meet these obligations or to successfully execute our business strategy.
16
The agreements governing our credit facilities impose restrictions on our business that may limit our business opportunities and hinder our ability to execute our business strategy.
The credit agreements for our senior secured credit facilities contain, and other agreements we may enter into in the future may contain, covenants imposing significant restrictions on our business. These restrictions may affect our ability to operate our business and may limit our ability to take advantage of potential business opportunities as they arise. These covenants place restrictions on our ability to, among other things, incur additional debt, create liens, make investments, enter into transactions with affiliates, sell assets, guarantee debt, declare or pay dividends, redeem common stock or make other distributions to stockholders, and consolidate or merge. See Description of Certain Indebtedness.
Our ability to comply with these covenants may be affected by events beyond our control, including prevailing economic, financial, and industry conditions. An event of default under our debt agreements would permit some of our lenders to declare all amounts borrowed from them to be due and payable, together with accrued and unpaid interest. If we were unable to repay debt to our senior lenders, these lenders could proceed against the collateral securing that debt.
Being a public company will increase our expenses and administrative workload.
As a public company, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur as a private company. In addition, our administrative staff will be required to perform additional tasks. For example, in anticipation of becoming a public company, we will have created or revised the roles and duties of our board committees, adopted additional internal controls and disclosure controls and procedures, retained a transfer agent and a financial printer, adopted an insider trading policy and will have all of the internal and external costs of preparing and distributing periodic public reports in compliance with our obligations under the securities laws. We also expect that being a public company and these new rules and regulations will make it more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to accept reduced coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain coverage. These factors could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified members of our board of directors, particularly to serve on our audit committee, and qualified executive officers.
If we fail to maintain an effective system of internal controls, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent fraud. As a result, our business could be harmed and current and potential stockholders could lose confidence in our company, which could cause our stock price to fall.
Changing laws, regulations and standards relating to corporate governance and public disclosure, including the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and related regulations implemented by the Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, and the New York Stock Exchange, or NYSE, are creating uncertainty for public companies, increasing legal and financial compliance costs and making some activities more time consuming. We will be evaluating our internal controls systems to allow management to report on, and our independent auditors to attest to, our internal controls. We will be performing the system and process evaluation and testing (and any necessary remediation) required to comply with the management certification and auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. As a result, we expect to incur substantial additional expenses and diversion of managements time. While we anticipate being able to fully implement the requirements relating to internal controls and all other aspects of Section 404 by our December 31, 2005 deadline, we cannot be certain as to the timing of completion of our evaluation, testing and remediation actions or the impact of the same on our operations since there is presently no precedent available by which to measure compliance adequacy. If we are not able to implement the requirements of Section 404 in a timely manner or with adequate compliance, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent fraud and might be subject to sanctions or
17
Our operations subject us to potential environmental liabilities that could increase our operating costs and harm our financial condition and results of operations.
Our printing operations are subject to numerous federal, state and local laws, and regulations relating to the environment. Such environmental regulations may affect us by restricting the use of certain products or regulating their disposal and regulatory or legislative changes may cause future increases in our operating costs or otherwise affect our operations. Although we believe we are and have been in substantial compliance with such regulations, there is no assurance that in the future we may not be adversely affected by such regulations or incur increased operating costs in complying with such regulations.
Our operations involve some use of hazardous substances and the generation of wastes, primarily toner, which could have adverse environmental impacts if released into the environment. Environmental regulations impose obligations on various entities to clean up contaminated properties or to pay for the cost of such remediation, often upon parties that did not actually cause the contamination. Accordingly, we may become liable, either contractually or by operation of law, for remediation costs even if a contaminated property is not presently owned or operated by us, or if the contamination was caused by third parties during or prior to our ownership or operation of the property. While we are not subject to any existing remediation obligations, future events, such as changes in existing laws or policies or their enforcement, or the discovery of currently unknown contamination, may give rise to future remediation liabilities that may be material.
Risks Related to Our Common Stock
Our stock price may be volatile, and you may not be able to resell your shares at or above the initial public offering price.
Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for shares of our common stock. An active public trading market for our common stock may not develop or, if it develops, may not be maintained after this offering, and the market price could fall below the initial public offering price. Factors such as quarterly variations in our financial results, announcements by us or others, developments affecting us, our customers and our suppliers, acquisition of products or businesses by us or our competitors, and general market volatility could cause the market price of our common stock to fluctuate significantly. As a result, you could lose all or part of your investment. Our company, the selling stockholders, and the representatives of the underwriters will negotiate to determine the initial public offering price. The initial public offering price may be higher than the trading price of our common stock following this offering.
Anti-takeover provisions in our charter documents and Delaware corporate law may make it difficult for our stockholders to replace or remove our current board of directors and could deter an unsolicited third party acquisition offer, which may adversely affect the marketability and market price of our common stock.
Provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws and in Delaware corporate law will make it difficult for stockholders to change the composition of our board of directors, which consequently will make it difficult to change the composition of management. In addition, these provisions may make it difficult and expensive for a third party to pursue a tender offer, change in control or takeover attempt that is opposed by our management and board of directors. Public stockholders who might desire to participate in this type of transaction may not have an opportunity to do so. These anti-takeover provisions could substantially impede the ability of public stockholders to benefit from a change in control or change
18
Our board of directors can issue preferred stock without stockholder approval of the terms of such stock.
Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will authorize our board of directors, without stockholder approval, to issue up to 25,000,000 shares of preferred stock in one or more series and to fix the rights, preferences, privileges, and restrictions granted to or imposed upon the preferred stock, including voting rights, dividend rights, conversion rights, terms of redemption, liquidation preference, sinking fund terms, subscription rights, and the number of shares constituting any series or the designation of a series. Our board of directors will be able to issue preferred stock with voting and conversion rights that could adversely affect the voting power of the holders of common stock, without stockholder approval. At the completion of this offering, no shares of preferred stock will be outstanding and we have no present plan to issue any shares of preferred stock.
Shares available for sale and future stock sales could decrease the market price of our stock.
Sales of shares of our common stock in the public market following this offering, or the perception that sales may occur, could depress the market price of our common stock. After this offering, we will have shares of common stock outstanding. The number of shares of common stock available for sale in the public market is temporarily limited by restrictions under federal securities law and under lock-up agreements that our directors, executive officers, the selling stockholders, and the holders of substantially all other shares of our common stock have entered into with the underwriters. Those lock-up agreements restrict these persons from disposing of or hedging their shares or securities convertible into or exchangeable for their shares until 180 days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of Goldman, Sachs & Co. and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. However, Goldman, Sachs & Co. and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. may release all or any portion of the shares from the restrictions of the lock-up agreements. All of the shares sold in this offering will be freely tradable without restrictions or further registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act, except for any shares purchased by our affiliates (as defined in Rule 144 of the Securities Act). The remaining shares outstanding after this offering will be available for sale into the public market after the expiration of the initial 180-day lock-up period, except for any shares purchased by our affiliates (as defined in Rule 144 of the Securities Act). Additional shares of common stock underlying options will become available for sale in the public market. We expect to file a registration statement on Form S-8 that will register approximately 5.8 million shares of common stock, including shares of common stock issuable under our stock plans.
As restrictions on resale end, our stock price could drop significantly if the holders of these restricted shares sell them or the market perceives they intend to sell them. These sales may also make it more difficult for us to sell securities in the future at a time and at a price we deem appropriate.
Because a limited number of stockholders control the majority of the voting power of our common stock, investors in this offering will not be able to determine the outcome of stockholder votes.
Following this offering, our executive officers, directors, Code, Hennessy & Simmons IV, L.P., and their affiliated entities will control % of the voting power of our common stock, or % if the underwriters over-allotment option is exercised in full. So long as these stockholders continue to hold, directly or indirectly, shares of common stock representing more than 50% of the voting power of our common stock, they will be able to direct the election of all of the members of our board of directors who will determine our strategic plans and financing decisions and appoint senior
19
You will incur immediate and substantial dilution as a result of this offering.
The initial public offering price will be substantially higher than the book value (deficit) per share of our common stock. As a result, purchasers in this offering will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $ per share in the tangible book value of the common stock from the assumed initial public offering price of $ . After our issue and sale of shares of our common stock in this offering at an initial public offering price of $ per share, the purchasers of shares issued by us in this offering will contribute % of the total gross amount invested to date in our company, but will own only % of the shares of common stock outstanding. However, the purchasers of shares from the selling stockholders will own an additional % of the shares of common stock outstanding. In addition, to the extent that currently outstanding options to purchase common stock at a price per share less than our tangible net book value per share are exercised, there will be further dilution.
20
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This prospectus includes forward-looking statements, as defined by federal securities laws, with respect to our financial condition, results of operations and business, and our expectations or beliefs concerning future events. Words such as, but not limited to, believe, expect, anticipate, estimate, intend, plan, targets, likely, will, would, could, and similar expressions or phrases identify forward-looking statements.
All forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties. The occurrence of the events described, and the achievement of the expected results, depend on many events, some or all of which are not predictable or within our control. Actual results may differ materially from expected results.
Factors that may cause actual results to differ from expected results include, among others:
| general economic conditions and a downturn in the architectural, engineering and construction industry; |
| competition in our industry and innovation by our competitors; |
| our failure to anticipate and adapt to future changes in our industry; |
| uncertainty regarding our product and service innovations; |
| the inability to charge for our value-added services to offset potential declines in print volumes; |
| adverse developments affecting the State of California, including general and local economic conditions, macroeconomic trends, and natural disasters; |
| our inability to successfully identify and manage our acquisitions or open new branches; |
| our inability to successfully monitor and manage the business operations of our subsidiaries and uncertainty regarding the effectiveness of financial and management policies and procedures we established to improve accounting controls; |
| adverse developments concerning our relationships with certain key vendors; |
| our inability to adequately protect our intellectual property and litigation regarding intellectual property; |
| acts of terrorism, violence, war, natural disaster or other circumstances that cause damage or disruption to us, our facilities, our technology centers, our vendors or a majority of our customers; |
| the loss of key personnel or qualified technical staff; |
| the potential writedown of goodwill we have recorded in connection with our acquisitions; |
| the availability of cash to operate and expand our business as planned and to service our debt; |
| the increased expenses and administrative workload associated with being a public company; |
| failure to maintain an effective system of internal controls necessary to accurately report our financial results and prevent fraud; |
| potential environmental liabilities. |
All future written and verbal forward-looking statements attributable to us or any person acting on our behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements contained or referred to in this section. We undertake no obligation, and specifically decline any obligation, to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise. In light of these risks, uncertainties and assumptions, the forward-looking events discussed in this prospectus might not occur.
21
See the section entitled Risk Factors for a more complete discussion of these risks and uncertainties and for other risks and uncertainties. These factors and the other risk factors described in this prospectus are not necessarily all of the important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in any of our forward-looking statements. Other unknown or unpredictable factors also could harm our results. Consequently, there can be no assurance that the actual results or developments anticipated by us will be realized or, even if substantially realized, that they will have the expected consequences to, or effects on, us. Given these uncertainties, prospective investors are cautioned not to place undue reliance on such forward-looking statements.
TRADEMARKS AND TRADE NAMES
We own or have rights to trademarks, service marks, copyrights and trade names that we use in conjunction with the operation of our business, including the names American Reprographics Company SM , ARC SM , Abacus PCR TM , BidCaster SM , EWO SM , MetaPrint TM , OneView SM , PEiR SM , PlanWell®, PlanWell PDS TM , PlanWell Enterprise SM , and various design marks associated therewith. This prospectus also includes trademarks, service marks and trade names of other companies.
MARKET DATA
We operate in an industry in which it is difficult to obtain precise industry and market information. Although we have obtained some industry data from third party sources that we believe to be reliable, in many cases we have based certain statements contained in this prospectus regarding our industry and our position in the industry on our estimates concerning our customers and competitors. These estimates are based on our experience in the industry, conversations with our principal vendors, our own investigation of market conditions and information obtained through our numerous acquisitions.
22
USE OF PROCEEDS
We expect to receive net proceeds of approximately $104.5 million from the sale of shares of common stock by us in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $ per share (the mid-point of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus), after deducting estimated underwriting commissions and discounts and estimated expenses. We will not receive any of the proceeds from the sale of shares by the selling stockholders or upon any exercise of the underwriters over-allotment option.
We anticipate using the net proceeds to us from this offering as follows:
| approximately $27.3 million to repurchase our preferred equity, including accrued interest, which becomes payable upon our initial public offering; |
| approximately $49.9 million to repay a portion of our $225 million senior second priority secured term loan facility, which has a maturity date of December 2009 and bears interest at a floating rate which was 8.625% as of September 30, 2004; and |
| the balance of approximately $27.3 million to repay a portion of our $100 million senior first priority secured term loan facility, which has a maturity date of June 2009 and bears interest at a floating rate which was 4.84% as of September 30, 2004. |
Pending application of the balance of the net proceeds described above, we plan to invest such balance in short and medium-term, interest-bearing obligations, investment-grade instruments, certificates of deposit or direct or guaranteed obligations of the U.S. government.
DIVIDEND POLICY
We have never declared or paid cash dividends on our common equity. We currently intend to retain all available funds and any future earnings for use in the operation of our business and do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Any future determination to declare cash dividends will be made at the discretion of our board of directors, subject to compliance with certain covenants under our credit facilities, which restrict or limit our ability to declare or pay dividends, and will depend on our financial condition, results of operations, capital requirements, general business conditions, and other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant.
REORGANIZATION
Immediately prior to this offering, we will reorganize from a California limited liability company to a Delaware corporation, American Reprographics Company. In the reorganization:
| each common unit of Holdings will be exchanged for one share of our common stock; |
| each Holdings option will be exchanged for an option exercisable for shares of our common stock equal to the number of units subject to the Holdings option and with the same exercise price and vesting terms as the Holdings option; and |
| each Holdings warrant will become exercisable for shares of our common stock equal to the number of units subject to the Holdings warrant and on the same terms as the Holdings warrant. |
Pursuant to the operating agreement of Holdings, cash distributions are to be made to members of Holdings to provide them with funds to pay taxes that the members will owe for their share of our profits as a limited liability company through the date of our reorganization, calculated at the highest combined federal and state income tax rate applicable for tax withholding purposes, currently 43%. Accordingly, immediately prior to our reorganization, we will make a cash distribution to all members of Holdings of the estimated amount due the members with respect to such taxes in the amount of approximately $596,000. Within approximately 45 days after the closing of this offering, when the final amount due the members with respect to such taxes has been calculated,
23
CHANGE IN INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
On October 24, 2003, Holdings board of advisors determined to no longer use the audit services of Ernst & Young LLP and approved the appointment of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to serve as our independent public accountants for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2003. During the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and the subsequent interim period through October 24, 2003, we did not consult with PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP with respect to the application of accounting principles to a specified transaction, either completed or proposed, or the type of audit opinion that might be rendered on our consolidated financial statements, or any other matters or reportable events as set forth in Items 304(a)(2)(i) and (ii) of Regulation S-K.
The reports of Ernst & Young LLP on our consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 did not contain an adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion, or a qualification or modification as to uncertainty, audit scope, or accounting principles. During our fiscal years 2001 and 2002 and the subsequent interim period through October 24, 2003, there were no disagreements between Ernst & Young LLP and us on any matter of accounting principle or practice, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreements if not resolved to the satisfaction of Ernst & Young LLP would have caused it to make reference thereto in its reports on the financial statements for such period. There has been no matter that was the subject of a reportable event (as defined in Item 304(a)(1)(v) of Regulation S-K).
We have provided Ernst & Young LLP with a copy of the foregoing disclosures and requested that Ernst & Young LLP furnish us with a letter addressed to the Securities and Exchange Commission stating whether or not Ernst & Young LLP agrees with the above statements. A copy of such letter, dated October 15, 2004, is filed as an exhibit to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.
24
CAPITALIZATION
The following table sets forth our unaudited consolidated capitalization as of September 30, 2004:
| on an actual basis; |
| on a pro forma basis to reflect the reorganization of our company from a limited liability company to a corporation prior to the completion of this offering (see Reorganization); and |
| on a pro forma as adjusted basis to reflect the sale of shares of our common stock by us in this offering and the application of the net proceeds as described under Use of Proceeds. |
This table should be read in conjunction with Reorganization, Use of Proceeds, Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, and our consolidated financial statements, including the related notes, appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.
As of September 30, 2004 | |||||||||||||||
|
|||||||||||||||
Pro Forma | |||||||||||||||
Actual | Pro Forma | As Adjusted | |||||||||||||
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents(1)
|
$ | 12,008 | $ | 910 | $ | 910 | |||||||||
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Long-term debt, excluding current maturities:
|
|||||||||||||||
Existing senior secured credit facilities(2)
|
$ | 309,759 | $ | 309,759 | $ | 232,978 | |||||||||
Capital leases
|
9,026 | 9,026 | 9,026 | ||||||||||||
Mandatorily redeemable preferred membership
units(3)
|
27,285 | 27,285 | | ||||||||||||
Seller notes from acquisitions(4)
|
1,630 | 1,630 | 1,630 | ||||||||||||
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Total long-term debt
|
347,700 | 347,700 | 243,634 | ||||||||||||
Total equity/deficit:
|
|||||||||||||||
Common members capital
35,487,511 member common membership units issued and outstanding
actual; none pro forma and pro forma as adjusted
|
29,302 | | | ||||||||||||
Common stock, par value $0.001 per
share 150,000,000 shares authorized; none
issued and outstanding actual; 35,487,511 issued and outstanding
pro
forma; issued
and outstanding pro forma as adjusted
|
| 35 | 35 | ||||||||||||
Preferred stock, par value $0.001 per
share 25,000,000 shares authorized; none issued
and outstanding actual; none issued and outstanding pro forma;
none issued and outstanding pro forma as adjusted
|
| | | ||||||||||||
Additional paid-in-capital
|
| 29,267 | 133,767 | ||||||||||||
Deferred compensation
|
(2,742 | ) | (2,742 | ) | (2,742 | ) | |||||||||
Accumulated equity (deficit):
|
|||||||||||||||
Accumulated earnings from inception, less
distributions to members (1)(5)(7)
|
(60,078 | ) | (55,284 | ) | (57,347 | ) | |||||||||
Accumulated other comprehensive income
|
(343 | ) | (343 | ) | (343 | ) | |||||||||
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Total equity/(deficit)(6)
|
(33,861 | ) | (29,067 | ) | 73,370 | ||||||||||
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Total capitalization
|
$ | 313,839 | $ | 318,633 | $ | 317,004 | |||||||||
|
|
|
25
(1) | Reflects the payment of $10.5 million to the CHS Entities in connection with our reorganization and reflects a $596,000 distribution to members in respect to taxes. See Reorganization. |
(2) | At September 30, 2004, our senior secured credit facilities consisted of two facilities: (i) a $130 million senior first priority secured facility, consisting of a $100 million term loan facility, of which $99.3 million was outstanding at September 30, 2004, and a $30 million revolving credit facility, none of which was outstanding at September 30, 2004; and (ii) a $225 million senior second priority secured term facility of which $213.4 million was outstanding at September 30, 2004. Subsequent to September 30, 2004, we repaid $9.3 million of our senior secured term facilities. We intend to apply the net proceeds from this offering to repay approximately $49.9 million of our second priority secured facility and the balance of approximately $27.3 million to repay a portion of our first priority secured facility. See Use of Proceeds. |
(3) | Holdings issued 20,000 redeemable preferred units in connection with the 2000 recapitalization. Holders of such preferred units are entitled to an investment return of 13.25% per annum for periods prior to April 10, 2003 and 15.0% per annum thereafter. A portion of the investment return is distributed quarterly under a formula which takes into account federal and certain state and local income tax rates applicable to such investment return. The unpaid portion of the investment return accumulates annually and will be payable upon any redemption or repurchase of the preferred units. Pursuant to the terms of Holdings operating agreement, on the closing date of the offering, we will use a portion of the net proceeds of this offering to repurchase all outstanding preferred units. The total amount we expect to pay to repurchase such preferred units, including the unpaid portion of the investment return, is approximately $27.3 million. |
(4) | The seller notes were issued in connection with certain acquisitions, with interest rates ranging between 7.0% and 8.0% and maturities between 2005 and 2007. |
(5) | Accumulated earnings from inception includes the income tax effects of the corporate conversion which will result in an income tax benefit of $15.9 million. |
(6) | The deficit of $33.9 million, as of September 30, 2004, includes $88.8 million in cash distributions to Holdings common unit holders made in connection with the 2000 recapitalization. |
(7) | Accumulated earnings from inception includes a charge of $2.1 million to write off a portion of debt discount and deferred financing costs due to early extinguishment of debt from the use of proceeds. |
26
DILUTION
If you invest in our common stock, your interest will be diluted to the extent of the difference between the initial public offering price per share of our common stock and the net tangible book value (deficit) per share of our common stock upon the completion of this offering.
On a pro forma basis to give effect to our reorganization as Delaware corporation, as described in Reorganization, our net tangible book value (deficit) as of September 30, 2004 equaled approximately $(279.9) million, or $(7.89) per share of common stock. Net tangible book value (deficit) per share represents the amount of our total tangible assets less total liabilities, divided by the total number of shares of common stock outstanding. After giving effect to the sale of shares of common stock offered by us in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $ per share and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, our net tangible book value (deficit), as adjusted, as of September 30, 2004 would have equaled approximately $ million, or $ per share of common stock. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $ per share to our existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in net tangible book value of $ per share to new investors of common stock in this offering. The following table illustrates this per share dilution to new investors purchasing our common stock in this offering.
Assumed initial public offering price per share
|
$ | ||||||||
Net tangible book value (deficit) per share at
September 30, 2004
|
(7.89 | ) | |||||||
Increase in net tangible book value per share
attributable to this offering
|
|||||||||
|
|||||||||
Net tangible book value per share after this
offering
|
|||||||||
|
|||||||||
Dilution per common share to new investors
|
$ | ||||||||
|
The following table summarizes the differences between our existing stockholders and new investors, as of September 30, 2004, with respect to the number of shares of common stock issued by us, the total consideration paid and the average price per share paid. The calculations with respect to common shares purchased by new investors in this offering reflect the initial public offering price of $ per share before deducting the underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.
Average | |||||||||||||||||||||
Shares Purchased | Total Consideration | Price | |||||||||||||||||||
|
|
Per | |||||||||||||||||||
Number | Percent | Amount | Percent | Share | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Existing stockholders
|
35,487,511 | % | $ | 168,954,000 | % | $ | 4.76 | ||||||||||||||
New investors
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Total
|
100 | % | $ | 100 | % |
The discussion and tables above assume no exercise of any of the stock options to purchase shares with exercise prices ranging from $4.88 to $6.14 per share and a weighted average exercise price of $5.22 per share outstanding at September 30, 2004. If all our outstanding options at September 30, 2004 had been exercised, the net tangible book value (deficit) per share, as adjusted, would have been $(7.52) per share, representing an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $0.37 per share to our existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in net tangible book value of $ per share to new investors purchasing shares in this offering.
27
If the underwriters over-allotment option is exercised in full, sales by the selling stockholders in this offering will reduce the number of shares of common stock held by existing stockholders to shares or approximately % of the total number of shares of common stock outstanding upon the closing of this offering and will increase the number of shares held by new public investors to shares or approximately % of the total number of shares of common stock outstanding after this offering. See Principal and Selling Stockholders.
28
SELECTED HISTORICAL AND UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL DATA
The selected historical and unaudited pro forma financial data presented below are derived from the audited financial statements of Holdings for the fiscal years ended December 31, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, and 2003, and the unaudited financial statements of Holdings for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2003 and 2004. The selected historical financial data for the nine-month periods ended September 30, 2003 and 2004 are derived from unaudited interim financial statements which, in the opinion of management, include all normal, recurring adjustments necessary to state fairly the data included therein in accordance with GAAP for interim financial information, except for pro forma data. Interim results are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for the entire fiscal year. The unaudited pro forma financial data set forth below give effect to our conversion to a Delaware corporation and the completion of this offering, as described in Use of Proceeds. The unaudited pro forma financial data are not necessarily indicative of our financial position or results of operations that might have occurred had the transactions they give effect to been completed as of the dates indicated and do not purport to represent what our financial position or results of operations might be for any future period or date. The financial data set forth below should be read in conjunction with Capitalization, Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and our audited financial statements and unaudited financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ended | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1999 | 2000 | 2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Statement of Operations Data:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Reprographics services
|
$ | 198,774 | $ | 287,995 | $ | 338,124 | $ | 324,402 | $ | 315,995 | $ | 242,507 | $ | 253,367 | |||||||||||||||
Facilities management
|
14,745 | 24,624 | 39,875 | 52,290 | 59,311 | 42,719 | 53,736 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Equipment and supplies sales
|
10,317 | 38,480 | 42,702 | 42,232 | 40,654 | 31,112 | 29,195 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Total net sales
|
223,836 | 351,099 | 420,701 | 418,924 | 415,960 | 316,338 | 336,298 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of sales
|
134,531 | 201,390 | 243,710 | 247,778 | 252,028 | 190,266 | 196,668 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Gross profit
|
89,305 | 149,709 | 176,991 | 171,146 | 163,932 | 126,072 | 139,630 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Selling, general and administrative expenses
|
53,730 | 85,371 | 102,576 | 101,805 | 101,252 | 76,127 | 81,167 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Amortization of intangibles
|
2,823 | 3,966 | 5,731 | 218 | 131 | 99 | 69 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Costs incurred in connection with the 2000
recapitalization
|
| 20,544 | | | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Costs incurred in connection with acquisition
activities
|
| 4,000 | 1,428 | 1,500 | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Write-off of intangible assets
|
| | 3,438 | | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Income from operations
|
32,752 | 35,828 | 63,818 | 67,623 | 62,549 | 49,846 | 58,394 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Other income
|
638 | 713 | 304 | 541 | 1,024 | 1,080 | 574 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Interest expense
|
(9,215 | ) | (29,238 | ) | (47,530 | ) | (39,917 | ) | (39,390 | ) | (28,958 | ) | (24,506 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
|
| (1,195 | ) | | | (14,921 | ) | | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Income before income tax provision
|
24,175 | 6,108 | 16,592 | 28,247 | 9,262 | 21,968 | 34,462 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax provision
|
4,068 | 4,784 | 5,802 | 6,304 | 4,321 | 4,417 | 7,076 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Net income
|
20,107 | 1,324 | 10,790 | 21,943 | 4,941 | 17,551 | 27,386 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends and amortization of discount on
preferred members equity
|
| (2,158 | ) | (3,107 | ) | (3,291 | ) | (1,730 | ) | (1,730 | ) | | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Net income (loss) attributable to common members
|
20,107 | (834 | ) | 7,683 | 18,652 | 3,211 | 15,821 | 27,386 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Unaudited pro forma incremental income tax
provision(1)
|
5,304 | 2,618 | 2,622 | 6,275 | 1,407 | 5,568 | 8,375 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Unaudited pro forma net income (loss)
attributable to common members
|
$ | 14,803 | $ | (3,452 | ) | $ | 5,061 | $ | 12,377 | $ | 1,804 | $ | 10,253 | $ | 19,011 | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
29
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ended | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1999 | 2000 | 2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(In thousands, except per unit amounts) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net income (loss) attributable to common members
per common unit:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Basic
|
$ | 0.82 | $ | (0.02 | ) | $ | 0.21 | $ | 0.51 | $ | 0.09 | $ | 0.45 | $ | 0.77 | ||||||||||||||
Diluted
|
$ | 0.82 | $ | (0.02 | ) | $ | 0.21 | $ | 0.51 | $ | 0.09 | $ | 0.42 | $ | 0.73 | ||||||||||||||
Unaudited pro forma net income (loss)
attributable to common members per common unit:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Basic
|
$ | 0.60 | $ | (0.10 | ) | $ | 0.14 | $ | 0.34 | $ | 0.05 | $ | 0.29 | $ | 0.54 | ||||||||||||||
Diluted
|
$ | 0.60 | $ | (0.10 | ) | $ | 0.14 | $ | 0.34 | $ | 0.05 | $ | 0.27 | $ | 0.51 | ||||||||||||||
Weighted average units:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Basic
|
24,571 | 35,308 | 36,629 | 36,406 | 35,480 | 35,478 | 35,488 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Diluted
|
24,571 | 35,371 | 36,758 | 36,723 | 37,298 | 37,307 | 37,489 |
Nine Months | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended December 31, | September 30, | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||
1999 | 2000 | 2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other Financial Data:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization(2)
|
$ | 9,542 | $ | 14,942 | $ | 25,372 | $ | 17,898 | $ | 18,359 | $ | 14,049 | $ | 13,141 | ||||||||||||||
Capital expenditures, net
|
$ | 3,877 | $ | 5,228 | $ | 8,659 | $ | 5,209 | $ | 4,992 | $ | 3,348 | $ | 4,772 | ||||||||||||||
Interest expense
|
$ | 9,215 | $ | 29,238 | $ | 47,530 | $ | 39,917 | $ | 39,390 | $ | 28,958 | $ | 24,506 |
As of December 31, | As of | |||||||||||||||||||||||
|
September 30, | |||||||||||||||||||||||
1999 | 2000 | 2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Balance Sheet Data:
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
$ | 15,814 | $ | 31,565 | $ | 29,110 | $ | 24,995 | $ | 17,315 | $ | 12,008 | ||||||||||||
Total assets
|
$ | 204,464 | $ | 358,026 | $ | 371,948 | $ | 395,677 | $ | 376,843 | $ | 381,209 | ||||||||||||
Long term obligations and mandatorily redeemable
preferred and common membership units(3)(4)
|
$ | 123,951 | $ | 359,746 | $ | 371,515 | $ | 378,102 | $ | 360,008 | $ | 347,700 | ||||||||||||
Total members equity (deficit)(5)
|
$ | 32,422 | $ | (80,478 | ) | $ | (78,900 | ) | $ | (59,784 | ) | $ | (57,329 | ) | $ | (33,861 | ) | |||||||
Working capital
|
$ | 15,379 | $ | 34,742 | $ | 24,338 | $ | 24,371 | $ | 16,809 | $ | 28,333 |
(1) | Until our reorganization, which will be effective prior to the closing of this offering, a substantial portion of our business will continue to operate as a limited liability company, or LLC, and taxed as a partnership. As a result, the members of the LLC pay the income taxes on the earnings. The unaudited pro forma incremental income tax provision amounts reflected in the table above were calculated as if our reorganization became effective on January 1, 1999. |
(2) | Depreciation and amortization includes a write-off of intangible assets of $3.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2001. |
(3) | In July 2003, we adopted SFAS No. 150,Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity. In accordance with SFAS No. 150, the redeemable preferred equity of Holdings has been reclassified in our financial statements as a component of our total debt upon our adoption of this new standard. The redeemable preferred equity amounted to $25.8 million as of December 31, 2003 and $27.3 million as of September 30, 2004. SFAS No. 150 does not permit the restatement of financial statements for periods prior to the adoption of this standard. |
(4) | Redeemable common membership units amounted to $6.0 million and $8.1 million at December 31, 2000 and 2001, respectively. |
(5) | The decline in total members equity (deficit) from December 31, 1999 to December 31, 2000 was a result of an $88.8 million cash distribution to Holdings common unit holders in connection with the 2000 recapitalization and the reclassification of $20.3 million of preferred equity issued in connection with the 2000 recapitalization upon the adoption of SFAS No. 150 in July 2003. |
30
MANAGEMENTS DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
The following discussion should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes and other financial information appearing elsewhere in this prospectus. This prospectus contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may differ materially from those indicated in forward-looking statements. See Risk Factors and Forward-Looking Statements.
Overview
We are the leading reprographics company in the United States providing business-to-business document management services to the architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry. We also provide these services to companies in non-AEC industries, such as the technology, financial services, retail, entertainment, and food and hospitality industries, that also require sophisticated document management services.
From late 2001 through late 2003, we experienced a decline in net sales due to the overall softness in the U.S. economy, coupled with declining non-residential construction spending. Since approximately half of our net sales are derived from our operations in California, the significant downturn in the technology sector in this area further contributed to the decline of our net sales. Despite acquisition activity, our net sales declined from $420.7 million in 2001 to $416.0 million in 2003. In the nine months ended September 30, 2004, we have seen an improvement in sales due to the improvement of the overall U.S. economy and increased spending in the non-residential construction sector. Net sales increased 6.3% to $336.3 million compared to the same period in 2003.
A significant component our growth has been related to acquisitions. In 2001, we acquired 14 reprographics companies for a total cost of $32.6 million. In 2002, we acquired eight companies for a total cost of $34.4 million, and in 2003, we acquired four companies for a total cost of $870,000. In the nine months ended September 30, 2004, we have acquired three companies for a total cost of $1.4 million. As part of our growth strategy, we also have also recently begun opening and operating branch service centers, which we view as a relatively low cost, rapid form of market expansion. Our branch openings require modest capital expenditures and are expected to generate operating profit within 12 months from opening. We have opened 17 new branches in key markets since September 2003 and expect to open an additional 15 branches by the end of the first quarter of 2005. To date, each branch that has been open at least 12 months has generated operating profit.
During 2003, we began our strategy of licensing our PlanWell technology to other independent reprographers. This strategy is designed to increase the market penetration of our PlanWell technology, while offsetting a portion of its development costs through the generation of licensing revenues. In 2003, we also started PEiR (Profit and Education in Reprographics), a privately held trade organization through which we charge membership fees and provide purchasing, technology and educational benefits to other reprographers, while promoting our reprographics technology as the industry standard. PEiR currently consists of 45 independent reprographics companies.
In December 2003, we refinanced our debt structure with the issuance of $225 million of second lien financing combined with a $130 million first lien debt package. This refinancing resulted in interest savings to the company for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 of approximately $6.2 million compared to the same period in 2003. These savings were partially offset by rising interest rates.
We continue to focus on our key opportunities, which include: the expansion of our market share, our national footprint of reprographics centers and our facilities management programs; the establishment of PlanWell as the industry standard for procuring digital reprographics online; and the expansion of our service offerings to non-AEC related industries.
31
Factors Affecting Financial Performance
Based on a review of the top 30% of our customers, representing approximately 90% of our net sales, and designating our customers as either AEC or non-AEC based on their primary use of our services, we believe that sales to the AEC market accounted for approximately 80% of our year to date net sales through September 30, 2004, with the remaining 20% consisting of sales to non-AEC markets. As a result, our operating results and financial condition are significantly impacted by various economic factors affecting the AEC industry, such as non-residential construction spending, GDP growth, interest rates, employment rates, office vacancy rates, and government expenditures. Similar to the AEC industry, we believe that the reprographics industry typically lags the recovery in the broader economy by approximately six months.
During the period from 2001 to 2003, non-residential construction activity in the United States declined as the overall economy softened and commercial vacancy rates increased. The consequent downturn in the AEC industry was the primary reason for the decline in our net sales during this period. Through cost cutting and aggressive sales and marketing, we were able to hold our operating margins fairly steady. Operating margins were 15.2% in 2001, 16.1% in 2002 and 15.1% in 2003. For the nine months ended September 30, 2004, our operating margins and net sales increased compared to the same period in 2003. Operating margins were 15.8% and 17.4% for the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively.
Key Financial Measures
The following key financial measures are used by our management to operate and assess the performance of our business: net sales and costs and expenses.
Net Sales
Net sales represent total sales less returns, discounts and allowances. These sales consist of document management services, document distribution and logistics services, print-on-demand services, reprographics equipment and supplies sales, software licenses and PEiR memberships. We generate sales by individual orders through commissioned sales personnel and, in some cases, pursuant to national contracts. Our document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services, including the use of PlanWell by our customers, are typically invoiced to a customer as part of a combined per square foot printing cost and, as such, it is impractical to allocate revenue levels for each item separately. Revenues for these services are included under the caption Reprographics services.
Facilities management revenues are generated from printing produced in our customers locations on machines that we own or lease. Generally, this revenue is derived via a single cost per square foot of printed material, similar to our Reprographics services revenue.
In 2003, our reprographics services represented approximately 76% of our net sales, facilities management revenues represented approximately 14%, and sales of reprographics equipment and supplies sales represented approximately 10%. Although our PlanWell and other software licenses and our PEiR memberships are strategic to providing our other services, to date these services have not been significant revenue contributors.
We identify reportable segments based on how management internally evaluates financial information, business activities and management responsibility. On that basis, we operate in a single reportable business segment.
To a large extent, our continued engagement by our customers for successive jobs depends upon the customers satisfaction with the quality of services that we provide. Our customer orders tend to be of a short-run, but recurring, nature. Since we do not operate with a backlog, it is difficult for us to predict the number, size and profitability of reprographics work that we expect to undertake more than a few weeks in advance.
32
Costs and Expenses
Our cost of sales consists primarily of paper, toner and other consumables, labor, and maintenance, repair, rental and insurance costs associated with operating our facilities and equipment, along with depreciation charges. Paper cost is the most significant component of our material cost; however, paper pricing typically does not impact our operating margins because changes in paper pricing are generally passed on to our customers. We closely monitor material cost as a percentage of net sales to measure volume and waste. We also track labor utilization, or net sales per employee, to measure productivity and determine staffing levels.
We maintain low inventory balances as well as low levels of other working capital requirements. In addition, capital expenditure requirements are low as most facilities and equipment are leased, with overall capital spending averaging approximately 1.5% of annual net sales over the last three years. Since we typically lease our reprographics equipment for periods averaging between three and five years, we are able to upgrade our equipment in response to rapid changes in technology.
Our selling expenses generally include the salaries and commissions paid to our sales professionals, along with promotional, travel and entertainment costs. Our general and administrative expenses generally include the salaries and benefits paid to support personnel at our reprographics businesses and our corporate staff, as well as office rent, utilities, insurance and communications expenses, and various professional services.
Our general and administrative expenses also include management fees paid to CHS Management IV, L.P. in accordance with a management agreement entered into in connection with our recapitalization in 2000. These management fees, which may not exceed $1 million in any year, amounted to $803,000 during 2001, $889,000 during 2002, $858,000 during 2003, $622,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2003, and $618,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2004. The management agreement will be terminated upon the completion of this offering.
Impact of Conversion from an LLC to a Corporation
Immediately prior to this offering, we will reorganize from a California limited liability company to a Delaware corporation, American Reprographics Company. In the reorganization, the members of Holdings will exchange their common units and options to purchase common units for shares of our common stock and options to purchase shares of our common stock. As required by the operating agreement of Holdings, we will repurchase all of the preferred equity of Holdings upon the closing of this offering with a portion of the net proceeds from this offering. After the reorganization, all outstanding warrants to purchase common units will be exercisable for shares of our common stock. We do not expect any significant impact on our operations as a result of the reorganization apart from an increase in our effective tax rate due to corporate level taxes, which will be offset by the elimination of tax distributions to our members and the recognition of deferred income taxes upon our conversion from a California limited liability company to a Delaware corporation.
Income Taxes
Holdings and Opco, through which a substantial portion of our business is operated, are limited liability companies which are taxed as partnerships. As a result, the members of Holdings pay income taxes on the earnings of Opco, which are passed through to Holdings. Certain divisions are consolidated in Holdings and are treated as separate corporate entities for income tax purposes (the consolidated corporations). These consolidated corporations pay income tax and record provisions for income taxes in their financial statements. Following the reorganization of our company to a Delaware corporation, our earnings will be subject to federal, state and local taxes at a combined statutory rate of approximately 43%, which is lower than our pro forma effective income tax rate of 44.8% for the period ended September 30, 2004 due to the redemption of our preferred equity and the related nondeductible interest expense.
33
Members Deficit and Capital Accounts
Our members deficit of $33.9 million as of September 30, 2004 includes $88.8 million in cash distributions to our common unit holders made in connection with our recapitalization in 2000 and previous cash distributions made to the members of Holdings to provide them with funds to pay taxes owed for their share of our profits as a limited liability company.
Immediately prior to our reorganization, we will make a cash distribution to all members of Holdings of the estimated amount due the members with respect to such taxes in the amount of approximately $596,000. After the closing of this offering, when the members final tax liability has been calculated, we will make a final payment for the balance, if any, due to the members. In addition, due to their tax attributes, certain of our members, Code Hennessey & Simmons IV, L.P. and ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. (the CHS Entities), have in the past elected to receive less than their proportionate share of distributions for such taxes and are owed a distribution of approximately $10.5 million. These distributions are not accrued at September 30, 2004, but will become payable and recorded immediately prior to the reorganization and consummation of this offering. The effects of all the proposed distributions have been reflected in the pro forma balance sheet at September 30, 2004 on page F-4 of this prospectus. We may also make a further distribution to the CHS Entities after the closing of this offering if the estimated payment to the CHS Entities does not fully offset such shortfall.
Acquisitions
Our financial results during the periods discussed below were impacted by the acquisition of 14 reprographics businesses in 2001 for a total purchase price of $32.6 million, eight acquisitions in 2002 for a total purchase price of $34.4 million, four acquisitions in 2003 for a total purchase price of $870,000 and three acquisitions in the nine months ended September 30, 2004 for a total purchase price of $1.4 million. Because each acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting, our consolidated income statements reflect sales and expenses of acquired businesses only for post-acquisition periods. For more details regarding these acquisitions, see Note 2 to our consolidated financial statements.
In connection with certain large acquisitions, we have made certain payments to employees of the acquired companies that could not be capitalized and included in goodwill because such payments represented compensation expense. These expenses are reflected in the expense line item titled Costs incurred in connection with acquisition activities in our consolidated financial statements.
Critical Accounting Policies
The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. We evaluate our estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis and rely on historical experience and various other factors that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances to determine such estimates. Actual results could differ from those estimates and such differences may be material to the consolidated financial statements. We believe the critical accounting policies and areas that require more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements to be: goodwill and other intangible assets; allowance for doubtful accounts; and commitments and contingencies.
34
Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
Effective January 1, 2002, we adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standard (SFAS) No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, which requires, among other things, the use of a nonamortization approach for purchased goodwill and certain intangibles. Under a nonamortization approach, goodwill and intangibles having an indefinite life are not amortized, but instead will be reviewed for impairment at least annually or if an event occurs or circumstances indicate the carrying amount may be impaired. Events or circumstances which could indicate an impairment include a significant change in the business climate, economic and industry trends, legal factors, negative operating performance indicators, significant competition, changes in our strategy or disposition of a reporting unit or a portion thereof. Goodwill impairment testing is performed at the reporting unit level.
SFAS 142 requires that goodwill be tested for impairment using a two-step process. The first step of the goodwill impairment test, used to identify potential impairment, compares the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered to be impaired and the second step of the impairment test is unnecessary. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test must be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. The second step of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
Application of the goodwill impairment test requires judgment, including the identification of reporting units, assignment of assets and liabilities to such reporting units, assignment of goodwill to such reporting units, and determination of the fair value of each reporting unit. The fair value of each reporting unit is estimated using a discounted cash flow methodology. This requires significant judgments including estimation of future cash flows, which is dependent on internal forecasts, estimation of the long-term rate of growth for our business, the useful life over which cash flows will occur, and determination of our weighted average cost of capital. Changes in these estimates and assumptions could materially affect the determination of fair value and/or goodwill impairment for each reporting unit.
We have selected September 30 as the date on which we will perform our annual goodwill impairment test. Based on our valuation of goodwill, no impairment charges related to the write-down of goodwill were recognized for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003. During the year ended December 31, 2001, we wrote-off $3.4 million of goodwill recorded from an acquisition completed during 2000 because the business was closed in 2001 due to underperformance.
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
We perform periodic credit evaluations of the financial condition of our customers, monitor collections and payments from customers, and generally do not require collateral. Receivables are generally due within 30 days. We provide for the possible inability to collect accounts receivable by recording an allowance for doubtful accounts. We write-off an account when it is considered to be uncollectible. We estimate our allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical experience, aging of accounts receivable, and information regarding the creditworthiness of our customers. To date, uncollectible amounts have been within the range of managements expectations.
35
Commitments and Contingencies
In the normal course of business, we estimate potential future loss accruals related to legal, tax and other contingencies. These accruals require managements judgment on the outcome of various events based on the best available information. However, due to changes in facts and circumstances, the ultimate outcomes could be different than managements estimates.
Non-GAAP Measures
EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related ratios presented in this prospectus) are supplemental measures of our performance that are not required by, or presented in accordance with GAAP. These measures are not measurements of our financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered as alternatives to net income, income from operations, or any other performance measures derived in accordance with GAAP or as an alternative to cash flow from operating, investing or financing activities as a measure of our liquidity.
EBIT represents net income before interest and taxes. EBITDA represents net income before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization. Adjusted EBITDA represents EBITDA adjusted to exclude the impact of costs incurred in connection with our recapitalization in 2000 and loss on early extinguishment of debt. Adjusted EBIT margin is a non-GAAP measure that is calculated by subtracting depreciation and amortization from adjusted EBITDA and dividing the result by net sales. Adjusted EBITDA margin is a non-GAAP measure that is calculated by dividing adjusted EBITDA by net sales.
We calculate Adjusted EBITDA by adjusting EBITDA to eliminate the impact of a number of items we do not consider indicative of our ongoing operations and for the other reasons noted below. You are encouraged to evaluate each adjustment and whether you consider it appropriate. In addition, in evaluating Adjusted EBITDA, you should be aware that in the future we may incur expenses similar to the adjustments in the presentation of Adjusted EBITDA. Our presentation of Adjusted EBITDA should not be construed as an inference that our future results will be unaffected by unusual or non-recurring items.
We present EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related ratios presented in this prospectus) because we consider them important supplemental measures of our performance and liquidity and believe that such measures are meaningful to investors because they are used by management for the reasons discussed below.
We use EBIT as a metric to measure and compare the performance of our divisions. We operate our 42 divisions as separate business units, but manage debt and taxation at the corporate level. As a result, EBIT is the best measure of divisional profitability and the most useful metric by which to measure and compare the performance of our divisions. We also use EBIT as a metric to measure performance for the purpose of determining compensation at the division level and use EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to measure performance and determine compensation at the consolidated level. We also use EBITDA as a metric to manage cash flow from our divisions to the corporate level and to determine the financial health of each division. As noted above, because our divisions do not incur interest or income tax expense, the cash flow from each division should be equal to the corresponding EBITDA of each division, assuming no other changes to a divisions balance sheet. As a result, we reconcile EBITDA to cash flow on a monthly basis as one of our key internal controls. We also use EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to evaluate potential acquisitions and to evaluate whether to incur capital expenditures. In addition, certain covenants in our credit agreements require compliance with financial ratios based on Adjusted EBITDA (as defined in our credit agreements).
36
EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related ratios presented in this prospectus) have limitations as analytical tools, and you should not consider them in isolation, or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under GAAP. Some of these limitations are:
| they do not reflect our cash expenditures, or future requirements for capital expenditures and contractual commitments; |
| they do not reflect changes in, or cash requirements for, our working capital needs; |
| they do not reflect the significant interest expense, or the cash requirements necessary to service interest or principal payments on our debt; |
| although depreciation and amortization are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated and amortized will often have to be replaced in the future, and EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA do not reflect any cash requirements for such replacements; |
| Adjusted EBITDA does not reflect the impact of earnings or charges resulting from matters we consider not to be indicative of our ongoing operations, as discussed in our presentation of Adjusted EBITDA in this prospectus; and |
| other companies, including companies in our industry, may calculate these measures differently than we do, limiting their usefulness as comparative measures. |
Because of these limitations, EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA (and related ratios presented this prospectus) should not be considered as measures of discretionary cash available to us to invest in the growth of our business or reduce our indebtedness. We compensate for these limitations by relying primarily on our GAAP results and using EBIT, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA only supplementally. For more information, see our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.
37
The following is a reconciliation of cash flows provided by operating activities to EBIT, EBITDA and unaudited pro forma net income:
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended | Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||
December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Cash flows provided by operating activities
|
$ | 53,151 | $ | 56,413 | $ | 48,237 | $ | 46,909 | $ | 42,579 | |||||||||||
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
|
2,399 | (4,040 | ) | (1,102 | ) | (3,878 | ) | 3,299 | |||||||||||||
Non-cash expenses, including depreciation and
amortization
|
(44,760 | ) | (30,430 | ) | (42,194 | ) | (25,480 | ) | (18,492 | ) | |||||||||||
Income tax provision
|
5,802 | 6,304 | 4,321 | 4,417 | 7,076 | ||||||||||||||||
Interest expense
|
47,530 | 39,917 | 39,390 | 28,958 | 24,506 | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
EBIT
|
64,122 | 68,164 | 48,652 | 50,926 | 58,968 | ||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
25,372 | 17,898 | 18,359 | 14,049 | 13,141 | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
EBITDA
|
89,494 | 86,062 | 67,011 | 64,975 | 72,109 | ||||||||||||||||
Interest expense
|
(47,530 | ) | (39,917 | ) | (39,390 | ) | (28,958 | ) | (24,506 | ) | |||||||||||
Income tax provision and unaudited pro forma
incremental income tax provision
|
(8,424 | ) | (12,579 | ) | (5,728 | ) | (9,985 | ) | (15,451 | ) | |||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
(25,372 | ) | (17,898 | ) | (18,359 | ) | (14,049 | ) | (13,141 | ) | |||||||||||
Dividends and amortization of discount on
preferred members equity
|
(3,107 | ) | (3,291 | ) | (1,730 | ) | (1,730 | ) | | ||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Unaudited pro forma net income attributable to
common members
|
$ | 5,061 | $ | 12,377 | $ | 1,804 | $ | 10,253 | $ | 19,011 | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
The following is a reconciliation of net income to EBITDA and to Adjusted EBITDA:
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended | Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||
December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Net income
|
$ | 10,790 | $ | 21,943 | $ | 4,941 | $ | 17,551 | $ | 27,386 | |||||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
47,530 | 39,917 | 39,390 | 28,958 | 24,506 | ||||||||||||||||
Income tax provision
|
5,802 | 6,304 | 4,321 | 4,417 | 7,076 | ||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
25,372 | 17,898 | 18,359 | 14,049 | 13,141 | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
EBITDA
|
89,494 | 86,062 | 67,011 | 64,975 | 72,109 | ||||||||||||||||
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
|
| | 14,921 | | | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
$ | 89,494 | $ | 86,062 | $ | 81,932 | $ | 64,975 | $ | 72,109 | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
38
The following is a reconciliation of our net income margin to Adjusted EBIT margin and Adjusted EBITDA margin:
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended | Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||
December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
(unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Net income margin
|
2.6 | % | 5.2 | % | 1.2 | % | 5.5 | % | 8.1 | % | |||||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
11.3 | % | 9.5 | % | 9.5 | % | 9.2 | % | 7.3 | % | |||||||||||
Income tax provision
|
1.4 | % | 1.5 | % | 1.0 | % | 1.4 | % | 2.1 | % | |||||||||||
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
|
| | 3.6 | % | | | |||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBIT margin
|
15.2 | % | 16.3 | % | 15.3 | % | 16.1 | % | 17.5 | % | |||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
6.0 | % | 4.3 | % | 4.4 | % | 4.4 | % | 3.9 | % | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA margin
|
21.3 | % | 20.5 | % | 19.7 | % | 20.5 | % | 21.4 | % | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
Results of Operations
The following table provides information on the percentages of certain items of selected financial data compared to net sales for the periods indicated:
As a Percentage of Net Sales | |||||||||||||||||||||
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||||||
Fiscal Year Ended | Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||
December 31, | September 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
(unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Net sales
|
100.0 | % | 100.0 | % | 100.0 | % | 100.0 | % | 100.0 | % | |||||||||||
Cost of sales
|
57.9 | 59.1 | 60.6 | 60.2 | 58.5 | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Gross profit
|
42.1 | 40.9 | 39.4 | 39.9 | 41.5 | ||||||||||||||||
Selling, general and administrative expenses
|
24.4 | 24.3 | 24.3 | 24.1 | 24.1 | ||||||||||||||||
Amortization of intangibles
|
1.4 | 0.1 | | | | ||||||||||||||||
Costs incurred in connection with acquisition
activities
|
0.3 | 0.4 | | | | ||||||||||||||||
Write-off of intangible assets
|
0.8 | | | | | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Income from operations
|
15.2 | 16.1 | 15.1 | 15.8 | 17.4 | ||||||||||||||||
Other income
|
0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 0.3 | 0.2 | ||||||||||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
(11.3 | ) | (9.5 | ) | (9.5 | ) | (9.2 | ) | (7.3 | ) | |||||||||||
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
|
| | (3.6 | ) | | | |||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Income before income tax provision
|
4.0 | 6.7 | 2.2 | 6.9 | 10.3 | ||||||||||||||||
Income tax provision
|
(1.4 | ) | (1.5 | ) | (1.0 | ) | (1.4 | ) | (2.1 | ) | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||
Net income
|
2.6 | % | 5.2 | % | 1.2 | % | 5.5 | % | 8.1 | % | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
39
Nine Months Ended September 30, 2004 Compared to Nine Months Ended September 30, 2003 |
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||
Ended | |||||||||||||||||
September 30, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2003 | 2004 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Reprographics services
|
$ | 242.5 | $ | 253.4 | $ | 10.9 | 4.5 | % | |||||||||
Facilities management
|
42.7 | 53.7 | 11.0 | 25.8 | |||||||||||||
Equipment and supplies sales
|
31.1 | 29.2 | (1.9 | ) | (6.1 | ) | |||||||||||
Total net sales
|
$ | 316.3 | $ | 336.3 | $ | 20.0 | 6.3 | % | |||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
Gross profit
|
$ | 126.1 | $ | 139.6 | $ | 13.5 | 10.8 | % | |||||||||
Selling, general and administrative expenses
|
$ | 76.1 | $ | 81.2 | $ | 5.1 | 6.6 | % | |||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
$ | 29.0 | $ | 24.5 | $ | (4.5 | ) | (15.5 | )% | ||||||||
Income taxes
|
$ | 4.4 | $ | 7.1 | $ | 2.7 | 61.4 | % | |||||||||
Net income
|
$ | 17.6 | $ | 27.4 | $ | 9.8 | 55.7 | % | |||||||||
EBITDA
|
$ | 65.0 | $ | 72.1 | $ | 7.1 | 10.9 | % |
Net Sales. Net sales increased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same 2003 period primarily attributable to the improvement of the U.S. economy, particularly in the Western United States, acquisition activity, the expansion of our revenue base through the opening of new branches, and by increasing our market share in certain markets. Of the $20.0 million increase in our 2004 net sales, $17.1 million was attributable to organic revenue growth (which includes $2.5 million from the opening of new branches) and $2.9 million was attributable to our acquisition activity during 2003 and 2004. Prices during this period remained relatively stable, indicating that our revenue increases were primarily volume driven. As job creation in the United States continues to move forward, and commercial vacancy rates in the United States continue to decline, we expect to see similar revenue trends in our reprographics services.
While revenue from reprographics services and facilities management increased, our revenue generated from sales of equipment and supplies sales decreased. This was due to our ability to convert many of our equipment sales contracts into facilities management contracts. We believe that the recurring revenues from such facilities management contracts that span over several years should make our revenue profile more stable. This ability to convert our equipment sales contracts into facilities management contracts, coupled with the increased decentralized nature of the architectural, engineering and construction, or AEC industry, leads us to believe that facilities management revenue will continue to increase in the near term.
Net sales by geographic region were as follows:
Nine Months | |||||||||||||||||
Ended | |||||||||||||||||
September 30, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2003 | 2004 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Southern California
|
$ | 97.2 | $ | 105.2 | $ | 8.0 | 8.2 | % | |||||||||
Northern California
|
$ | 59.2 | $ | 64.1 | $ | 4.9 | 8.3 | % | |||||||||
Southern
|
$ | 46.7 | $ | 51.6 | $ | 4.9 | 10.5 | % | |||||||||
Midwest
|
$ | 41.4 | $ | 38.5 | $ | (2.9 | ) | (7.0 | )% | ||||||||
Northeast
|
$ | 53.3 | $ | 57.8 | $ | 4.5 | 8.4 | % | |||||||||
Pacific Northwest
|
$ | 18.5 | $ | 19.1 | $ | 0.6 | 3.2 | % | |||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
Total
|
$ | 316.3 | $ | 336.3 | |||||||||||||
|
|
40
The increase in net sales from our Southern California divisions in the 2004 period was driven by our efforts to capture market share combined with a strong local economy. The increase in net sales from our Northern California divisions in the 2004 period was due to improving economic conditions, business derived from new markets we entered, and increased market share. The increase in net sales from our Southern United States division in the 2004 period was driven by strong construction activity in Las Vegas and Tampa, partially offset by a 2.2% decline in net sales from our Houston divisions due to weak AEC activity in that market as a result of local corporate scandals that created an abundance of vacant office space. The decline in net sales from our Midwest divisions in the 2004 period was due to the continued softness in the manufacturing economy coupled with high unemployment rates in this regions major markets. The increase in net sales from our Northeast divisions in the 2004 period was due to new business gained from the purchase of facilities management customers from a competitor that filed for bankruptcy in New York in 2003. Excluding this purchase, net sales in the Northeast declined 1.1% due to the continued sluggish AEC economy in the Northeast since the 9/11 terrorist attacks.
Gross Profit. Our gross profit increased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 due primarily to the increase in our net sales coupled with the fixed cost nature of our leases for production equipment and facilities. The gross margin realized on our incremental sales increase during this period amounted to 67.5%. Our overall gross margin improved by approximately 1.6 percentage points to 41.5% for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to 39.9% in the comparable 2003 period. We were able to reduce our material cost as a percentage of net sales from 16.2% in the 2003 period to 15.4% in the 2004 period due to a negotiated reduction in the cost of material from one of our major vendors, coupled with better waste control procedures. Production labor cost as a percentage of net sales increased slightly from 21.4% in the 2003 period to 21.9% in the 2004 period due to the hiring of additional production labor in anticipation of continued revenue increases coupled with an increase in employee health benefits costs. Production overhead as a percent of revenue decreased from 22.6% in the nine months ended September 30, 2003 to 21.1% in 2004 due to the fixed cost nature of the expense coupled with the net sales increase.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses increased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same 2003 period primarily due to higher sales commissions related to increased sales and higher incentive bonus accruals during 2004 compared to 2003 related to improved operating results. As a percentage of net sales, selling, general and administrative expenses during the nine month periods ended September 30, 2003 and 2004 remained flat at 24.1%, despite the increase in net sales due to our larger sales force and increased selling and marketing activities during 2004 as we continued to pursue market share expansion. Our general and administrative expenses in the 2003 and 2004 nine month-periods included $0.6 million of management fees paid to CHS Management IV, L.P. in accordance with a management agreement entered into in connection with our recapitalization in 2000. These management fees will cease after our initial public offering. We expect that our selling, general and administrative expenses will increase in absolute dollars due to increased legal and accounting fees as a public company, including costs associated with evaluating and enhancing our internal control over financial reporting.
Interest Expense, Net. Net interest expense decreased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 due to the refinancing of our debt in December 2003, which lowered our overall effective interest rate in 2004 by approximately two percentage points. Also, since September 30, 2003, we have reduced our outstanding debt by $30.9 million. Partially offsetting these interest expense reductions was the additional interest expense recognized with the adoption of FAS 150. FAS 150 required that we treat our redeemable preferred stock as debt from the effective date of July 1, 2003. As a result, we incurred three months of this interest expense in 2003 amounting to $0.9 million, compared to nine months of interest expense amounting to $2.9 million for the same period in 2004.
41
During the nine months ended September 30, 2003, the interest benefit from our interest rate swap contracts was $4.0 million. The interest rate swap contracts expired in September 2003, and we entered into a new interest rate hedge in September 2003. This hedge instrument is accounted for as a hedge, and fluctuations in the market value of the hedge do not impact our income statement. Absent significant acquisition activity and continued increases in interest rates, we expect that our interest expense would decline as a result of the repayment of debt from the proceeds of this offering.
Income Taxes. Income tax provision increased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 primarily due to higher pretax income at the consolidated corporations. Our overall effective income tax rate for the 2004 period increased slightly to 20.5% compared to 20.1% in the comparable 2003 period. We expect our overall effective income tax rate to increase to approximately 43.0% due to our conversion to a corporation as part of this offering.
We provided for pro forma income taxes of $15.5 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 and $10.0 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2003. Our overall effective pro forma income tax rate for the same 2004 period was 44.8% as compared to 45.0% for the same period in 2003.
Net Income. Net income increased for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to the same period in 2003 primarily related to increased sales resulting from the improvement in the overall U.S. economy, increased AEC activity, as well as our reduced interest expense due to the refinancing of our debt in December 2003.
EBITDA. Our EBITDA margin increased to 21.4% in the nine months ended September 30, 2004 compared to 20.5% in the same 2003 period primarily due to higher revenues. For a reconciliation of EBITDA to pro forma net income, please see Non-GAAP Measures above.
Year Ended December 31, 2003 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2002 |
Year Ended | |||||||||||||||||
December 31, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2002 | 2003 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Reprographics services
|
$ | 324.4 | $ | 316.1 | $ | (8.3 | ) | (2.5 | )% | ||||||||
Facilities management
|
52.3 | 59.3 | 7.0 | 13.4 | |||||||||||||
Equipment and supplies sales
|
42.2 | 40.6 | (1.6 | ) | (3.8 | ) | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
Total net sales
|
$ | 418.9 | $ | 416.0 | $ | (2.9 | ) | (0.7 | )% | ||||||||
Gross profit
|
$ | 171.1 | $ | 163.9 | $ | (7.2 | ) | (0.4 | )% | ||||||||
Selling, general and administrative expenses
|
$ | 101.8 | $ | 101.3 | $ | (0.5 | ) | | % | ||||||||
Acquisition costs
|
$ | 1.5 | $ | | $ | (1.5 | ) | (100.0 | )% | ||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
$ | (39.9 | ) | $ | (39.4 | ) | $ | 0.5 | 1.3 | % | |||||||
Income taxes
|
$ | 6.3 | $ | 4.3 | $ | (2.0 | ) | (31.8 | )% | ||||||||
Net income
|
$ | 21.9 | $ | 4.9 | $ | (17.0 | ) | (77.6 | )% | ||||||||
EBITDA
|
$ | 86.1 | $ | 67.0 | $ | (19.1 | ) | (22.1 | )% | ||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
$ | 86.1 | $ | 81.9 | $ | (4.2 | ) | (0.5 | )% |
Net Sales. Net sales decreased in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to the continued slowdown in the economy and the AEC industry, particularly in our Northern California and Northeast divisions, and the continued pricing pressure on our sales due to reduction in activity levels due to contraction in the economy. As is typical in our industry, as the volume of reprographic business declines due to lower non-residential construction spending, we also saw prices decline. During this period, we experienced a contraction in the volume of reprographics work performed and
42
Net sales by geographic region were as follows:
Year Ended | |||||||||||||||||
December 31, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2002 | 2003 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Southern California
|
$ | 112.7 | $ | 127.6 | $ | 14.9 | 13.1 | % | |||||||||
Northern California
|
$ | 88.1 | $ | 77.5 | $ | (10.6 | ) | (12.1 | )% | ||||||||
Southern
|
$ | 62.4 | $ | 62.1 | $ | (0.3 | ) | (0.5 | )% | ||||||||
Midwest
|
$ | 53.9 | $ | 52.9 | $ | (1.0 | ) | (1.8 | )% | ||||||||
Northeast
|
$ | 77.4 | $ | 71.9 | $ | (5.5 | ) | (7.1 | )% | ||||||||
Pacific Northwest
|
$ | 24.3 | $ | 24.0 | $ | (0.3 | ) | (1.2 | )% | ||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
Total
|
$ | 418.9 | $ | 416.0 | |||||||||||||
|
|
The increase in net sales in our Southern California divisions was primarily due to the acquisition of Consolidated Reprographics in May 2002. The decline in net sales derived from our divisions located in Northern California was a result of the continued soft economy and high commercial vacancy rates created from the continued contraction in the internet and technology sectors. The decrease in net sales from our Northeast divisions in 2003 compared to 2002 was due to the economic slowdown in New York City and Washington, D.C. after the 9/11 terrorist attacks. Additionally, our Washington, D.C. division was negatively affected by the entry of another reprographics firm in this market.
Gross Profit. Our gross profit declined in 2003 compared to 2002 mainly due to lower net sales in 2003, particularly in Northern California and the Northeast where aggregate net sales in 2003 declined by $16.1 million, combined with strong pricing pressure which reduced our profit margins. Our overall gross profit margin declined by 1.5 percentage points to 39.4% in 2003 from 40.9% in 2002, driven primarily by the fixed cost nature of our equipment and facility leases. Production overhead as a percentage of net sales, which includes lease and maintenance costs, increased from 17.5% in 2002 to 19.0% in 2003. Additionally, our cost of production labor increased $364,000 due to increased health and workers compensation insurance rates. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in our material cost as a percentage of net sales.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses for 2003 remained flat compared to 2002, despite the decrease in our net sales and gross profit, because we pursued market share expansion amid difficult industry conditions. As a result, our selling and marketing expenses increased by $1.0 million in 2003 compared to 2002 despite lower net sales in 2003. This was offset by a $2.5 million decrease in general and administrative expenses in 2003, which was primarily due to lower incentive bonus accruals resulting from the decline in our operating results. Our general and administrative expenses in 2003 included $858,000 of management fees.
Acquisition Costs. There were no costs incurred in connection with acquisition activities during 2003 that could not be capitalized into goodwill. The acquisition costs expensed in 2002 related to signing bonuses to the senior management of a division acquired in 2002.
Interest Expense, Net. Net interest expense increased in 2003 due primarily to a net interest benefit from our interest rate swap contracts of $4.0 million in 2003 compared to a net interest
43
Income Taxes. Our income tax provision decreased for 2003 primarily due to lower pretax income at the consolidated corporations. Our overall effective income tax rate was 22.3% in 2002 and 46.7% in 2003. The effective rate increased due to $1.8 million of nondeductible interest expense on our preferred units and a higher overall effective state income tax rate due to a loss on early extinguishments of debts in the parent company that was not deductible for tax purposes by our subsidiaries outside of California.
We provided for pro forma income taxes of $5.7 million for 2003 as compared to $12.6 million in 2002 due to a loss on early extinguishments of debts in 2003. However, our overall effective pro forma income tax rate was 44.5% in 2002 compared to 61.8% in 2003 as explained above.
Net Income. Net income decreased for 2003 compared to 2002 primarily related to a $14.9 million loss related to the early extinguishment of debt in connection with our debt refinancing in December 2003.
EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA. EBITDA as a percentage of net sales for 2003 decreased to 16.1% from 20.5% for 2002 primarily as a result of the $14.9 million of loss from early extinguishment of debt, which we incurred as part of our debt refinancing in December 2003. Our Adjusted EBITDA for 2003, which excludes this early extinguishment charge, was $81.9 million, or 19.7% of net sales compared to 20.5% for 2002. Our EBITDA margin decreased in 2003 from 2002 primarily because of lower revenues. For a reconciliation of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to pro forma net income, please see Non-GAAP Measures above.
Year Ended December 31, 2002 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2001 |
Year Ended | |||||||||||||||||
December 31, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Reprographics services
|
$ | $338.1 | $ | 324.4 | $ | (13.7 | ) | (4.0 | )% | ||||||||
Facilities management
|
39.9 | 52.3 | 12.4 | 31.1 | % | ||||||||||||
Equipment and supplies sales
|
42.7 | 42.2 | (0.5 | ) | (1.2 | )% | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
Total net sales
|
$ | 420.7 | $ | 418.9 | $ | (1.8 | ) | (0.4 | )% | ||||||||
Gross profit
|
$ | 177.0 | $ | 171.1 | $ | (5.9 | ) | (0.3 | )% | ||||||||
Selling, general and administrative expenses
|
$ | 102.6 | $ | 101.8 | $ | (0.8 | ) | (0.8 | )% | ||||||||
Amortization of intangibles
|
$ | 5.7 | $ | 0.2 | $ | (5.5 | ) | (96.5 | )% | ||||||||
Acquisition costs
|
$ | 1.4 | $ | 1.5 | $ | 0.1 | 5.0 | % | |||||||||
Interest expense, net
|
$ | 47.5 | $ | 39.9 | $ | (7.6 | ) | (16.0 | )% | ||||||||
Income taxes
|
$ | 5.8 | $ | 6.3 | $ | 0.5 | 0.9 | % | |||||||||
Net income
|
$ | 10.8 | $ | 21.9 | $ | 11.1 | 102.8 | % | |||||||||
EBITDA
|
$ | 89.5 | $ | 86.1 | $ | (3.4 | ) | (3.8 | )% |
Net Sales. Net sales decreased in 2002 compared to 2001 due to the continued downturn in the economy generally and the AEC industry in particular and continued pricing pressure on our sales. Our net sales decreased during this period despite our acquisition of Consolidated Reprographics and seven other smaller reprographics companies in 2002. Excluding net sales related to businesses acquired during 2002 and 2001, net sales from our operations decreased by
44
Net sales by geographic region were as follows:
Year Ended | |||||||||||||||||
December 31, | Increase (decrease) | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | (In dollars) | (Percent) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(In millions) | |||||||||||||||||
Southern California
|
$ | 90.6 | $ | 112.7 | $ | 22.1 | (24.4 | )% | |||||||||
Northern California
|
$ | 101.8 | $ | 88.1 | $ | (13.7 | ) | (13.5 | )% | ||||||||
Southern
|
$ | 63.0 | $ | 62.4 | $ | (0.6 | ) | (1.0 | )% | ||||||||
Midwest
|
$ | 53.5 | $ | 53.9 | $ | 0.4 | 0.7 | % | |||||||||
Northeast
|
$ | 85.6 | $ | 77.4 | $ | (8.2 | ) | (9.6 | )% | ||||||||
Pacific Northwest
|
$ | 26.2 | $ | 24.3 | $ | (1.9 | ) | (7.2 | )% | ||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||
Total
|
$ | 420.7 | $ | 418.9 | |||||||||||||
|
|
The decline in net sales from our divisions located in Southern California, Northern California, the Pacific Northwest, and the Northeast, excluding 2002 acquisitions, was attributable to the nationwide softness in the economy, which fueled unemployment and high non-residential vacancy rates.
Gross Profit. Our gross profit decreased in 2002 from 2001 due primarily to lower net sales in 2002. Our overall gross profit margin declined by 1.2 percentage points to 40.9% in 2002 from 42.1% in 2001, driven primarily by the fixed-cost nature of our leases for production equipment and facilities. Production overhead as a percentage of net sales, which includes lease and maintenance costs, increased from 15.6% in 2001 to 17.5% in 2002. This increase was partially offset by a decrease in our material cost as a percentage of net sales, caused by the lower cost of paper.
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses. Selling, general and administrative expenses decreased in 2002 compared to 2001 due to cost savings from the elimination of certain redundant administrative offices during late 2001, which offset increases in our legal fees in 2002 compared to 2001 as a result of the investigation of our company by the Federal Trade Commission that was triggered by the Consolidated Reprographics acquisition and litigation that we pursued against certain competitors. Both of these matters have been concluded. As a percentage of net sales, selling, general and administrative expenses for 2002 decreased slightly to 24.3% from 24.4% in 2001. Our general and administrative expenses in 2002 included $889,000 of management fees.
Amortization of Intangibles. Amortization of intangibles decreased in 2002 compared to 2001 due to our discontinuing the amortization of goodwill pursuant to our adoption of SFAS No. 142 as of January 1, 2002. In 2001, we wrote off $3.4 million of goodwill relating to a business acquired in 2000, which was subsequently closed in 2001 due to underperformance.
Acquisition Costs. The increase in costs incurred in connection with acquisition activities for 2002 from 2001 was due to costs expensed in 2002 for bonuses to the senior management of a division acquired in 2002. In 2001, these costs represented a bonus paid to the president of a division acquired in 2000. See note 2 to our consolidated financial statements.
Interest Expense, Net. Net interest expense decreased in 2002 compared to 2001 due to lower average borrowings and interest rates throughout 2002 as compared to 2001 and a net interest benefit from our interest rate swap contracts of $1.6 million compared to a net interest expense from our swap contracts of $5.6 million in 2001. The decrease was partially offset by additional borrowings incurred in May 2002 to finance the acquisition of Consolidated Reprographics, the addition of new capital leases, and higher interest expense from Holdings previously outstanding
45
Income Taxes. Our income tax provision increased in 2002 compared to 2001 due to higher pretax income at the consolidated corporations. Our overall effective income tax rate for 2002 decreased to 22.3% as compared to 35.0% in 2001 due to the write off of non-deductible goodwill in 2001, as well as the impact of the SFAS No. 133 transition adjustment.
We provided for pro forma income taxes of $12.6 million for 2002 and $8.4 million for 2001. Our overall effective pro forma income tax rate was 44.5% in 2002 compared to 50.8% in 2001 due to nondeductible goodwill amortization in 2001 and not in 2002. Goodwill ceased to be amortized in 2002 due to our adoption of SFAS No. 142 as of January 1, 2002.
Net Income. Net income increased for 2002 from 2001 primarily due to a $7.2 million improvement in interest income related to an interest rate swap contract and a decrease of $5.5 million related to discontinuing the amortization of goodwill pursuant to our adoption of SFAS No. 142 as of January 1, 2002.
EBITDA. The decrease in EBITDA for 2002 compared to 2001 and the decrease in EBITDA as a percentage of net sales for 2002 to 20.5% from 21.3% for 2001 were primarily as a result of lower revenues. For a reconciliation of EBITDA to pro forma net income, please see Non-GAAP Measures above.
Quarterly Results of Operations
The following table sets forth certain quarterly financial data for the seven quarters ended September 30, 2004. This quarterly information is unaudited, has been prepared on the same basis as the annual financial statements and, in our opinion, reflects all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring accruals, necessary for a fair presentation of the information for periods presented. Operating results for any quarter are not necessarily indicative of results for any future period.
Quarter Ended | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Mar. 31, | June 30, | Sept. 30, | Dec. 31, | Mar. 31, | June 30, | Sept. 30, | |||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
2003 | 2004 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited, dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Reprographics services
|
$ | 81,301 | $ | 83,794 | $ | 77,411 | $ | 73,489 | $ | 84,170 | $ | 87,237 | $ | 81,958 | |||||||||||||||
Facilities management
|
13,644 | 14,448 | 14,628 | 16,592 | 16,529 | 17,954 | 19,254 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Equipment and supplies sales
|
10,327 | 10,640 | 10,145 | 9,541 | 9,819 | 10,424 | 8,953 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Total net sales
|
$ | 105,272 | $ | 108,882 | $ | 102,184 | $ | 99,622 | $ | 110,518 | $ | 115,615 | $ | 110,165 | |||||||||||||||
Gross profit
|
$ | 42,292 | $ | 44,551 | $ | 39,229 | $ | 37,860 | $ | 45,919 | $ | 49,424 | $ | 44,287 | |||||||||||||||
Income from operations
|
$ | 17,014 | $ | 18,718 | $ | 14,114 | $ | 12,703 | $ | 18,986 | $ | 21,039 | $ | 18,369 | |||||||||||||||
EBITDA
|
$ | 21,989 | $ | 23,889 | $ | 19,097 | $ | 2,036 | $ | 23,376 | $ | 25,839 | $ | 22,894 | |||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
$ | 21,989 | $ | 23,889 | $ | 19,097 | $ | 16,957 | $ | 23,376 | $ | 25,839 | $ | 22,894 | |||||||||||||||
Net income (loss)
|
$ | 5,469 | $ | 9,237 | $ | 2,845 | $ | (12,610 | ) | $ | 8,729 | $ | 10,441 | $ | 8,216 |
46
The following is a reconciliation of Adjusted EBITDA and EBITDA to net income (loss) for each respective quarter.
Quarter Ended | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Mar. 31, | June 30, | Sept. 30, | Dec. 31, | Mar. 31, | June 30, | Sept. 30, | ||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||
2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Unaudited, dollars in thousands) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted EBITDA
|
$ | 21,989 | $ | 23,889 | $ | 19,097 | $ | 16,957 | $ | 23,376 | $ | 25,839 | $ | 22,894 | ||||||||||||||
Loss on early extinguishment of debt
|
| | | (14,921 | ) | | | | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||
EBITDA
|
21,989 | 23,889 | 19,097 | 2,036 | 23,376 | 25,839 | 22,894 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Interest expense
|
(9,317 | ) | (8,799 | ) | (10,842 | ) | (10,432 | ) | (7,984 | ) | (8,264 | ) | (8,258 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Income tax benefit (provision)
|
(2,428 | ) | (1,213 | ) | (776 | ) | 96 | (2,547 | ) | (2,627 | ) | (1,902 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Depreciation and amortization
|
(4,775 | ) | (4,640 | ) | (4,634 | ) | (4,310 | ) | (4,116 | ) | (4,507 | ) | (4,518 | ) | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||||||||||
Net income (loss)
|
$ | 5,469 | $ | 9,237 | $ | 2,845 | $ | (12,610 | ) | $ | 8,729 | $ | 10,441 | $ | 8,216 | |||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We believe that quarterly revenues and operating results may vary significantly in the future and that quarter-to-quarter comparisons of our results of operations are not necessarily meaningful and should not be relied upon as indications of future performance. In addition, our quarterly operating results are typically affected by seasonal factors, primarily the number of working days in a quarter. Historically, our fourth quarter is the slowest, reflecting the slowdown in construction activity during the holiday season, and our second quarter is the strongest, reflecting the fewest holidays and best weather compared to the other quarters.
Impact of Inflation
Inflation has not had a significant effect on our operations. Price increases for raw materials such as paper typically have been, and we expect will continue to be, passed on to customers in the ordinary course of business.
Liquidity and Capital Resources |
Our principal sources of cash have been cash provided by operations and borrowings under our bank credit facilities or debt agreements. Our historical uses of cash have been for acquisitions of reprographics businesses, payment of principal and interest on outstanding debt obligations, capital expenditures and tax-related distributions to our LLC members. Supplemental information pertaining to our historical sources and uses of cash is presented as follows and should be read in
47
Nine Months | ||||||||||||||||
Year Ended December 31, | Ended | |||||||||||||||
|
September 30, | |||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2004 | |||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | ||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | ||||||||||||||||
Net cash provided by operating activities
|
$ | 53,151 | $ | 56,413 | $ | 48,237 | $ | 42,579 | ||||||||
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Net cash used in investing activities
|
$ | (37,065 | ) | $ | (45,918 | ) | $ | (8,336 | ) | $ | (7,611 | ) | ||||
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||
Net cash used in financing activities
|
$ | (18,541 | ) | $ | (14,610 | ) | $ | (47,581 | ) | $ | (40,275 | ) | ||||
|
|
|
|
Operating Activities |
Net cash provided by operating activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 primarily related to net income of $27.4 million, depreciation and amortization of $13.1 million, non-cash interest expense of $3.3 million from the amortization of deferred financing costs and the accretion of yield on our mandatorily redeemable preferred members equity, and an increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses of $7.5 million primarily due to the timing of payments on trade payables, incentive bonus accruals to be paid at year end, and the higher volume of business activity in 2004. These factors were offset by the growth in accounts receivables of $10.3 million primarily related to increased sales during 2004.
Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2003 primarily related to net income of $4.9 million, depreciation and amortization of $18.4 million, non-cash interest expense of $11.1 million from the accretion of yield on our Holdings notes and our mandatorily redeemable preferred members equity and the amortization of deferred financing costs, the write-off of unamortized debt discount and deferred financing costs of $9.0 million as a result of our debt refinancing in December 2003, a decrease in accounts receivable of $1.8 million and a $1.0 million decrease in inventory.
Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2002 primarily related to net income of $21.9 million, depreciation and amortization of $17.9 million, non-cash interest expense of $11.1 million from the accretion of yield on our Holdings notes and the amortization of deferred financing costs, a $2.1 million decrease in prepaid expenses and other current assets, a $0.7 million decrease in inventory, and a $2.7 million increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses.
Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2001 primarily related to net income of $10.8 million, depreciation and amortization of $25.3 million (which includes a write off of $3.4 million of goodwill), non-cash interest expense of $16.5 million from the accretion of yield on our Holdings notes and the amortization of deferred financing costs, a $5.3 million decrease in accounts receivable due to strong cash collections during the second half of 2001, deferred income tax provision of $2.2 million, a $1.4 million decrease in inventory, and a $1.4 million decrease in prepaid expenses and other current assets. These factors were offset by a $10.5 million decrease in accounts payable and accrued expenses primarily due to acquisition earnout payments paid during 2001 which were accrued during the prior year.
Investing Activities |
Net cash used in investing activities primarily relates to acquisition of businesses and capital expenditures. Payments for businesses acquired, net of cash acquired and including other cash
48
Financing Activities |
Net cash used in financing activities primarily relates to payments on long-term debt under our debt agreements and cash distributions to members. These are offset mainly by the proceeds from borrowings under our debt agreements. Cash used in financing activities for the nine months ended September 30, 2004 included $36.2 million of repayments under our debt agreements and $4.7 million in cash distributions to members. Cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2003 included $375.6 million of repayments on our prior credit facilities, an $8.1 million payment of loan fees related to our debt refinancing and $1.7 million in cash distributions to members. These were offset by $337.8 million in borrowings under our new credit facilities in December 2003. Cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2002 included $35.5 million of repayments on our debt agreements and $10.2 million in cash distributions to members (including $6.3 million of cash paid to redeem certain of the Companys common membership units), partially offset by $32.0 million in borrowings under our debt agreements. Cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2001 included $20.4 million of repayments under our debt agreements and $3.4 million of cash distributions to members, offset by $5.2 million of proceeds from borrowings under our debt agreements.
Our cash position, working capital and debt obligations as of December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 and September 30, 2004 are shown below and should be read in conjunction with our consolidated balance sheets and notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.
December 31, | |||||||||||||||||
|
September 30, | ||||||||||||||||
2001 | 2002 | 2003 | 2004 | ||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
(Unaudited) | |||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | |||||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents
|
$ | 29,110 | $ | 24,995 | $ | 17,315 | $ | 12,008 | |||||||||
Working capital
|
24,338 | 24,371 | 16,809 | 28,333 | |||||||||||||
Mandatorily redeemable preferred and common
membership units
|
30,116 | 23,903 | 25,791 | 27,285 | |||||||||||||
Other debt obligations
|
364,738 | 378,608 | 359,340 | 331,100 | |||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||
Total debt obligations
|
$ | 394,854 | $ | 402,511 | $ | 385,131 | $ | 358,385 |
Debt obligations as of December 31, 2003 and September 30, 2004 include $25.8 million and $27.3 million of redeemable preferred equity which has been reclassified in our financial statements as a component of our total debt upon our adoption of SFAS No. 150 in July 2003. Debt obligations as of December 31, 2001 included $8.1 million of redeemable common membership units.
We expect a positive impact on our liquidity and results of operations going forward upon the completion of our initial public offering due to lower interest expense as net proceeds of approximately $104.5 million from the sale of our common stock will be used to reduce our existing debt obligations. Our overall interest expense may also be reduced as rates applicable to future borrowings on our revolving credit facility may decrease since the margin for loans made under the revolving facility is based on the ratio of our consolidated indebtedness to our consolidated adjusted EBITDA (as defined in our credit facilities). The applicable margin on our revolving facility ranges between 2.00% and 2.75% for LIBOR rate loans and ranges between 1.00% and 1.75% for index rate loans. In addition, the termination of our management agreement with CHS Management IV, L.P. upon the completion of our initial public offering will positively impact our future results of
49
These positive factors will be offset to a certain extent by rising market interest rates on our debt obligations under our senior secured credit facilities which are subject to variable interest rates. As discussed in Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk, we had $385.1 million of total debt outstanding as of December 31, 2003 of which $340.0 million was bearing interest at variable rates. A 1.0% change in interest rates on variable rate debt would have resulted in interest expense fluctuating by approximately $2.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2003.
We believe that our cash flow provided by operations will be adequate to cover our 2005 working capital needs, debt service requirements and planned capital expenditures to the extent such items are known or are reasonably determinable based on current business and market conditions. However, we may elect to finance certain of our capital expenditure requirements through borrowings under our credit facilities or the issuance of additional debt.
We continually evaluate potential acquisitions. Absent a compelling strategic reason, we expect that all future acquisitions will be cash flow accretive within six months. Currently, we are not party to any agreements or engaged in any negotiations regarding a material acquisition. We expect to fund future acquisitions through cash flow provided by operations, additional borrowings or the issuance of our equity. The extent to which we will be willing or able to use our equity or a mix of equity and cash payments to make acquisitions will depend on the market value of our shares from time to time and the willingness of potential sellers to accept equity as full or partial payment.
Debt Obligations
Senior Secured Credit Facilities. We have two senior secured credit facilities: a $130 million senior first priority secured facility, or first priority facility, and a $225 million senior second priority secured facility, or second priority facility. Our first priority facility consists of a $100 million senior first priority secured term loan facility, or term facility, and a $30 million senior first priority secured revolving credit facility, or revolving facility. Our second priority facility consists of a $225 million senior second priority secured term loan facility. The proceeds of the term facility and a portion of the revolving facility, together with substantially all of the proceeds of the second priority facility, were used to refinance our then existing debt in December 2003. We may use amounts remaining available under the revolving facility for working capital, certain permitted acquisitions and general corporate purposes. See Description of Certain Indebtedness.
The term facility matures in June 2009, the revolving facility matures in December 2008 and the second priority facility matures in December 2009. Opcos obligations under each of the credit facilities are guaranteed by Holdings and each of its domestic subsidiaries. In addition, subject to limited exceptions, the first priority facility is secured by first priority security interests in all of Opcos assets and the assets of Holdings and its domestic subsidiaries and 65% of the assets of its foreign subsidiary. The second priority facility is secured by second priority security interests in the assets securing the first priority facility. The priority of the security interests and related creditor rights between the first priority facility and the second priority facility are subject to an intercreditor agreement.
Loans made under the credit facilities bear interest at a floating rate and may be maintained as index rate loans or as LIBOR rate loans. Index rate loans bear interest at the index rate plus the applicable index rate margin, as described in the first priority facility. Index rate is defined as the higher of (1) the rate of interest publicly quoted from time to time by The Wall Street Journal as the base rate on corporate loans posted by at least 75% of the nations 30 largest banks, and (2) the
50
The applicable margin with respect to the term facility is 2.00% in the case of index rate loans and 3.00% in the case of LIBOR rate loans. The applicable margin for the revolving facility is determined by a grid based on the ratio of our consolidated indebtedness to our consolidated adjusted EBITDA (as defined in our credit facilities) for the most recently ended four fiscal quarters and range between 2.00% and 2.75% for LIBOR rate loans and range between 1.00% and 1.75% for index rate loans.
The applicable margin with respect to loans made under the second priority facility is 5.875% in the case of index rate loans and 6.875% in the case of LIBOR rate loans; provided, that, if the ratio of our consolidated indebtedness over our consolidated adjusted EBITDA (as defined in our credit facilities) is greater than 4.8:1.0 for any four fiscal quarters, each of the applicable margins set forth above will be increased by 100 basis points. In addition to the foregoing, loans made under the second priority facility are issued at a discount of 1.0% to the face amount.
The following table sets forth the outstanding balance, borrowing capacity and applicable interest rate under our senior secured credit facilities. Subsequent to September 30, 2004, we repaid $4.2 million under our term facility and $5.1 million under our second priority facility.
As of December 31, 2003 | As of September 30, 2004 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||||
Available | Available | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Borrowing | Interest | Borrowing | Interest | |||||||||||||||||||||
Balance | Capacity | Rate | Balance | Capacity | Rate | |||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||
(unaudited) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
(Dollars in thousands) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Term facility
|
$ | 100,000 | $ | | 5.75% | $ | 99,250 | $ | | 4.84% | ||||||||||||||
Revolving facility
|
15,000 | 15,000 | 5.75% | | 30,000 | | ||||||||||||||||||
Second priority facility, excluding debt discount
|
225,000 | | 9.8% | 213,364 | | 8.63% | ||||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
$ | 340,000 | $ | 15,000 | $ | 312,614 | $ | 30,000 | |||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
In addition, under the revolving facility, we are required to pay a fee equal to 0.50% of the total unused commitment amount. We may also draw upon this credit facility through letters of credit which carry specific fees.
Redeemable Preferred Units. As of September 30, 2004, we had $27.3 million of redeemable, non-voting preferred membership units. Holders of the redeemable preferred units are entitled to receive a yield of 13.25% of its liquidation value per annum for the first three years starting in April 2000, and increasing to 15% of the liquidation value per annum thereafter. The discount inherent in the yield for the first three years was recorded as an adjustment to the carrying amount of the redeemable preferred units. This discount was amortized as a dividend over the initial three years. Of the total yield on the redeemable preferred units, 48% is mandatorily payable quarterly in cash to the redeemable preferred unit holders. The unpaid portion of the yield accumulates annually and is added to the liquidation value of the redeemable preferred units. The preferred units are redeemable without premium or penalty, wholly or in part, at Holdings option at any time, for the liquidation value, including any unpaid yield. The preferred units are mandatorily redeemable on the closing of this offering to the extent of 25% of the net proceeds from this offering.
Seller Notes. As of September 30, 2004, we had $5.0 million of seller notes outstanding, with interest rates ranging between 7.0% and 8.0% and maturities between 2004 and 2007. These notes were issued in connection with prior acquisitions.
51
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
At December 31, 2003 and 2002, we did not
have any relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial
partnerships, such as entities often referred to as structured
finance or special purpose entities, which would have been
established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet
arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes.
Contractual Obligations and Other
Commitments
Our future contractual obligations as of
September 30, 2004 by fiscal year are as follows:
Three Months
Ending
Twelve Months Ending December 31,
December 31,
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
Thereafter
(Dollars in thousands)
$
1,005
$
3,722
$
1,696
$
635
$
47,875
$
288,138
1,780
6,174
3,907
2,231
944
278
9,064
29,516
19,760
12,884
8,428
20,291
$
11,849
$
39,412
$
25,363
$
15,750
$
57,247
$
308,707
Operating Leases. We have entered into various noncancelable operating leases primarily related to facilities, equipment and vehicles used in the ordinary course of our business.
Contingent Transaction Consideration. We have entered into earnout agreements in connection with prior acquisitions. If the acquired businesses generate operating profits in excess of pre-determined targets, we are obligated to make additional cash payments in accordance with the terms of such earnout agreements. As of September 30, 2004, we estimate that we will be required to make additional cash payments of up to $822,000 between 2004 to 2007. These additional cash payments are accounted for as goodwill when earned.
We are involved in a dispute with a state tax authority related to an unresolved sales tax issue which arose from such state tax authoritys audit findings from their sales tax audit of certain of our operating divisions for the period from October 1998 to September 2001. The unresolved issue relates to the application of sales taxes on certain discounts we granted to our customers. Based on the position taken by the state tax authority on this unresolved issue, they have claimed that an additional $1.2 million of sales taxes are due from us for the period in question, plus approximately $0.4 million of interest. We strongly disagree with the state tax authoritys position and have filed a petition for redetermination requesting an appeals conference to resolve this issue. A date for the appeals conference originally scheduled in July 2004 has been postponed at the request of the state tax authority to December 14, 2004. The accrued expenses in our consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2003 and September 30, 2004 each include approximately $0.2 million of reserves related to this unresolved matter.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk
Our primary exposure to market risk is interest rate risk associated with our debt instruments. We use both fixed and variable rate debt as sources of financing. In September 2003, we entered into an interest rate hedge agreement with a notional amount of $111.2 million to reduce our exposure to fluctuations in interest rates. Under the hedge agreement, we pay a fixed rate of 2.29% and we receive a variable rate equal to the 1-month LIBOR rate. The difference between the fixed and variable rates is settled monthly and is recognized as an increase or decrease in interest expense. The notional amount of the hedge agreement is reduced quarterly by an amount equal to
52
In January 2004, we entered into two interest rate collar agreements, referred to as the front-end and the back-end interest rate collar agreements. The front-end interest rate collar agreement has an initial notional amount of $22.6 million which is increased quarterly to reflect reductions in the notional amount of our interest rate swap agreement, such that the notional amount of the swap agreement, together with the notional amount of the front-end interest rate collar agreement, remains not less than 40% of the aggregate principal amount outstanding on our senior credit facilities. The front-end interest rate collar agreement expires in September 2005. The back-end interest rate collar agreement becomes effective upon expiration of the swap agreement and front-end interest rate collar agreement in September 2005 and has a fixed notional amount of $111.0 million. The back-end interest rate collar agreement expires in December 2006. At September 30, 2004, the fair value of these interest rate collar agreements was $(405,000).
At December 31, 2003, we had $385.1 million of total debt outstanding of which $340.0 million was bearing interest at variable rates approximating 8.5%. A 1.0% change in interest rates on variable rate debt would have resulted in interest expense fluctuating by approximately $2.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2003.
We have not, and do not plan to, enter into any derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes. As of December 31, 2003, we had no other significant material exposure to market risk, including foreign exchange risk and commodity risks.
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
In April 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 145, Rescission of FASB Statements No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of FASB Statement No. 13, and Technical Corrections. SFAS No. 145 updates, clarifies, and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements. This statement rescinds SFAS No. 4, which required all gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of related income tax effect. As a result, the criteria in Accounting Principles Board No. 30 will now be used to classify those gains and losses. SFAS No. 64 amended SFAS No. 4 and is no longer necessary as SFAS No. 4 has been rescinded. SFAS No. 44 has been rescinded as it is no longer necessary. SFAS No. 145 amends SFAS No. 13 to require that certain lease modifications that have economic effects similar to sale-leaseback transactions be accounted for in the same manner as sale-lease transactions. This statement also makes technical corrections to existing pronouncements. While those corrections are not substantive in nature, in some instances, they may change accounting practice. Our adoption of SFAS No. 145 did not have a material impact on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
In June 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 146, Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities. SFAS No. 146 nullifies Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 94-3, Liability Recognition for Certain Employee Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity, under which a liability for an exit cost was recognized as of the date of an entitys commitment to an exit plan. SFAS No. 146 requires that a liability for a cost associated with an exit or disposal activity be recognized at fair value when the liability is incurred. Our adoption of this standard effective January 1, 2003 had no impact on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
In November 2002, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 45 (FIN 45), Guarantors Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others. This interpretation elaborates on disclosures required in financial statements concerning obligations under certain guarantees. It also clarifies the requirements related to the recognition of liabilities by a guarantor at the inception of certain guarantees. Our adoption of FIN 45 did not have a material impact on our financial position or results of operations or cash flows.
53
In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation Transition and Disclosure, an amendment of SFAS No. 123. SFAS No. 148 provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary change to the fair value based method of accounting for stock-based employee compensation. In addition, SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of SFAS No. 123 to require more prominent and more frequent disclosures in financial statements about the effects of stock-based compensation. This statement is effective for financial statements for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002. Our adoption of SFAS No. 148 did not have any impact on our financial statements as management does not have any intention to change to the fair value method.
In January 2003, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities, which addresses the consolidation of business enterprises (variable interest entities) to which the usual condition (ownership of a majority voting interest) of consolidation does not apply. The interpretation focuses on financial interests that indicate control. It concludes that in the absence of clear control through voting interests, a companys exposure (variable interest) to the economic risks and potential rewards from the variable interest entitys assets and activities are the best evidence of control. Variable interests are rights and obligations that convey economic gains or losses from changes in the values of the variable interest entitys assets and liabilities. Variable interests may arise from financial instruments, service contracts, nonvoting ownership interests and other arrangements. If an enterprise holds a majority of the variable interests of an entity, it would be considered the primary beneficiary. The primary beneficiary would be required to include the assets, liabilities and the results of operations of the variable interest entity in its financial statements. In December 2003, the FASB issued a revision to FIN 46 to address certain implementation issues. The adoption of FIN 46 and FIN 46 (revised) had no material impact on our results of operations, financial position or cash flows.
In April 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 149, Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities. SFAS No. 149 amends and clarifies the financial accounting and reporting of derivative instruments, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other contracts (collectively referred to as derivatives) and for hedging activities under SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities. This Statement is effective for contracts entered into or modified after June 30, 2003, except for certain hedging relationships designated after June 30, 2003. The adoption of SFAS No. 149 did not have a material effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
In May 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of Both Liabilities and Equity (SFAS 150). SFAS 150 requires issuers to classify as liabilities (or assets in some circumstances) three classes of freestanding financial instruments that embody obligations for the issuer. SFAS 150 is effective for financial instruments entered into or modified after May 31, 2003, and is otherwise effective at the beginning of the first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. We adopted SFAS 150 on July 1, 2003, which resulted in classifying mandatorily redeemable preferred stock as a liability in the balance sheet and related accretion being charged to interest expense in the statement of operations. See Note 1 to our consolidated financial statements for more detail.
54
BUSINESS
Our Company
We are the leading reprographics company in the United States providing business-to-business document management services to the architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry. We also provide these services to companies in non-AEC industries, such as technology, financial services, retail, entertainment, and food and hospitality, that also require sophisticated document management services. Reprographics services typically encompass the digital management and reproduction of construction documents or other graphics-related material and the corresponding finishing and distribution services. The business-to-business services we provide to our customers include document management, document distribution and logistics , and print-on-demand . We provide our core services through our suite of reprographics technology products, a network of 174 locally branded reprographics service centers, and more than 1,560 facilities management programs at our customers locations throughout the country. We also sell reprographics equipment and supplies to complement our full range of service offerings. In further support of our core services, we license our suite of reprographics technology products, including our flagship internet-based application, PlanWell, to independent reprographers. We also operate PEiR (Profit and Education in Reprographics) through which we charge membership fees and provide purchasing, technology and educational benefits to other reprographers, while promoting our reprographics technology as the industry standard. Our services are critical to our customers because they shorten their document processing and distribution time, improve the quality of their document information management, and provide a secure, controlled document management environment.
We operate 174 reprographics service centers, including 171 service centers in 133 cities in 29 states throughout the United States and three reprographics service centers in the Toronto metropolitan area. Our reprographics service centers are located in close proximity to the majority of our customers and offer pickup and delivery services within a 15 to 30 mile radius. These service centers are arranged in a hub and satellite structure and are digitally connected as a cohesive network, allowing us to provide our services both locally and nationally. We service more than 65,000 active customers and employ over 3,450 people, including a sales force of approximately 270 employees.
In terms of revenue, number of service facilities and number of customers, we believe we are the largest company in our industry, operating in more than eight times as many cities and with more than five times the number of service facilities as our next largest competitor. We believe that our national footprint, our suite of reprographics technology products, and our value-added services, including logistics and facilities management, provide us with a distinct competitive advantage.
While we began our operations in California and currently derive approximately half of our net sales from our operations in the state, we have continued to expand our geographic coverage and market share by entering complementary markets through strategic acquisitions of high quality companies with well recognized local brand names and, in most cases, more than 25 years of operating history. Since 1997, we have acquired 81 companies and have retained approximately 93% of the management of the acquired companies. As part of our growth strategy, we have recently begun opening and operating branch service centers, which we view as a low cost, rapid form of market expansion. Our branch openings require modest capital expenditures and are expected to generate operating profit within 12 months from opening. We have opened 17 new branches in key markets since September 2003 and expect to open an additional 15 branches by the end of the first quarter of 2005.
55
Corporate Background and Reorganization
Our predecessor, Ford Graphics, was founded in Los Angeles, California in 1960. In 1967, this sole proprietorship was dissolved and a new corporate structure was established under the name Micro Device, Inc., which continued to provide reprographics services under the name Ford Graphics. In 1989, our current senior management team purchased Micro Device, Inc., and in November 1997 our company was recapitalized as a California limited liability company, with management retaining a 50% ownership position and the remainder owned by outside investors. In February 2000, Code Hennessy & Simmons IV, L.P., or CHS IV, a private equity fund formed by Code Hennessy & Simmons L.L.C., or CHS, acquired a 50% stake in our company from these outside investors in the 2000 recapitalization (referred to as the 2000 recapitalization).
We are currently organized as American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., a California limited liability company, or Holdings. We conduct our operations through our wholly-owned operating subsidiary, American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., a California limited liability company, or Opco, and its subsidiaries.
Immediately prior to the closing of this offering, we will reorganize from a California limited liability company to a Delaware corporation, American Reprographics Company. In the reorganization, the members of Holdings will exchange their common units and options to purchase common units for shares of our common stock and options to purchase shares of our common stock. As required by the operating agreement of Holdings, we will repurchase all of the preferred equity of Holdings upon the closing of this offering with a portion of the net proceeds from this offering. After our reorganization, all outstanding warrants to purchase common units will be exercisable for shares of our common stock.
Current Ownership
CHS is a private equity firm based in Chicago, Illinois specializing in leveraged buyouts and recapitalizations of middle market companies in partnership with company management through its private equity funds, including CHS IV. Since its founding in 1988, CHS has formed four private equity funds totaling $1.6 billion and currently has investments in 19 operating companies with combined annual revenues of more than $4.0 billion. CHS presently manages $1.5 billion of equity capital from leading financial institutions, pension funds, insurance companies, and university endowments. Its principal offices are located at 10 South Wacker Drive, Suite 3175, Chicago, Illinois 60606. As of September 30, 2004, CHS IV and its affiliates owned approximately 49% of our outstanding common equity.
Our founders, Mr. Chandramohan, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and Mr. Suriyakumar, President and Chief Operating Officer, purchased ARC in 1989 under its predecessor name, Micro Device, Inc., are still actively involved in the business, and have provided continuity of leadership and control since then. As of September 30, 2004, our executive officers had a pecuniary interest in approximately 33% of our outstanding common equity. See Principal and Selling Stockholders.
Acquisitions
In addition to our primary focus on the growth of our business, we have pursued tactical acquisitions to expand and complement our existing service offerings and to expand our geographic locations where we believe we could be a market leader. In 2000, we acquired 14 reprographics companies for an aggregate purchase price of $111.6 million, including our acquisition of Ridgways, Inc., which enabled us to expand our geographic reach and market penetration in 14 major metropolitan markets. In 2001, we acquired 14 reprographics companies for an aggregate purchase price of $32.6 million. In 2002, we acquired eight reprographics companies for an aggregate purchase price of $34.4 million, including certain assets of the Consolidated Reprographics division of Lason Systems, Inc., which allowed us to increase our market penetration in Southern California.
56
We intend to continue to pursue a disciplined course of growing our business through complementary acquisitions. We regularly evaluate potential acquisitions and may engage in acquisition negotiations at any time and from time to time. Currently, we are not party to any agreements or engaged in any negotiations regarding a material acquisition.
Industry Overview
The reprographics industry has traditionally provided services related to the reproduction and distribution of large format architectural, engineering and construction documents. Customer demands for speed and efficiency and advances in technology have transformed the reprographics industry such that reprographers are now expected to offer complex digital document management capabilities, document distribution expertise, comprehensive logistics, and the ability to provide document services under intense deadlines. These sophisticated services typically are charged as part of a per square foot printing cost.
According to the International Reprographics Association, or IRgA, and other industry sources, the reprographics industry in the United States is estimated to be approximately $5 billion in size. The IRgA indicates that the reprographics industry is highly fragmented, consisting of approximately 3,000 firms with average annual sales of approximately $1.5 million and 20 to 25 employees. Since construction documents are the primary medium of communication for the architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry, demand for reprographics services in the AEC market is closely tied to the level of activity in the construction industry, which in turn is driven by macroeconomic trends such as GDP growth, interest rates, job creation, office vacancy rates, and tax revenues. According to FMI Corporation, or FMI, a consulting firm to the construction industry, construction industry spending in the United States for 2004 is estimated at $975 billion, with expenditures divided between residential construction (55%) and commercial and public, or non-residential, construction (45%). Our AEC revenues are most closely correlated to the non-residential sectors of the construction industry because these sectors are the largest users of reprographics services. According to FMI, the non-residential sectors of the construction industry are projected to grow at an average of 5.4% per year over the next three years. Although we believe the estimates and industry data we have obtained to be reliable, we have not independently verified this information or the accuracy of any such estimates.
For over 100 years, AEC customers have used reprographics services to print, distribute, and store architectural, engineering and construction diagrams and plans. Prior to the 1980s, the blueprint was the primary medium of communication among the highly fragmented team of AEC professionals who was responsible for the creation and development of a construction project. With the advent of Computer Aided Drafting (CAD) software and the corresponding need for improved graphic reproduction and color graphics to support the digital nature of construction documents, reprographers have evolved their products and services to facilitate better communication through digital means. The production of documents through digital means significantly decreases errors in drawing interpretation due to the increased quality of information and the clarity with which these documents can be produced. The introduction of the internet spurred additional service and technology development, especially in the area of document management, document distribution and logistic services and print-on-demand.
Non-residential construction projects are generally large in scale, time consuming, and subject to cost overruns and delays. A frequent cause of such problems is the complexity of the construction documentation and the logistics involved in distributing documents to their intended recipients. Reprographers can facilitate better document management through technology applications. For example, reprographers can provide more efficient document distribution by shifting from an analog print and distribute business model, where customer orders are placed and produced in one location and physically distributed locally or nationally, to a digital distribute and print model, where customer orders are placed in one location, distributed digitally and physically produced at one or more local service centers.
57
Market opportunities for business-to-business document management services such as ours are rapidly expanding into non-AEC industries. For example, non-AEC customers are increasingly using large and small format color imaging for point-of-purchase displays, digital publishing, presentation materials, educational materials and marketing materials as these services have become more efficient and available on a short run, on-demand basis through digital technology. As a result, we believe that our addressable market is substantially larger than the core AEC reprographics market. We believe that the growth of non-AEC industries is generally tied to growth in the U.S. gross domestic product, or GDP, which is projected to grow 4.3% in 2004 and 3.6% in 2005 according to Wall Streets consensus estimates.
The development of digital technology and internet-based solutions for managing documents and the corresponding distribution and reproduction processes have also created an additional opportunity for reprographics companies such as ourselves to offer complementary, value-added services to AEC and non-AEC customers through intelligent technological solutions and an extensive physical network.
We believe the following general trends will continue to impact our business:
| Economic Recovery. The recovery in the overall economy is expected to boost construction activity. We estimate that recovery in non-residential construction typically lags the recovery in the broader economy by approximately six months, and we believe that we are at the early stages of an upturn in the non-residential construction cycle. FMI forecasts increases in non-residential construction spending at an average of 5.4% per year over the next three years. The economy is continuing to show signs of recovery as indicated by positive GDP growth, employment growth, increased consumer confidence and supportive monetary policy. Wall Streets consensus estimates forecast real GDP growth of 4.3% in 2004 and 3.6% in 2005. |
We believe we are well positioned to capitalize on these recovery trends through our economies of scale and through our nationwide network of service centers. |
| Digitization. The AEC industry is increasingly becoming digital, creating substantial efficiencies and cost savings for participants of the AEC industry through electronic design and collaboration. Improved document management by the AEC industry is compelling to participants due to frequent cost overruns and completion delays attributable to poor and inaccurate use of plans, specifications and other construction documentation, as well as the complex nature of construction projects. AEC and non-AEC customers alike are increasingly demanding higher value-added, comprehensive digital reprographics services. To meet the demands of the customers, the reprographics industry has been converting its main production technology from analog to digital. Digital technology is cost effective, allows for just-in-time printing and results in high quality documents that can be stored electronically, modified easily and printed in any quantity at any time. The internet is becoming the new distribution channel for the AEC industry, allowing reprographics businesses to shift from a print and distribute business model to a distribute and print model. |
We believe we are at the forefront of this industry trend and conduct our operations entirely by digital means through our 174 digitally connected service centers, each with similar production equipment and quality standards, and by enabling the digital fulfillment of our reprographics services through the development of our proprietary software, including PlanWell. |
| Expanding Geographic Presence. AEC firms of all sizes are expanding their operations into larger geographic territories. This trend requires reprographers to expand their service levels and offerings to keep up with customer demand. As a result, the ability to fulfill reprographics services across wider areas increases the logistical burden for the vast majority of reprographers, which are typically small, privately-held companies that serve only local markets. In addition, the desire for customers to possess a degree of centralized administrative control over their documents requires the support of a corresponding digital infrastructure. As AEC firms continue to decentralize and |
58
shift to the distribute and print model, we believe that reprographics firms with a comprehensive digital network and footprint of service facilities such as ours will be best positioned to serve their customers. |
The digitization of the AEC industry has also enabled AEC firms to expand globally to take advantage of opportunities in the global construction industry, which according to FMI is $3.3 trillion in size, and diversify the risks associated with operating in one region or one country. International reprographics markets appear to mirror the fragmentation and the small business orientation of the U.S. market, with few large reprographics companies. In addition, our recent efforts to introduce our technology solutions into Europe and Asia indicate that there is a significant lag in the adoption and availability of digital reprographics technology in those markets. | |
We believe that the addressable reprographics market of the global construction industry is significantly larger than the U.S. reprographics market and that we are well positioned to service the needs of global AEC firms. Although we derive less than 1% of our net sales from operations in foreign countries, our abilities to leverage our technology, offer value-added business service offerings, expand our physical operations, and successfully integrate new businesses offer us significant opportunities for growth outside the United States. | |
| Secular Trends Favoring Outsourcing. Both AEC and non-AEC businesses are focused on increasing productivity by specializing in their core competencies and outsourcing non-core operations such as reprographics. The rapid pace of technological advances and the high costs of purchasing and operating equipment for in-house reprographics departments have further contributed to this trend. According to IDC, a global market intelligence and advisory firm, on-site outsourcing revenue will increase from $4.8 billion in 2003 to $6.6 billion in 2008, resulting in a projected CAGR of 6%. IDC also indicates that revenue from facilities management services and mailroom management services, from which the bulk of on-site revenue is derived, is expected to increase from $4.3 billion in 2003 to $5.9 billion in 2008, representing a projected CAGR of 6%. |
With a current base of more than 1,560 on-site facilities management programs, we believe we can leverage our depth of experience in selling and managing these programs into a growth opportunity that will meet or exceed the potential growth rate of the market itself. |
Our Competitive Strengths
We believe that our growth will be driven by our competitive strengths, which include the following:
| Leading Market Position in Fragmented Industry. In terms of revenue, number of service facilities and number of customers, we believe we are the largest company in our industry, operating in more than eight times as many cities and with more than five times the number of service facilities as our next largest competitor. We are the largest reprographer in most of the geographic markets we serve, as the majority of the approximately 3,000 firms in the reprographics industry are small and locally focused. Our size and national footprint provide us with significant purchasing power, economies of scale, the ability to invest in the development of technologies, and the resources to service large, national customers. Our well-recognized local brand names and our reputation for quality and reliability within the reprographics and architectural, engineering and construction industries, or AEC industries, supported by our ability to provide a wide range of services, have allowed us to gain and sustain the leading position in our industry. |
| Leader in Technology and Innovation. We strive to maintain the leading position in our industry by creating innovative, value-added technology solutions for our customers and other independent reprographers. We develop and support our suite of reprographics technology products through a team of approximately 20 full-time engineers and technical specialists at our two technology centers in Silicon Valley, as well as through continued investment in research and |
59
development. We also draw upon the combined experience, expertise and market insight of the management of our acquired reprographics firms to design, evaluate and improve our reprographics technology products. We believe PlanWell is best positioned to become the industry standard within the AEC industry. From PlanWells inception in June 2000 through September 30, 2004, more than 650,000 orders have been placed through PlanWell online planrooms for the management of more than 54,000 projects and seven million complex, large format documents. In addition, we have developed other proprietary software applications that complement PlanWell and have enabled us to improve the efficiency of our services, add complementary services and increase our opportunities for capturing revenue. These include Abacus PCR, our proprietary job tracking software, BidCaster, our proprietary Invitation to Bid tool (ITB), EWO, our proprietary electronic work order application, MetaPrint, our print automation and device manager, and OneView, our proprietary centralized project and administrative module for larger customers. | |
| Extensive National Footprint with Regional Expertise. Our service centers maintain local customer relationships while benefiting from our centralized corporate functions and national scale. Each service center provides personalized services that are tailored to meet the regional needs of our customers. Our service facilities are organized as hub and satellite structures within individual markets, allowing us to balance production capacity and minimize capital expenditures through technology sharing among our service centers within each market. Our service centers are in close proximity to the majority of our customers and offer pickup and delivery services within a 15 to 30 mile radius. This enables us to maintain our national distribute and print operations and allows our service facilities to act as backup and supply centers for the more than 1,560 facilities management programs we have in place at customer sites throughout the United States. We also leverage the geographic coverage of our production facilities to address the service needs of large companies that operate in multiple locations. Our Premier Accounts sales initiative offers regional and national customers our localized services under a single contract, while offering centralized access to project specific services, billing, and tracking information. |
| Flexible Operating Model. We are able to tailor our operations to meet the demands of the local markets that we serve by promoting regional decision making for marketing, pricing, and selling practices. In this manner, we remain responsive to our customers while benefiting from the cost structure advantages of our centralized administrative functions. Our flexible operating model also allows us to capitalize on an improving business environment. Capital investment for a new branch is modest and these new branches are expected to generate positive operating profit within 12 months from opening. The economies associated with opening a new branch give us flexibility and market response times that can significantly enhance our regional growth. We use our wide area network and management information systems to benchmark daily financial and operational data to help us identify and respond to changes in operating trends and disseminate best practices across all branches. We estimate that approximately 60% of our cost base is fixed and that the operating margin on our incremental revenue is more than two times our current operating margin. For example, for the year ended December 31, 2003, we achieved an operating margin of 15.0% and an EBITDA margin (exclusive of a one-time charge related to the early extinguishment of debt) of 19.7%. For the nine months ended September 30, 2004, we experienced revenue growth of 6.3% compared to the same period in 2003, and achieved an operating margin of 17.4% and an EBITDA margin of 21.4%, resulting in margin improvement of approximately 2.4 and 1.7 percentage points, respectively, compared to the year ended December 31, 2003, demonstrating the leverage in our operating model in an expanding business environment. For a description of EBITDA margin and its reconciliation to operating margin, see Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations Non- GAAP Measures. |
| Consistent, Strong Cash Flow. Through management of our inventory and receivables and our low capital expenditure requirements, we have consistently generated strong cash flow from operations after capital expenditures, regardless of industry and economic conditions. Our |
60
historical cash capital expenditures have been relatively low, with overall capital spending averaging approximately 1.5% of annual net sales over the last three years. In 2003, we generated cash flow from operations of $48.2 million. From the beginning of 2001 to the end of September 2004, we generated a cumulative $200.4 million of cash flow from operations. | |
| Low Cost Operator. We believe we are one of the lowest cost operators in the reprographics industry, which we have accomplished by minimizing branch level expenses and capitalizing on our significant scale for purchasing efficiencies. As a result of our national presence and size, we enjoy significant economies of scale, and we receive favorable terms from major vendors of equipment, software and reprographics supplies, such as Océ N.V., Xerox Corporation, Canon Inc., Xpedx, a division of International Paper Company, CDW Corporation, and Dell Inc. We also offer savings to other reprographers through our PEiR division, which allows members to purchase machinery and supplies at lower prices than they could obtain independently while further increasing our purchasing power. |
| Experienced Management Team and Highly Trained Workforce. Our senior management team of S. Mohan Chandramohan, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, K. Suri Suriyakumar, President and Chief Operating Officer, and Mark Legg, Chief Financial Officer, together with our divisional managers, has an average of over 20 years of industry experience. Mr. Chandramohan has been with us since February 1988 and Mr. Suriyakumar has been with us since November 1989. We have also successfully retained approximately 93% of the managers of the 81 businesses we have acquired since 1997. As a result of these acquisitions, we have developed a formalized training program that collects and disseminates best practices to our employees through formal instruction and seminars. The program covers all of our business practices, including general management, operations, sales and marketing, technology, human resources and accounting. |
Our Business Strategy
Our objective is to continue to strengthen our competitive position as the preferred provider of business-to-business document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services. We seek to strengthen this position while increasing revenue, cash flow, profitability, and market share. We believe our nationwide footprint, our continuous technological innovation, our promotion of PlanWell as the industry standard, and our value-added service offerings will allow us to continue to meet this objective. Our key strategies to accomplish this objective includes:
| Continue to Increase Our Market Penetration and Expand Our Nationwide Footprint. Through our technical and operational expertise and strong customer relationships, we expect to continue to penetrate key markets and build our nationwide presence. We believe that customers rely on local relationships for their document management services, and we intend to increase our existing presence in key U.S. markets while expanding into under-penetrated regions through facilities management contracts, targeted branch openings, strategic acquisitions, and national accounts. |
Õ | Facilities Management Contracts: We expect to capitalize on the continued trend of our customers to outsource their document management services, including their in-house operations. Our facilities management services are turnkey solutions to our customers that can transform what was a cost center for our customers into a profit center. Rather than absorbing the entire cost of such a facility, our customers receive an invoice from us based on their use which is typically reimbursable by project owners and developers. Since January 1, 2001, the number of our facilities management contracts has more than doubled. Based on the nine months ended September 30, 2004, annualized net sales from these contracts have grown to $71.6 million. We will continue to concentrate on developing ongoing facilities management relationships in all of the markets we serve and building our base of recurring revenue. |
61
Õ | Targeted Branch Openings: Significant opportunities exist to expand our geographic coverage, capture new customers and increase our market share by opening additional satellite branches in regions near our established operations. Our strategy with respect to branch openings is in the early stages of implementation, having evolved as the next stage of our growth to complement our traditional acquisition strategy. Since September 2003, we have opened 17 new branches in areas that expand or further penetrate our existing markets and plan to open an additional 15 branches by the end of the first quarter of 2005. Capital investment for a new branch is modest and these new branches are expected to generate positive operating profit within 12 months from opening. We plan to open branches within our existing markets to serve new customers, in new markets to serve both existing and new customers, and in markets that have no ideal acquisition candidates or where potential acquisitions are likely to be too costly. We believe that our existing corporate infrastructure is capable of supporting a much larger branch network and significantly higher revenue. | |
Õ | Strategic Acquisitions: Acquisitions have historically been an important component of our growth strategy. Since 1997, we have acquired 81 reprographics companies and have developed a structured approach to acquiring and integrating companies. We believe that there are significant opportunities to grow our business further through disciplined, strategic acquisitions due to the fragmented nature of our industry. Because our industry consists primarily of small, privately-held companies that serve only local markets, we believe that we can continue to grow our business by successfully acquiring additional reprographics companies at reasonable prices and subsequently realizing substantial operating and purchasing synergies by leveraging our existing corporate infrastructure. We will continue to leverage our acquisition and integration expertise to expand into new markets and increase our presence in existing underpenetrated markets. | |
Õ | National Accounts: Our Premier Accounts business unit offers a comprehensive suite of reprographics services designed to meet the demands of large regional and national businesses. It provides local reprographics services to regional and national companies through our national network of reprographics service centers, while offering centralized access to project-specific services, billing and tracking information. For example, we recently entered into an exclusive Premier Accounts contract with one of the leading construction companies in the United States under which we offer a full range of document management, distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services on a national scale. This contract requires that the customer use PlanWell for every project, and the use of PlanWell by this customers contractors, subcontractors and outside work force should significantly improve the potential for revenue growth from this account. Through our extensive national footprint and industry leading technology, we believe that we are well-positioned to meet the demands of national companies and will continue to capture additional revenues and customers through this business unit. | |
| Promote PlanWell as the Industry Standard for Procuring Reprographics Services Online. Our goal is to continue to expand the market penetration of PlanWell and create a standardized, internet-based portal to manage, store, and retrieve documents. In order to increase market share and achieve industry standardization, we will continue to license our PlanWell technology to other reprographics companies, including members of PEiR. Through September 30, 2004, we have licensed PlanWell and our other technology products to 66 reprographics companies operating 83 service facilities across the United States. These efforts, combined with the functionality and capabilities of the PlanWell suite of products, should continue to position us at the forefront of technological innovation within the AEC and non-AEC reprographics markets, and create additional service and licensing revenue for us. |
| Expand Our Non-AEC and Ancillary Product and Service Offerings. We believe that offering our services to non-AEC customers and expanding our existing suite of product and service offerings are effective methods of increasing sales to both new and existing customers. We have |
62
leveraged our expertise in providing highly customized, quick-turn services to the AEC industry to attract customers from non-AEC industries that are increasingly seeking document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services. We have been successful in attracting non-AEC customers that require services such as the production of large format and small format color and black and white documents, educational and training materials, short-run publishing products, and retail and promotional items. We began targeting non-AEC customers upon our conversion to digital technology in 1997, and we believe that our services to these customers accounted for approximately 20% of our year to date net sales. |
In addition to expanding our non-AEC revenues, we continue to focus on creating new value-added services beyond traditional reprographics to offer all of our customers. We are actively engaged in services such as bid facilitation, print network management for offices and on-site production facilities, and on-demand color publishing. We plan to continue to capitalize on our technological innovation to enhance our existing services and to create new reprographics technologies.
Our Services
Reprographics services typically encompass the digital management and reproduction of graphics-related material and corresponding finishing and distribution services. We provide these business-to-business services to our customers in three major categories: document management, document distribution and logistics , and print-on-demand .
Document Management. We store, organize, print and track AEC and non-AEC project documents using a variety of digital tools and industry expertise. The documents we manage are typically larger than 11x17, requiring specialized production equipment, and the documents are iterative in nature; frequently 10 or more versions of a single document must be tracked and managed throughout the course of a project.
Document Distribution and Logistics. We provide fully-integrated document distribution and logistics, which consist of tracking document users, packaging prints, addressing and coordinating services for shipment (either in hard copy or electronic form), as well as local pick-up and delivery of documents to multiple locations within tight time constraints.
Print-on-demand. We produce small and large-format documents in black and white or color using digital scanning and printing devices. We can reproduce documents when and where they are needed by balancing production capacity between the high-volume equipment in our network of reprographic service centers, as well as equipment placed on site in our customers facilities.
These broad categories of services are provided to our architectural, engineering and construction industry, or AEC industry, customers, as well as to our customers in non-AEC industries that have similar document management and production requirements. Our AEC customers work primarily with high volumes of large format construction plans and small format specification documents that are technical, complex, constantly changing and frequently confidential. Our non-AEC customers generally require services that apply to black and white and color small format documents, promotional documents of all sizes, and the digital distribution of document files to multiple locations for a variety of print-on-demand needs including short-run digital publishing.
We provide the following specific services through our suite of reprographics technology products, a network of 174 locally-branded reprographics service centers, and more than 1,560 facilities management programs. These services include:
| PlanWell, our proprietary, internet-based planroom launched in June 2000, and our suite of other reprographics software products that enable the online purchase and fulfillment of reprographics services. From Planwells inception in June 2000 through September 1, 2004, more than 650,000 orders have been placed through PlanWell online planrooms for the management of more than 54,000 projects and seven million complex, large format documents. While PlanWell typically facilitates the management of large and small format documents for professionals in the AEC |
63
industry, the application can be used to manage small format document collections and color documents for non-AEC users. PlanWell is provided in two primary configurations: PlanWell Enterprise , a hosted, comprehensive documentation system with a wide variety of administration and document management features; and PlanWell PDS, a simple, stand alone online planroom that acts as a document viewing and distribution tool for a single set of plans. | |
| Production services, including print-on-demand, document assembly, document finishing, mounting, laminating, binding, and kitting. We utilize a broad range of digital output equipment and finishing and assembly skills to produce print-on-demand projects at each of our 174 service centers. These services include the production of large format and small format documents in both black and white and color. Documents can be digitally transferred from one service facility to another to balance production capacity or take advantage of a distribute and print operating system. |
| Document distribution and logistics, including the physical pick up, delivery, and shipping of time-sensitive, critical documents. These services are supported by a fleet of approximately 675 vehicles and nearly 700 employees. Our service facilities provide pedestrian, bicycle and car courier services in most metropolitan markets, and we also offer third party shipping services to all of our customers. Contracted courier services allow our divisions to manage additional delivery capacity through approximately 157 vehicles and drivers. |
| Highly customized large and small format reprographics in color and black and white. For our non-AEC customers this includes digital reproduction of posters, tradeshow displays, plans, banners, signage and maps. We offer large format color services through a variety of processes, including inkjet, bubblejet, large format electrostatic printing and photographic printing. We also offer small format color reprographics services, which typically use laser printing technology, for products such as flyers, real estate deal books and financial presentations. |
| Facilities management, including recurring on-site document management services and staffing at our customers locations. We currently have more than 1,560 facilities management programs, which typically include the management and procurement of related on-site equipment and supplies. Our facilities management services generally eliminate reprographics capital expenditures for our customers and keep equipment current and in good condition. Our facilities management services also help our customers track and capture reprographics costs that are often reimbursable, and frequently transform a customers cost center into profit center. |
| Sales of reprographics equipment and supplies to other reprographics companies and end-users in the AEC industry to further complement our service and product offerings and increase our purchasing power. In addition, a number of our service centers are authorized dealers for reprographics equipment manufactures such as Océ and Xerox. Sales of reprographics equipment and supplies accounted for over $40.7 million, or 9.8%, of our net sales in 2003. |
| The design and development of other document management and reprographics software, in addition to PlanWell, that supports ordering, tracking, job costing, and other customer specific accounting information for a variety of projects and services. Many of these applications create greater value and offer a wider range of services when used in conjunction with one another, providing an incentive to our customers to use our services beyond a single need. These proprietary applications include: |
Õ | Electronic Work Order (EWO), which offers our customers access to the services of all of our service centers through the internet. This application also offers the reprographer the ability to create internet-based order forms that conform to their available service offerings and pricing. Customers can use a simple upload application to send files to the reprographer or schedule a pickup for original documents. This application can also be configured to interface with other third party internet-based products, acting as the driving e-commerce engine for a reprographics organization. |
64
Õ | Abacus Print Cost Recovery (PCR) System, which provides a suite of software modules for reprographers and their customers to track documents produced from equipment installed as a part of a facilities management program. | |
Õ | BidCaster Invitation-to-Bid (ITB) System, a data management internet application that issues customizable invitations to bid from a customers desktop using email and a hosted fax server. This application links potential bidders directly to a PlanWell online planroom to evaluate and order plans used in the submission of project bids, and tracks bid responses to provide the customer a much faster, convenient and efficient way to gather and complete project bids. | |
Õ | MetaPrint Print Automation and Device Manager, a universal print driver that facilitates the printing of documents with output devices manufactured by multiple vendors, and allows the reprographer to print multiple documents in various formats as a single print submission. | |
Õ | OneView Document Access and Customer Administration System, an internet-based application that leverages the security attributes of PlanWell to provide a single point of access to all of a customers project documents, regardless of which of our local production facilities stores the relevant documents. This application also imports and consolidates invoice data from each of our service centers in a variety of formats and reports. |
To further support and promote our major categories of services, as well as lead our industry forward and establish ourselves firmly at the forefront of technology and innovation in the reprographics industry, we also:
| License our suite of reprographics technology products, including our flagship online planroom, PlanWell, to independent reprographers. Our licensing efforts promote our technology as the digital standard for the fulfillment of reprographics services in the AEC industry. Through September 30, 2004, we have licensed PlanWell and our other technology products to 66 reprographics companies operating 83 service facilities across the United States. |
| Operate PEiR (Profit and Education in Reprographics), a trade organization wholly owned by us, through which we charge membership fees and provide purchasing, technology and educational benefits to other reprographers. PEiR members, currently consisting of 45 independent reprographers, are required to license PlanWell and may purchase equipment and supplies at a lower cost than they could obtain independently. In turn, their purchasing volumes increase our buying power and influence with our vendors. We also distribute our educational programs to PEiR members to help establish and promote best practices within the reprographics industry. |
Customers and Representative Projects
Our customers are both local and national companies, with no single customer accounting for more than 2% of our net sales in 2003.
We have historically provided reprographics and related business services primarily to the architectural, engineering and construction, or AEC, market. However, since 1997, we have focused on increasing the number of non-AEC customers in our customer base to increase diversification and expand our core services into markets that seek sophisticated document management, document distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand services. We generated approximately 80% of our year to date net sales from AEC customers. We began targeting non-AEC customers upon
65
Top 20 AEC Customers
The following is a list of our top 20 AEC customers based upon year to date net sales through September 2004:
Anshen & Allen, Architects, Inc.
BSW Architects EDAW, Inc. Ewing Cole Cherry Brott Gensler Hammel, Green & Abrahamson, Inc. Hillier International The Irvine Company KTGY Group, Inc. MBH Architects, Inc. |
Parsons Brinkerhoff Inc.
Perini Corporation RBF Consulting Rockwell Group Skanska USA Building Inc. Skidmore Owens & Merrill LLP Standard Pacific Corporation The Turner Corporation URS Corporation Wimberly Allison Tong & Goo |
Top 20 Non-AEC Customers
The following is a list of our top 20 non-AEC customers based upon year to date net sales through September 2004:
Adac Laboratories, Inc.
AIM Management Group Inc. Applied Materials, Inc. Baker Hughes Incorporated The Boeing Company Chevron Phillips Chemical DBL Realtors Corp. Etec Systems Helix U.S.A. Ltd. Lam Research Corporation |
Los Angeles County Dept. of Public Works
NACE International San Manuel Indian Bingo & Casino Sound Transit Southern California Edison Staedtler, Inc. Taco Bell Corp. WDI/ Document Controls Wells Fargo & Company University of California, Los Angeles |
66
Representative Projects
The following is a representative list of recent
small and large projects in which we supplied reprographics
services:
Name of Project
Architect
Builder
Corgan Associates, Inc.
The Turner Corporation
North Terminal Development
(Miami, FL)
Frank O. Gehry & Associates, Inc.
M. A. Mortenson Company
(Los Angeles, CA)
Polshek Partnership Architects LLP
Skanska USA Building Inc.
Biomedical Science Research Building
(Ann Arbor, MI)
LPA, Inc.
The Turner Corporation
Campus Office Development
(Torrance, CA)
Marnell Carrao Associates
Marnell Carrao Associates
Sams Town Gambling Hall
(Las Vegas, NV)
(Irvine, CA)
Zimmer, Gunsul, Frasca Partnership + HDR
Hensel Phelps
Fluor Corporation
Fluor Corporation
Headquarters (Irvine, CA)
Multiple
Multiple
Masterplan (Aliso Viejo, CA)
HOK Sport + Venue + Event
Kellogg Brown & Root (KBR)
PCL Civil Constructors Inc.
Multiple
Tunnel (Virginia Beach, VA)
Morphosis Architects
Clark Construction Group, LLC
Headquarters
(Los Angeles, CA)
Gensler
Gilbane Building Company
International Airport (San Jose, CA)
SSOE, Inc.
W.G. Yates & Sons
Facility (Canton, MS)
Construction Co.,
Yates/ Walbridge
67
Operations
Geographic Presence. We operate 174 reprographics service centers, including 171 service centers in 133 cities in 29 states throughout the United States and three service centers in the Toronto metropolitan area. Our reprographics service centers are located in close proximity to the majority of our customers and offer pickup and delivery services within a 15 to 30 mile radius. The map below illustrates the number of our service centers by state.
Hub and Satellite Configuration. We are organized into 42 divisions that typically consist of a cluster configuration of at least one large service facility, or hub facility, and several smaller facilities, or satellite facilities, that are digitally connected as a cohesive network, allowing us to provide all of our services both locally and nationwide. Our hub and satellite configuration enables us to shorten our customers document processing and distribution time, as well as achieve higher utilization of output devices by coordinating the distribution of work orders digitally among our service centers. In addition, this organizational structure allows us to balance production capacity, improve equipment utilization, and minimize capital expenditures through technology sharing among our service centers within each market. The hub and satellite model supports our ability to respond to the demands of local markets by promoting regional decision making for marketing, pricing, and selling practices while benefiting from centralized administrative functions.
68
Overview of Typical Hub and Satellite
Capabilities
Central Hub Facilities
Satellite Facilities
Process simple reprographics
Quick turnaround capabilities
Sophisticated equipment
Responsive, localized service
Local delivery service
Light production capacity
Finishing services
| Central Hub Facilities. In each of our major markets, we operate one or more large scale full service facilities that have high production capacity and sophisticated equipment. These larger facilities offer specialized services such as laser digital imaging on photographic material, large format color printing, and finishing services that may not be economically viable for smaller facilities to provide. Each central hub facility also maintains a library of design and imaging software, including architectural software, to process customer orders in digital format. In addition, digital equipment at all of our service facilities is networked, allowing a single order to be processed simultaneously on multiple pieces of equipment. These facilities also offer customers access to PlanWell, as well as document storage and retrieval services. Our central hub facilities also coordinate our facilities management programs. |
| Satellite Facilities. To supplement the capabilities of our central hub facilities, we operate satellite facilities that are typically located closer to our customers than the central hubs. Our satellite facilities have quick turnaround capabilities, responsive, localized service, and handle the majority of digital processes. By utilizing a fleet of approximately 675 vehicles and nearly 700 employees, together with approximately 157 vehicles and drivers from contracted courier services for additional flexible capacity, these satellite facilities interact directly with customers and our central hub facilities to provide customers with a full range of high quality, on-demand reprographics services. In addition, our delivery fleet enables the smaller satellite facilities to coordinate with each other to reduce turnaround time for customers by evenly distributing work orders. The smaller satellite centers also typically provide digital black and white printing and imaging, color printing and limited finishing services. |
Management Systems and Controls. We operate our business under a dual operating structure of centralized administrative functions and regional decision making. Acquired companies typically retain their local business identities, managers, sales force, and marketing efforts in order to maintain strong local relationships. Our local management maintains autonomy over the day-to-day operations of their business units, including profitability, customer billing, receivables collection, and service mix decisions. We believe that this decentralized and entrepreneurial approach to our operations is essential in capitalizing on our managers knowledge of local markets and long established customer relationships.
Although we operate on a decentralized basis, our senior management closely monitors and reviews each of our 42 divisions through daily reports that contain operating and financial information such as sales, inventory levels, purchasing commitments, collections, and receivables. In addition, our operating divisions submit monthly reports to senior management that track each divisions financial and operating performance in comparison to monthly budgets.
Suppliers and Vendors
We purchase raw materials, consisting primarily of paper, toner, and other consumables, and purchase or lease reprographics equipment. To minimize our materials cost, we maintain a paper
69
Our primary vendors of equipment, maintenance services and reprographics supplies include Océ N.V., Xerox Corporation, Canon Inc., and Xpedx, a division of International Paper Company. We have long standing relationships with all of our suppliers and we believe we receive favorable prices as compared to our competition due to the large quantities we purchase and strong relationships with our vendors. We have entered into annual supply contracts with certain vendors to guarantee prices. Significant market fluctuations in our raw material costs have historically been limited to paper prices and we have typically maintained strong gross margins as the result of our ability to pass increased material costs through to our customers.
Sales and Marketing
Divisional Sales Force. We market our products and services throughout the United States through localized sales forces and marketing efforts at the divisional level. We had approximately 270 sales and customer service representatives as of September 30, 2004. Each sales force generally consists of a sales manager and a staff of between two to 12 sales and customer service representatives that target various customer segments. Depending on the size of the operating division, a sales team may serve both the central hub service facility and satellite facilities, or if market demographics require, operate on behalf of a single service facility.
Our sales associates have been trained in our entire portfolio of services. They are in close contact with the local business community and offer our portfolio of services to customers in a variety of local industries in both the architectural, engineering and construction, or AEC market, and the non-AEC markets.
In most locations, we follow a customized sales approach to the market that is dependent on the distinctive trade practices of the region. For example, in some major metropolitan markets, architects exert controlling influence over the management of construction projects, whereas in other markets, general contractors have greater control. We believe our strong connections to AEC and general business communities and our long operating history provide us with the insight and understanding to effectively address regionally focused trade practices through our targeted sales efforts.
Premier Accounts. To further enhance our market share and service portfolio on a national level, we operate a Premier Accounts business unit. Designed to meet the requirements of large regional and national businesses, we established this operating division to take advantage of growing globalization within the AEC market, and to establish ourselves at the corporate level as the leading national reprographer with extensive geographic and service capabilities. The Premier Accounts sales initiative allows us to attract large AEC and non-AEC companies with document management, distribution and logistics, and print-on-demand needs that span wide geographical or organizational boundaries. Since its launch in the middle of 2003, we have established eight national accounts through Premier Accounts, including our most recent exclusive contract with one of the leading construction companies in the United States.
PEiR Group. We established the PEiR Group (Profit and Education in Reprographics) in July 2003, a separate operating division of our company that is a membership-based organization for the reprographics industry. Comprised of independent reprographers and reprographics vendors, its
70
Competition
According to the IRgA, most firms in the U.S. reprographics services industry are small, privately held entrepreneurial businesses. The larger reprographers in the United States, besides ourselves, include Service Point USA, a subsidiary of Service Point Solutions, S.A., Thomas Reprographics, Inc., ABC Imaging, LLC, and National Reprographics Inc. While we have no nationwide competitors, we do compete at the local level with a number of privately held reprographics companies, commercial printers, digital imaging firms, and to a limited degree, retail copy shops. Competition is primarily based on customer service, technological leadership, product performance and price. We believe that the scale and scope of our operations are distinct competitive advantages that differentiate us from our competitors. See Risk Factors Competition in our industry and innovation by our competitors may hinder our ability to execute our business strategy and maintain our profitability.
Research and Development
We believe that to compete effectively we must continue to invest in research and development of our services. Our research and development efforts are focused on improving and enhancing PlanWell as well as developing new proprietary services. As of September 30, 2004, we employed approximately 20 engineers and technical specialists with expertise in software, internet-based applications, database management, internet security and quality assurance. Cash outlays for research and development which include both capitalized and expensed items amounted to $2.5 million in 2001, $2.7 million in 2002, $2.8 million in 2003, and $1.9 million for the nine months ended September 30, 2004.
Proprietary Rights
Our success depends on our proprietary information and technology. We rely on a combination of copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, license agreements, nondisclosure and noncompete agreements, reseller agreements, customer contracts, and technical measures to establish and protect our rights in our proprietary technology. Our PlanWell license agreements grant our customers a nonexclusive, nontransferable, limited license to use our products and receive our services and contain terms and conditions prohibiting the unauthorized reproduction or transfer of our services. We retain all title and rights of ownership in our software products. In addition, we enter into agreements with some of our employees, third-party consultants and contractors that prohibit the disclosure or use of our confidential information and require the assignment to us of any new ideas, developments, discoveries or inventions related to our business. We also require other third parties to enter into nondisclosure agreements that limit use of, access to, and distribution of our proprietary information. We also rely on a variety of technologies that are licensed from third parties to perform key functions.
We have registered PlanWell as a trademark with the United States Patent and Trademark Office and have applied for registration in Canada, Australia and the European Union. Additionally, we have applied to register the trademark PlanWell PDS with the United States Patent and Trademark Office and in Canada, Australia and the European Union. We do not have any other trademarks, service marks or patents that are material to our business.
71
For a discussion of the risks associated with our proprietary rights, see Risk Factors Our failure to adequately protect the proprietary aspects of our technology, including PlanWell, may cause us to lose market share and Risk Factors We may be subject to intellectual property rights claims, which are costly to defend, could require us to pay damages and could limit our ability to use certain technologies in the future.
Information Technology
We operate two technology centers in Silicon Valley to support our reprographics services. Our second technology center was recently opened to accommodate the continuing growth of our digital operations, and to provide redundancy for our critical equipment and communication infrastructure. Our technology centers also serve as design and development facilities for our software applications, and house our nationwide database administration team and networking engineers.
From these technology centers, our technical staff is able to remotely manage, control and troubleshoot the primary databases and connectivity of each of our 42 operating divisions. This allows us to avoid the costs and expenses of employing costly database administrators and network engineers in each of our service facilities.
All of our reprographics service centers are connected via a high performance, dedicated wide area network (WAN), with additional capacity and connectivity through a virtual private network (VPN) to handle customer data transmissions and e-commerce transactions. Our technology centers are standardized on HP/Compaq ProLiant TM Servers and Microsoft Window 2000 Enterprise Server software. Our technology centers use both commonly available software and custom applications running in a clustered computing environment and employ industry leading technologies for redundancy, backup and security.
We apply the extensive industry knowledge and experience of the managers of our acquired reprographics companies to our technology development in order to create solutions that are immediately practical to reprographers and their customers.
We employ advanced digital technology to improve processes, reduce costs, and increase our efficiency. We have built our technology infrastructure in a manner which provides us with engineering talent, development tools, and powerful computing resources while carefully managing our costs.
Employees
As of September 30, 2004, we had over 3,450 employees. Approximately 20 of our employees are covered by two collective agreements. The collective bargaining agreement with our subsidiary, Ridgways Ltd., expires on November 30, 2007 and the agreement with our subsidiary, B.P. Independent Reprographics, Inc., expires on December 4, 2006, but will continue thereafter from year to year unless either party terminates the agreement. We have not experienced a work stoppage during the past five years and believe that our relationships with our employees and collective bargaining units are good.
Facilities
We currently operate 181 production facilities, including five production support facilities and our two technology centers in Fremont, California, totaling approximately 1,348,057 square feet. We have five administrative facilities, totaling approximately 25,082 square feet. Our executive offices are located in Glendale, California.
72
The table below lists our facilities by region, type of facility, number of facilities and square footage as of December 1, 2004.
Number of | Number of | ||||||||||||||
Administrative | Square | Production | Square | ||||||||||||
Region | Facilities | Footage | Facilities(1) | Footage(1) | |||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||
Southern California
|
1 | 7,183 | 37 | 307,605 | |||||||||||
Northern California
|
1 | 4,659 | 35 | 269,146 | |||||||||||
Pacific Northwest
|
0 | 0 | 9 | 96,640 | |||||||||||
Northeast
|
3 | 13,240 | 33 | 193,560 | |||||||||||
Southern
|
0 | 0 | 42 | 284,281 | |||||||||||
Midwest
|
0 | 0 | 25 | (2) | 196,825 | ||||||||||
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||
Total
|
5 | 25,082 | 181 | 1,348,057 |
(1) | Includes five production support facilities and our two technology centers in Fremont, California. |
(2) | Includes our three service centers in the Toronto metropolitan area. |
We lease 169 of our production facilities, each of our administrative facilities and both of our technology centers. These leases generally expire between 2005 and 2009. Substantially all of the leases contain renewal provisions with automatic rent escalation clauses. The owned facilities are subject to major encumbrances under our credit facilities. In addition to the facilities that are owned, our fixed assets are comprised primarily of machinery and equipment, trucks, and computer equipment.
Legal Proceedings
We are a creditor and participant in the Chapter 7 Bankruptcy of Louis Frey Company, Inc., or LF Co., which is pending in the United States Bankruptcy Court, Southern District of New York. We managed LF Co. under a contract from May through September of 2003. LF Co. filed for Bankruptcy protection in August 2003, and the proceeding was converted to a Chapter 7 liquidation in October 2003. On or about June 30, 2004, the Bankruptcy Estate Trustee filed a complaint in the LF Co. Bankruptcy proceeding against us, which was amended on or about July 19, 2004, alleging, among other things, breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duties, conversion, unjust enrichment, tortious interference with contract, unfair competition and false commercial promotion in violation of The Lanham Act, misappropriation of trade secrets and fraud regarding our handling of the assets of LF Co. The Trustee claims damages of not less than $9.5 million, as well as punitive damages and treble damages with respect to the Lanham Act claims. Previously, on or about October 10, 2003, a secured creditor of LF Co., Merrill Lynch Business Financial Services, Inc., or Merrill, had filed a complaint in the LF Co. Bankruptcy proceeding against us, which was most recently amended on or about July 6, 2004. Merrills claims are duplicated in the Trustees suit. We, in turn, have filed answers and counterclaims denying liability to the Trustee and seeking reimbursement of all costs and damages sustained as a result of the Trustees actions and in our efforts to assist LF Co. Discovery has commenced and is ongoing in each of these cases. We believe that we have meritorious defenses as well as substantial counterclaims against Merrill Lynch and the Trustee. We intend to vigorously contest the above matters. Based on the discovery and depositions to date, we do not believe that the outcome of the above matters will have a material adverse impact on our results of operations or financial condition.
We are involved in various legal proceedings and other legal matters from time to time in the normal course of business. We do not believe that the outcome of any of these matters will have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
Environmental and Regulatory Considerations
Our property consists principally of reprographics and related production equipment and we lease substantially all of our production and administrative facilities. We are not aware of any environmental liabilities which would have a material impact on our operations and financial condition.
73
MANAGEMENT
Directors and Executive Officers
The following table sets forth the name, age and
position of the persons who will be our directors and executive
officers as of the date of the completion of the offering.
Name
Age
Position
45
Chief Executive Officer; Chairman of the Board of
Directors
51
President; Chief Operating Officer; Director
49
Chief Financial Officer; Secretary
45
Chief Technology Officer
46
Director
40
Director
47
Director
Executive officers are appointed by and serve at the pleasure of our board of directors. A brief biography of each person who will serve as a director or executive officer upon consummation of this offering follows below. Prior to our conversion from a California limited liability company to a Delaware corporation, each officer served Holdings in the capacities discussed below.
Sathiyamurthy (Mohan) Chandramohan has served as an advisor and the Chairman of the Board of Advisors of Holdings since March 1998 and has served as a director and the Chairman of the Board of Directors of American Reprographics Company since October 2004. Mr. Chandramohan joined Micro Device, Inc. (our predecessor company) in February 1988 as President and became the Chief Executive Officer in March 1991. Prior to joining our company, Mr. Chandramohan was employed with U-Save Auto Parts Stores from December 1981 to February 1988, and became the companys Chief Financial Officer in May 1985 and Chief Operating Officer in March 1987. Mr. Chandramohan served as the President of the International Reprographics Association (IRgA) from August 1, 2001 to July 31, 2002 and continues to be an active member of the IRgA.
Kumarakulasingam (Suri) Suriyakumar has served as an advisor of Holdings since March 1998 and has served as a director of American Reprographics Company since October 2004. Mr. Suriyakumar joined Micro Device, Inc. in 1989. He became the Vice President of Micro Device, Inc. in 1990 and became the companys President and Chief Operating Officer in 1991. Prior to joining our company, Mr. Suriyakumar was employed with Aitken Spence & Co. LTD, a highly diversified conglomerate and one of the five largest corporations in Sri Lanka. Mr. Suriyakumar is an active member of the IRgA.
Mark W. Legg joined Holdings as its Chief Financial Officer in April 1998. From 1987 to 1998, Mr. Legg was employed at Vivitar Corporation, a distributor of photographic, optical, electronic and digital imaging products, as a Vice President and the Chief Financial Officer, and later as its Chief Operating Officer. Before Vivitar, he was director of corporate accounting at Sunrise Medical from 1984 to 1986. From 1979 to 1984, Mr. Legg was employed as an accountant with Price Waterhouse & Co.
Rahul K. Roy joined Holdings as our Chief Technology Officer in September 2000. Prior to joining our company, Mr. Roy was the Founder, President and Chief Executive Officer of MirrorPlus Technologies, Inc., which developed software for the reprographics industry, from August 1993 until it was acquired by us in 1999. Mr. Roy served as the Chief Operating Officer of InPrint, a provider of printing, software, duplication, packaging, assembly and distribution services to technology companies, from 1993 until it was acquired by us in 1999.
74
Andrew W. Code has served as an advisor of Holdings since May 2002 and has served as a director of American Reprographics Company since October 2004. Mr. Code is a partner of CHS and founded its predecessors in 1988. Mr. Code is also a director of SCP Pool Corporation.
Thomas J. Formolo has served as an advisor of Holdings since April 2000 and has served as a director of American Reprographics Company since October 2004. Mr. Formolo has been a partner of CHS since 1997 and employed by its affiliates since 1990.
Manuel Perez de la Mesa functioned as a director for Holdings from July 2002 until his appointment as a director of American Reprographics Company in October 2004. Mr. Perez de la Mesa has been Chief Executive Officer of SCP Pool Corporation, a wholesale distributor of swimming pool supplies and related equipment, since May 2001 and has also been the President of SCP Pool Corporation since February 1999. Mr. Perez de la Mesa served as Chief Operating Officer of SCP Pool Corporation from February 1999 to May 2001.
Board Composition
Prior to our reorganization to a Delaware corporation, we were governed under the direction of a board of advisors, consisting of Messrs. Chandramohan, Suriyakumar, Code, Formolo and Marcus J. George, a managing director of CHS. In connection with our reorganization from a limited liability company to a corporation, we have established a board of directors consisting initially of Messrs. Chandramohan, Suriyakumar, Code, Formolo, and Perez, who are listed above.
In addition, in order to ensure compliance with the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange, the composition of the board of directors may change prior to and following this offering. It is our intention to be in full and timely compliance with all applicable rules of the New York Stock Exchange and applicable law, including with respect to the independence of our directors. As discussed in greater detail below, we intend to comply with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and the New York Stock Exchange rules which require that, among other things, our audit committee include at least a majority of independent directors within 90 days after the effective date of our registration statement. In addition, within one year after such effectiveness, our audit committee must consist entirely of independent directors.
The board has determined that Mr. Perez is an independent director under the rules governing companies listed on the New York Stock Exchange. No later than one year after the completion of this offering, we will satisfy the requirements for independent directors contained in the rules governing companies listed on the New York Stock Exchange through the appointment of three additional independent directors, one of whom will replace one of the five current directors, resulting in a board consisting of seven members, four of whom will be independent.
In accordance with the terms of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation to be filed prior to the completion of this offering, the board of directors will be elected annually. There are no family relationships among any of the directors or executive officers of our company.
Board Compensation
Except for reimbursement for reasonable travel expenses relating to attendance at board meetings and the grant of stock options, employee directors are not compensated for their services as directors. Directors who are not our employees receive cash compensation for their services as directors at a rate of $90,000 per year ($50,000 of which will be payable through annual grants of nonstatutory stock options under our 2005 Stock Plan). In addition, directors who are not our employees will receive $5,000 per year for duties as committee chair. Directors who are our employees are eligible to participate in our 2005 Stock Option Plan and, beginning in 2005, they will also be eligible to participate in our 2005 Employee Stock Purchase Plan. See Benefit Plans.
75
Board Committees
Audit Committee
Presently, our audit committee consists of Messrs. Perez, and . Mr. Perez is an audit committee financial expert and is an independent audit committee member. Our audit committee must have at least one independent member at the time our registration statement becomes effective, as required by the rules governing companies listed on the New York Stock Exchange. The audit committee must have a majority of independent members within 90 days after the effective date of our registration statement and the entire audit committee must consist of independent members within one year after the effective date of our registration statement, one of which must be a financial expert. The audit committee will comply with all of the rules governing companies listed on the New York Stock Exchange.
Our audit committee is responsible for reviewing the adequacy of our system of internal accounting controls; reviewing the results of the independent accountants annual audit, including any significant adjustments, management judgments and estimates, new accounting policies and disagreements with management; reviewing our audited financial statements and discussing the statements with management; reviewing the audit reports submitted by the independent registered public accounting firm; reviewing disclosures by the independent registered public accounting firm concerning relationships with our company and the performance of our independent registered public accounting firm and annually recommending the independent registered public accounting firm; and preparing such reports or statements as may be required by securities laws.
Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee
We do not currently have a nominating committee. The responsibilities of a nominating committee have been assumed by our board of directors. Following the completion of this offering, we will have a corporate governance and nominating committee and anticipate that it will consist of individuals who meet the independence requirements established by the New York Stock Exchange. The corporate governance and nominating committee will, among other things, identify individuals qualified to become members of the board of directors, select or recommend to the board of directors the nominees to stand for election as directors and develop and recommend to the board of directors a set of corporate governance principles. The corporate governance and nominating committee will be governed by a charter that complies with the rules of the New York Stock Exchange.
Compensation Committee
We do not currently have a compensation
committee. The responsibilities of a compensation committee have
been assumed by our board of directors. Following the completion
of this offering, we anticipate that our compensation committee
will consist of individuals meeting the independence
requirements established by the New York Stock Exchange. The
compensation committee will, among other things, review, approve
and make determinations concerning our compensation practices,
policies and procedures for the members of senior management.
The compensation committee will be governed by a charter that
complies with the rules of the New York Stock Exchange.
Compensation Committee Interlocks and
Insider Participation
During 2003, our entire board of advisors,
consisting of Messrs. Chandramohan, Suriyakumar, Code,
Formolo, and George, determined executive compensation. We did
not have a compensation committee apart from the board of
advisors. During 2003, Mr. Chandramohan served as our Chief
Executive Officer and Mr. Suriyakumar served as our
President and Chief Operating Officer.
76
Messrs. Code and Formolo, both members of
our board of directors, are affiliated with CHS Management IV,
L.P. We are party to a management agreement with CHS Management
IV, L.P., pursuant to which CHS Management IV, L.P. has agreed
to provide certain consulting services to us. The management
agreement will be terminated upon the consummation of this
offering.
Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar, both
members of our board of advisors, are affiliated with Sumo
Holdings LA, LLC, Sumo Holdings San Jose, LLC, Sumo
Holdings Irvine, LLC, Sumo Holdings Sacramento, LLC, Sumo
Holdings Maryland, LLC, and Sumo Holdings Costa Mesa, LLC, each
of which are parties to various real property leases with our
subsidiaries relating to our facilities.
For a further description of the transactions
between the members of our board of directors, their affiliates
and us, see Certain Relationships and Related
Transactions.
Executive Compensation
The compensation paid to our Chief Executive
Officer and the only other executive officers who received
compensation in excess of $100,000 for services in all
capacities to our company and our subsidiaries during 2003 is
set forth below. We did not grant any options or membership unit
appreciation rights, restricted units or long-term incentive
plan, or LTIP, awards to our executive officers during 2003.
Summary Compensation Table
Annual Compensation
Other Annual
All Other
Name and Principal Position
Salary
Bonus
Compensation(1)
Compensation
$
600,000
$
$
52,150
(2)
$
288
(3)
Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief
Executive Officer
600,000
65,527
(4)
288
(3)
President, Chief Operating Officer and
Director
200,000
387,000
1,288
(5)
Chief Financial Officer and
Secretary
360,000
2,688
(6)
Chief Technology Officer
(1) | Certain personal benefits provided by us to the named executive officers are not included in the above table as permitted by the SEC regulations because the aggregate amount of such personal benefits for each named executive officer in each year reflected in the table did not exceed the lesser of $50,000 or 10% of the sum of such officers salary and bonus in each respective year. |
(2) | Includes $47,770 for automobile lease payments. |
(3) | Consists of premiums for life insurance. |
(4) | Consists of automobile lease payments. |
(5) | Consists of $288 of premiums for life insurance and $1,000 paid by us as the employer match under our 401(k) plan. |
(6) | Consists of $288 of premiums for life insurance and $2,400 paid by us as the employer match under our 401(k) plan. |
77
Option Grants During the Year Ended December 31, 2003
During 2003, no options to purchase any shares of common stock were granted to the named executive officers listed in the above Summary Compensation Table. None of such persons received awards of stock appreciation rights, restricted stock or LTIP awards during 2003.
Aggregated Option Exercises During the Year Ended December 31, 2003 and Value of Options Held at December 31, 2003
The following table provides summary information
concerning the shares of common stock acquired in 2003, the
value realized upon exercise of stock options in 2003, and the
year end number and value of unexercised options with respect to
each of the named executive officers as of December 31,
2003. The value was calculated by determining the difference
between the fair market value of underlying securities and the
exercise price. The fair market value of our common stock at
December 31, 2003 was assumed to be
$ per
share.
Fiscal Year-End Option Values
Number of
Securities
Value of
Underlying
Unexercised
Unexercised
in-the-Money
Options at
Options at
FY-End(#)
FY-End($)
Shares
Acquired on
Value
Exercisable/
Exercisable/
Name
Exercise(#)
Realized($)
Unexercisable
Unexercisable
420,000/280,000
/
During 2004, we granted Mr. Legg an option to purchase 15,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $5.62 per share, and granted Mr. Roy an option to purchase 100,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $5.85 per share.
Employment Agreements
We had an agreement with each of Mr. Chandramohan and Mr. Suriyakumar that expired in December 2002. These agreements provided that, at the closing of an acquisition, each would be paid in cash a fee equal to one percent (1%) of the aggregate consideration paid by us in connection with the acquisition (including, without limitation, all interest bearing obligations assumed, the deferred purchase price of property or assets, all non-compete, consulting, employment or lease arrangements and similar forms of consideration). For purposes of these agreements with Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar, acquisition was defined as an acquisition by us of all or substantially all of the outstanding capital stock or of all or substantially all of the assets and business of any person, division or any similar business unit of any person. Since the expiration of these agreements, we have continued to pay Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar acquisition bonuses in accordance with the agreements. These payments will be discontinued upon the consummation of this offering. We intend to enter into new employment agreements with each of our executive officers that will be effective upon the consummation of this offering.
We have entered into a 2004 Bonus Plan with Mr. Legg that provides for the payment to Mr. Legg of (1) a bonus of up to $300,000 based on the financial results for the twelve months ended December 31, 2004 of three divisions specified in the Bonus Plan (up to $100,000 bonus per division), (2) a bonus of $100,000 for the repayment of no less than $30,700,000 of bank debt by December 31, 2004 (subject to increase for repayments of bank debt above this amount), and (3) a
78
Benefit Plans
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit Option Plan II
On January 1, 2001, Holdings adopted the American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit Option Plan II, or Unit Plan, under which selected employees, independent advisors, members of the board of advisors of Holdings (or any subsidiary) or members of the board of directors of any subsidiary may be granted common unit options. The members of Holdings approved the Unit Plan on December 22, 2000. Under the Unit Plan, 1,735,415 shares of Holdings plan member common units have been reserved for the grant of options. As of December 31, 2003, options to purchase a total of 1,446,000 plan member common units were outstanding under the Unit Plan. The exercise price of the units is to be determined by the board of advisors, provided, however, that the option price is not to be less than 85% of the fair market value of such unit at the time such option is granted, or, in the case of a person who owns units possessing more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all units of Holdings, 110% of the fair market value of such unit at the time such option is granted. For purposes of the Unit Plan, the term fair market value means the fair market value of a unit determined as of any particular date by the board of advisors, on a fully diluted basis assuming the exercise or conversion of all then exercisable options, warrants, and other rights to purchase units and, to the extent that the board of advisors in its discretion determines to be appropriate, the exercise or conversion of such options, warrants, and other rights to purchase units that are not then exercisable or convertible.
Holdings board of advisors is to determine the vesting period of each option at the date of the grant, provided, however, that except for options granted to officers or consultants, or officers, directors or consultants of any of Holdings subsidiaries, each option shall become exercisable at no lesser rate than 20% for each full year elapsed after the grant of the option and on or before termination of service as an employee until fully exercisable. Upon termination of employment, Holdings and an affiliate of Holdings, ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., have the right to redeem the options. On July 1, 2003, Holdings amended the Unit Plan to extend the exercise period and vesting period for certain optionholders, provided (a) the optionholder had been employed by Holdings or any of its subsidiaries for a period of at least 10 years, (b) the optionholder was at least 55 years old on the date of termination, and (c) the optionholders service with Holdings and any of its subsidiaries terminated because of his or her retirement or any other voluntary reason other than his or her death or permanent disability. If an optionholder satisfies the aforementioned criteria, Holdings may elect to treat the portion of the option that was exercisable on the date of such termination of employment as exercisable by the optionholder until such time that he or she chose to compete (as defined in the Unit Plan) with Holdings or any of its subsidiaries. In addition, as long as the optionholder did not compete with Holdings or any of its subsidiaries, the option would continue to vest according to the Unit Plan and the applicable option agreement.
Upon completion of this offering, members of Holdings will exchange their outstanding options granted under the Unit Plan for options under our 2005 Stock Plan exercisable for shares of our common stock equal to the number of units subject to the Holdings option and with the same exercise price and vesting terms as the Holdings option and all outstanding options under the Unit Plan will be canceled. The Unit Plan will be terminated prior to the completion of this offering, and no additional options will be granted under the Unit Plan.
79
2005 Stock Plan
We will adopt the American Reprographics Company
2005 Stock Plan, and obtain stockholder approval of the plan,
prior to the completion of this offering. Upon our
reorganization, all outstanding options under our Unit Option
Plan will be canceled in exchange for an option under our 2005
Stock Plan exercisable for shares of our common stock equal to
the number of units subject to the Holdings option and with the
same exercise price and vesting terms as the Holdings option.
The 2005 Stock Plan will be administered by our compensation
committee.
Type of
Awards.
The 2005 Stock Plan
provides for the discretionary grant after the consummation of
this offering of incentive stock options (within the provisions
of Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code) to employees,
including officers and employee directors, and for the
discretionary grant of nonstatutory stock options, restricted
stock awards, and restricted stock unit awards to employees,
directors and consultants. No person may be granted options
under the 2005 Stock Plan covering more than 500,000 shares of
common stock in any calendar year.
Reservation of
Shares.
The total shares of common
stock currently reserved and authorized for issuance under the
2005 Stock Plan equals 5,000,000 shares of common stock.
This authorization shall automatically increase annually on the
first day of our fiscal year, from 2006 through and including
2010, by the lesser of (i) 1.0% of the outstanding shares
on the date of the increase; (ii) 300,000 shares; or
(iii) such smaller number of shares determined by our board
of directors. The board may elect to increase, with stockholder
approval, or reduce the number of additional shares authorized
in any given year. In the event of a stock split or other
alteration in our capital structure, appropriate adjustments
will be made to the authorized shares and outstanding awards to
prevent dilution or enlargement of participants rights.
Administration.
Our compensation committee, which generally administers the 2005
Stock Plan, has the authority to determine the terms of the
options, restricted stock, and restricted stock units granted,
including the exercise price of the option or purchase price for
a restricted stock grant or restricted stock unit; the number of
shares subject to each option or restricted stock grant or the
number of restricted stock units; the vesting and exercise forms
of each award; and the form of consideration payable upon the
exercise of each option or stock purchase right.
Nonassignability.
Generally, options, restricted stock or other awards granted
under our 2005 Stock Plan are not transferable by the
participant, and each option is exercisable during the lifetime
of the participant and only by such participant.
Stock
Options.
The exercise price of
nonstatutory stock options and stock purchase rights granted
under the 2005 Stock Plan is determined by the compensation
committee. With respect to nonstatutory stock options, the
exercise price must be at least equal to the fair market value
of our common stock on the date of grant. Generally, the
exercise price of all incentive stock options must be at least
equal to the fair market value of the common stock on the date
of grant. With respect to any participant who owns stock
possessing more than 10% of the voting power of all classes of
our outstanding capital stock, the exercise price of any
incentive stock option granted must at least equal 110% of the
fair market value on the grant date and the term of such
incentive stock option must not exceed five years. The term of
all other options granted under the 2005 Stock Plan may not
exceed 10 years. Options granted under the 2005 Stock Plan
vest at the rate specified in the option agreement. Unless the
terms of an optionholders stock option agreement provide
for earlier or later termination, if an optionholders
service with us, or any affiliate of ours, ceases due to
disability or death, the optionholder, or his or her
beneficiary, may exercise any vested options up to
12 months, or 18 months in the event of death, after
the date such service ends. If an optionholders service
with us, or any affiliate of ours, ceases without cause for any
reason other than disability or death, the optionholder may
exercise any vested options up to three months from cessation of
service, unless the terms of the stock option agreement provide
for earlier or later termination. If an optionholders
service with us, or any affiliate of ours, ceases with cause,
the option will terminate at the time such service ceases. In no
event may an option be exercised after its expiration date.
80
Restricted Stock
Awards.
Restricted stock awards
granted under the 2005 Stock Plan may be either in the form of a
restricted stock purchase right, giving the participant a right
to immediately purchase common stock, or in the form of a
restricted stock award, for which the participant will be
required to furnish consideration in the form of services to us
(in consideration for past services to us). The purchase price
shall be determined by the committee and may be less than the
current fair market value of the common stock. Restricted stock
awards may be subject to vesting conditions based upon such
services to be rendered as specified by the committee, and the
shares acquired may not be transferred by the participant until
vested. If a restricted stock award recipients service
with us, or any affiliate of ours, terminates, we may reacquire
all of the shares of our common stock issued to the recipient
pursuant to a restricted stock award which have not vested as of
the date of termination. Participants holding restricted stock
will be permitted to vote the shares and receive any dividends
paid in cash.
Restricted Stock
Units.
Restricted stock units
granted under the 2005 Stock Plan represent a right to receive
payment for units in the form or cash or shares of our common
stock at a future date determined in accordance with the
participants award agreement. The consideration for a
restricted stock unit award may be payable in any form permitted
under applicable laws. Restricted stock unit awards shall be
granted subject to vesting conditions as determined by the
compensation committee. Participants have no voting rights or
rights to receive cash dividends with respect to restricted
stock unit awards until shares of common stock are issued in
settlement of such awards. However, the compensation committee
may grant restricted stock units that entitle their holders to
receive dividend equivalents, which are rights to receive
additional restricted stock units for a number of shares whose
value is equal to any cash dividends we pay. If a restricted
stock unit award recipients service with us, or any
affiliate of ours, terminates, any unvested portion of the
restricted stock unit award is forfeited upon the
recipients termination of service.
Non-Employee Director
Awards.
Commencing with our first
annual meeting of stockholders (on or after the effective date
of this offering), each non-employee director automatically will
receive a nonstatutory stock option with a fair market value, as
determined under the Black-Scholes option pricing formula, equal
to $50,000 (or 55.56%) of such non-employee directors
annual cash compensation (exclusive of committee fees). Each
nonstatutory stock option will cover his or her service since
either the previous annual meeting or the date on which he or
she was first elected or appointed.
Corporate Transactions and Change in
Control.
In the event of certain
corporate transactions, the surviving entity may assume all
stock-based awards outstanding under the 2005 Stock Plan or
substitute substantially equivalent awards. If the surviving
entity elects not to assume or substitute for all such awards,
then with respect to stock-based awards held by persons
providing us or any of our affiliates service, the vesting (and,
if applicable, the time during which the award may be exercised)
will be accelerated in full. Stock awards will terminate if not
exercised (if applicable) before the effective time of the
corporate transaction. In addition, the relevant award agreement
may accelerate the vesting and settlement of any award upon a
change in control.
Amendment and
Termination.
The 2005 Stock Plan
will continue in effect until the tenth anniversary of its
approval by the board of directors or our stockholders,
whichever is earlier, unless earlier terminated by the board of
directors. The board of directors may amend, suspend or
terminate the 2005 Stock Plan at any time, provided that without
stockholder approval, the plan cannot be amended to increase the
number of shares authorized, change the class of persons
eligible to receive incentive stock options or effect any other
change that would require stockholder approval under any
applicable law or listing rule. Amendment, suspension or
termination of the 2005 Stock Plan may not adversely affect any
outstanding award without the consent of the participant, unless
such amendment, suspension or termination is necessary to comply
with applicable laws, regulations or rules.
81
2005 Employee Stock Purchase
Plan
We will adopt the American Reprographics Company
2005 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, or ESPP, and obtain
stockholder approval of the plan, prior to the completion of
this offering.
Purpose.
The
purpose of the ESPP is to advance our interests and the
interests of our stockholders by providing an incentive to
attract, retain and reward eligible employees. It is intended to
qualify as an employee stock purchase plan under
Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Code.
Shares Subject to Purchase
Plan.
A total of
750,000 shares of our common stock are initially authorized
and reserved for sale under the ESPP. Appropriate adjustments
will be made in the number of authorized shares and in
outstanding purchase rights to prevent dilution or enlargement
of participants rights in the event of a stock split or
other change in our capital structure.
Administration.
Our board of directors or a committee of the board will serve as
administrator of the ESPP. The administrator has the authority
to construe and interpret the terms of the ESPP and the purchase
rights granted under it, to determine eligibility to
participate, and to establish policies and procedures for
administration of the plan.
Eligibility.
Our employees and employees of any parent corporation designated
by the administrator are eligible to participate in the ESPP if
they are customarily employed by us for more than 20 hours
per week and more than five months in any calendar year.
However, an employee may not be granted a right to purchase
stock under the ESPP if: (1) the employee immediately after
grant would own stock possessing 5 percent or more of the
total combined voting power or value of all classes of our
capital stock or of any parent or subsidiary corporation, or
(2) the employees rights to purchase stock under all
of our employee stock purchase plans would accrue at a rate that
exceeds $25,000 in value for each calendar year of participation
in such plans.
Offerings.
The ESPP is implemented by offerings of purchase rights to
eligible employees. Under the ESPP, we may specify offerings
with a duration of not more than 27 months, and may specify
shorter purchase periods within each offering. A new offering
will automatically begin on March 1 and September 1 of
each year, will generally be 24 months in duration and will
consist of four six-month purchase periods, except that the
first offering will commence on the effective date of the ESPP
and will end on August 31, 2005. The administrator is
authorized to establish additional or alternative sequential or
overlapping offering periods and offering periods having a
different duration or different starting or ending dates,
provided that no offering period may have a duration exceeding
27 months.
Participation.
Eligible employees who enroll in the ESPP may elect to have up
to 15 percent of their eligible compensation withheld and
accumulated for the purchase of shares at the end of each
purchase period in each offering in which they participate.
However, all eligible employees will be automatically enrolled
in the ESPPs initial offering period and may only purchase
shares by delivering an exercise notice and payment of the
applicable purchase price prior to the initial purchase date,
provided that participants may elect to begin payroll deductions
under the ESPP after the effective date of a Form S-8
registration statement registering the shares reserved for
issuance under the ESPP. Participants may voluntarily withdraw
from the ESPP at any time during an offering period and receive
a refund, without interest, of all amount withheld from
compensation not previously applied to purchase shares.
Participation ends automatically upon termination of employment.
Purchase of
Shares.
Amounts accumulated for
each participant are used to purchase shares of our common stock
at the end of each purchase period at a price generally equal to
85 percent of the lower of the fair market value of our
common stock at the beginning of an offering period or at the
end of the corresponding purchase period. Prior to commencement
of an offering period, the administrator is authorized to
reduce, but not increase, this purchase price discount for that
offering period, or, under the circumstances described in the
ESPP, during that offering period; provided that
82
Corporate
Transactions.
In the event of
certain corporate transactions, an acquiring or successor
corporation may assume our rights and obligations under the
ESPP. If the acquiring or successor corporation does not assume
such rights and obligations or does not substitute them with
similar rights and obligations, then the purchase date of the
offering periods then in progress will be accelerated to a date
prior to the effective time of the corporate transaction.
Nonassignability.
Rights granted under the ESPP are not transferable by a
participant other than by will or the laws of descent and
distribution. However, a participant may designate a beneficiary
who is to receive any cash and/or shares from the
participants account in the event the participants
death.
Amendment and
Termination.
The ESPP will
continue in effect until terminated by the administrator. The
administrator may amend, suspend or terminate the ESPP at any
time, provided that unless stockholder approval is obtained
within 12 months of such amendment, the plan cannot be
amended to increase the number of shares authorized or change
the definition of the corporations that may be designated by the
administrator for participation in the plan. Amendment,
suspension or termination of the ESPP may not adversely affect
any purchase rights previously granted without the consent of
the participant, unless such amendment, suspension or
termination is necessary to qualify the plan under
Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Code or to comply with
applicable law, or is effected after a determination by the
administrator that continuation of the plan or an offering
period would result in unfavorable accounting consequences to us
as a result of a change, after the plans effective date,
in the generally accepted accounting principles applicable to
the ESPP.
401(k) Plan
Holdings sponsors a defined contribution plan
intended to qualify under Section 401 of the Internal
Revenue Code covering substantially all employees who are at
least 21 years of age. Plan participants may contribute up
to 75% of their annual eligible compensation, subject to
contribution limitations imposed by the Internal Revenue
Service. Holdings matches up to 20% of a participants
contributions up to a maximum of 4% of their eligible annual
compensation.
83
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS
Certain of our directors, executive officers, 5% beneficial owners and their affiliates have engaged in transactions with us in the ordinary course of business. We believe these transactions involved terms comparable to terms that would be obtained from an unaffiliated third party at the times the transactions were consummated. The following is a description of these transactions:
Related Party Leases and Purchases
We are party to certain leases with entities owned by Mr. Chandramohan and Mr. Suriyakumar for our facilities located in Los Angeles, California, San Jose, California, Irvine, California, Sacramento, California, Oakland, California, Gaithersburg, Maryland, and Costa Mesa, California. Under these leases, we paid these entities rent in the aggregate amount of approximately $1,036,356 in 2001, $1,092,600 in 2002, $1,092,600 in 2003, and $1,119,785 for the nine months ended September 30, 2004. We are also obligated to reimburse these entities for certain real property taxes and assessments. These leases expire between January 2006 and December 2013.
We sell certain products and services to Thomas Reprographics, Inc. and Albinson Inc., each of which is owned or controlled by William Thomas, who beneficially owns more than 5% of our common equity. These companies purchased products and services from us of approximately $215,000 and $95,000 during the twelve months ended December 31, 2002 and 2003, respectively, and $45,000 during the nine months ended September 30, 2004.
Management Agreement
We are party to a management agreement with CHS Management IV, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership. Messrs. Code and Formolo, both members of our board of directors, have a direct beneficial ownership in CHS Management IV, L.P. Under the management agreement, we paid CHS Management IV, L.P. a management fee of $803,000 in 2001, $889,000 in 2002 and $858,000 in 2003, and we anticipate paying CHS Management IV, L.P. a management fee of $858,000 in 2004. The annual management fee is subject to an annual increase based on our financial results but shall not exceed $1,000,000 annually. This management fee is in consideration of CHS Management IV, L.P. providing ongoing consulting and management advisory services to us. Our board of directors may terminate the management agreement if it determines in good faith that CHS Management IV, L.P. has materially failed to diligently provide such management services. This management agreement will be terminated upon our initial public offering.
Indemnification Agreements
We will enter into indemnification agreements with each director which provide indemnification under certain circumstances for acts and omissions which may not be covered by any directors and officers liability insurance. The indemnification agreements may require us, among other things, to indemnify our officers and directors against certain liabilities that may arise by reason of their status or service as officers and directors (other than liabilities arising from willful misconduct of a culpable nature), to advance their expenses incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as to which they could be indemnified, and to obtain officers and directors insurance if available on reasonable terms.
Registration Rights Agreement
We have entered into a registration rights agreement with certain holders of our common stock and holders of warrants to purchase our common stock, including entities affiliated with certain of our executive officers and directors. The holders of 27,220,839 shares of common stock and the holders of 1,168,842 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of warrants are entitled to certain rights with respect to the registration of such shares under the Securities Act. For more detailed information regarding these registration rights, please see Description of Capital Stock Registration Rights Agreement.
84
Investor Unitholders Agreement
Holdings entered into an Investor Unitholders Agreement with ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. and certain other parties that hold warrants to purchase Holdings common units. Under this agreement, subject to certain exceptions, (i) Holdings has a right of first refusal in connection with a transfer of units acquired by the warrant holders, (ii) the warrant holders have a right to participate in transfers of units by ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., (iii) ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. has limited preemptive rights in connection with an issuance of units by Holdings to the warrant holders and the warrant holders have limited preemptive rights in connection with an issuance of units by Holdings to ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., (iv) the warrant holders have the right to receive certain financial information from Holdings, and (v) the warrant holders have certain property inspection rights. The Investor Unitholders Agreement will be terminated upon the consummation of this offering.
85
PRINCIPAL AND SELLING STOCKHOLDERS
The following table sets forth information, as of December 1, 2004, regarding the beneficial ownership of our common stock: (1) immediately prior to the consummation of the offering, but after giving effect to our reorganization; and (2) as adjusted to reflect the sale of the shares of common stock in this offering, by:
| each of our directors and named executive officers; |
| all directors and named executive officers as a group; |
| each person who is known to us to own beneficially more than 5% of our common stock; and |
| each of the selling stockholders. |
The table includes all shares of common stock issuable within 60 days of December 1, 2004 upon the exercise of options and other rights beneficially owned by the indicated stockholders on that date. Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with the rules of the SEC and includes voting and investment power with respect to shares. To our knowledge, except under applicable community property laws or as otherwise indicated in the footnotes to this table, the persons named in the table have sole voting and sole investment control regarding all shares beneficially owned. The applicable percentage of ownership for each stockholder is based on 35,510,011 shares of common stock outstanding as of December 1, 2004, together with applicable options for that stockholder. Shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of options and other rights beneficially owned were deemed outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of the person holding these options and other rights, but are not deemed outstanding for computing the percentage ownership of any other person.
Shares Beneficially | Shares Beneficially | ||||||||||||||||||||
Owned | Owned | ||||||||||||||||||||
Prior to Offering | After Offering*** | ||||||||||||||||||||
|
Number of |
|
|||||||||||||||||||
Name and Address* | Number | Percent | Shares Offered(1) | Number | Percent | ||||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
||||||||||||||||
Principal Stockholders:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C.(2)
|
17,334,221 | 48.8 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
10 S. Wacker Drive, Suite 3175
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Chicago, IL 90606
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Micro Device, Inc.
|
7,064,964 | 19.9 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
William Thomas(3)(4)
|
5,075,964 | 14.3 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
600 North Central Expressway
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Richardson, TX 75080
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
OCB Reprographics, Inc.
|
4,616,631 | 13.0 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
17721 Mitchell North
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Irvine, CA 92714
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Directors and Named Executive
Officers:
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Andrew W. Code(5)
|
17,334,221 | 48.8 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Thomas J. Formolo(5)
|
17,334,221 | 48.8 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Sathiyamurthy Chandramohan(3)(4)(6)(7)(8)
|
14,810,502 | 41.7 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Kumarakulasingam Suriyakumar(3)(4)(6)(7)(8)(9)
|
14,777,145 | 41.6 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
1981 N. Broadway, Suite 202
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Walnut Creek, CA 94596
|
|||||||||||||||||||||
Rahul K. Roy(10)
|
637,500 | 1.8 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Mark W. Legg(11)
|
335,001 | ** |
86
Shares Beneficially | Shares Beneficially | |||||||||||||||||||
Owned | Owned | |||||||||||||||||||
Prior to Offering | After Offering*** | |||||||||||||||||||
|
Number of |
|
||||||||||||||||||
Name and Address* | Number | Percent | Shares Offered(1) | Number | Percent | |||||||||||||||
|
|
|
|
|
|
|||||||||||||||
Manuel Perez de la Mesa(12)
|
45,500 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
All directors and executive officers as a group
(seven persons)
|
33,284,866 | 92.3 | % | |||||||||||||||||
Other Selling Stockholders:
|
||||||||||||||||||||
Brownies Blueprint, Inc.
|
1,656,051 | 4.7 | % | |||||||||||||||||
Dietrich-Post Company
|
858,024 | 2.4 | % | |||||||||||||||||
Color Expressions of California, Inc.
|
459,333 | 1.3 | % | |||||||||||||||||
Ted Carlson
|
300,000 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Steve Gilmore
|
300,000 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Patrick Duggan
|
225,000 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Richard Nelson
|
75,000 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Ken Gini(13)
|
41,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Jack Anderson
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Janine Brandel
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
John Coats
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Johann De Abeyesinhe
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
David Dodge(14)
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Trevor Fernando
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Dan Hagan
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Doug McCrae
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Monita Sarthou
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Virgilio Sim
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Noel Van Langenberg
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Laurie Williams
|
35,001 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
CHS Associates IV, L.P.
|
28,465 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Karl Winkelman
|
9,000 | ** | ||||||||||||||||||
Paige Walsh
|
1,473 | ** |
* | Except as otherwise noted, the address of each person listed in the table is c/o American Reprographics Company, 700 North Central Avenue, Suite 550, Glendale, California 91203. |
** | Less than one percent of the outstanding shares of common stock. |
*** | Assumes underwriters have not exercised their option to purchase additional shares. | |
(1) | If the underwriters overallotment option is exercised in full, the additional shares sold would be allocated among the selling stockholders as follows: |
Shares Beneficially | ||||||||||||
Owned Assuming | ||||||||||||
Exercise of | ||||||||||||
Shares Beneficially | Overallotment | |||||||||||
Owned Subject to | Option | |||||||||||
Overallotment |
|
|||||||||||
Selling Stockholders | Option | Number | Percent | |||||||||
|
|
|
|
|||||||||
ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C.
|
||||||||||||
Andrew W. Code(5)
|
||||||||||||
Thomas J. Formolo(5)
|
||||||||||||
CHS Associates IV, L.P.
|
||||||||||||
Paige Walsh
|
If the underwriters overallotment option is exercised in part, the additional shares sold would be allocated pro rata based upon the share amounts set forth in the preceding table. |
87
(2) | The sole member of ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. is Code Hennessey Simmons IV, L.P. The general partner of Code Hennessy Simmons IV, L.P. is CHS Management IV, L.P. The general partner of CHS Management IV, L.P. is Code Hennessy & Simmons LLC. Code Hennessy & Simmons LLC, CHS Management IV, L.P. and Code Hennessy Simmons IV, L.P. may be deemed to beneficially own these shares, but disclaim beneficial ownership of shares in which they do not have a pecuniary interest. The investment committee of Code Hennessy & Simmons LLC is composed of Andrew W. Code, Daniel J. Hennessy, Brian P. Simmons, Thomas J. Formolo, Jon S. Vesely and Peter M. Gotsch. Messrs. Code, Hennessy, Simmons, Formolo, Vesely and Gotsch may be deemed to beneficially own these shares due to the fact that they share investment and voting control over shares held by ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., but disclaim beneficial ownership of shares in which they do not have a pecuniary interest. | |
(3) | Includes 4,616,631 shares held by OCB Reprographics, Inc. As Messrs. Chandramohan, Suriyakumar and Thomas have ownership interests of 22.4%, 17.6% and 40%, respectively, in OCB Reprographics, Inc. and serve on its Board of Directors, each could be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all these shares. Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar each disclaim beneficial ownership of these shares except to the extent of each of their pecuniary interests therein. | |
(4) | Includes 459,333 shares held by Color Expressions of California, Inc. As Messrs. Chandramohan, Suriyakumar and Thomas have ownership interests of 24.8%, 19.5% and 26.7%, respectively, in Color Expressions of California, Inc. and serve on its Board of Directors, each could be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all these shares. Messrs. Chandramohan and, Suriyakumar each disclaim beneficial ownership of these shares except to the extent of each of their pecuniary interests therein. | |
(5) | Andrew W. Code and Thomas J. Formolo are members of the investment committee of Code Hennessy & Simmons LLC, the general partner of CHS Management IV, L.P., which in turn is the general partner of Code, Hennessy & Simmons IV, L.P., which is the sole member of ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. Messrs. Code and Formolo may be deemed to beneficially own the shares owned by ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., but disclaim beneficial ownership of shares in which they do not have a pecuniary interest. | |
(6) | Includes 7,064,964 shares held by Micro-Device, Inc. As Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar have ownership interests of 56% and 44%, respectively, in Micro-Device, Inc. and serve on its Board of Directors, each could be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all these shares. Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar each disclaim beneficial ownership of these shares except to the extent of each of their pecuniary interests therein. | |
(7) | Includes 1,656,051 shares held by Brownies Blueprint, Inc. As Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar have ownership interests of 42% and 33%, respectively, in Brownies Blueprint, Inc. and serve on its Board of Directors, each could be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all these shares. Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar each disclaim beneficial ownership of these shares except to the extent of each of their pecuniary interests therein. | |
(8) | Includes 858,024 shares held by Dietrich-Post Company. As Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar have ownership interests of 47.6% and 37.4%, respectively, in Dietrich-Post Company and serve on its Board of Directors, each could be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all these shares. Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar each disclaim beneficial ownership of these shares except to the extent of each of their pecuniary interests therein. | |
(9) | Includes 122,142 shares held by the Suriyakumar Family Trust. Mr. Suriyakumar and his spouse, as trustees of the Suriyakumar Family Trust, share voting and investment power over these shares. |
(10) | Includes 540,000 shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of December 1, 2004. |
(11) | Shares held by the Legg Family Trust. Mr. Legg and his spouse, as trustees of the Legg Family Trust, share voting and investment power over these shares. |
(12) | Includes 25,500 shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of December 1, 2004. Includes 6,000 shares held by Mr. Perezs children. |
(13) | Includes 6,000 shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options exercisable within 60 days of December 1, 2004. |
(14) | Shares held by David N. Dodge and Linda P. Dodge, as trustees of the David and Linda Dodge Family Trust u/a/d March 12, 2004. Mr. Dodge has sole voting and investment control over these shares. |
88
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
Our authorized capital stock consists of 150 million shares of common stock, $.001 par value per share, and 25 million shares of undesignated preferred stock, $.001 par value per share. Immediately following the consummation of this offering of the authorized shares of common stock will be issued and outstanding and no shares of our preferred stock will be outstanding.
Common Stock
The holders of common stock are entitled to one vote for each share held of record on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders. Subject to preferences that may be applicable to any outstanding preferred stock, holders of common stock are entitled to receive ratably such dividends as may be declared by the board of directors out of funds legally available for that purpose. See Dividend Policy. In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, the holders of common stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after payment of liabilities, subject to the prior distribution rights of any outstanding preferred stock. The common stock has no preemptive or conversion rights or other subscription rights. The outstanding shares of common stock (after giving effect to our reorganization) are, and the shares of common stock to be issued upon completion of this offering will be, fully paid and non-assessable.
Preferred Stock
Upon the closing of this offering, the board of directors will have the authority, without further action by the stockholders, to issue up to 25 million shares of preferred stock, $.001 par value, in one or more series. The board of directors will also have the authority to designate the rights, preferences, privileges, and restrictions of each such series, including dividend rights, dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of redemption, redemption prices, liquidation preferences, and the number of shares constituting any series.
The issuance of preferred stock may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our company without further action by the stockholders. The issuance of preferred stock with voting and conversion rights may also adversely affect the voting power of the holders of common stock. In certain circumstances, an issuance of preferred stock could have the effect of decreasing the market price of the common stock. As of the closing of the offering, no shares of preferred stock will be outstanding and we currently have no plans to issue any shares of preferred stock.
Registration Rights Agreement
The holders of 27,220,839 shares of common stock and the holders of 1,168,842 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of warrants are entitled to rights with respect to the registration of their shares under the Securities Act. These registration rights are contained in a registration rights agreement and are described below.
Demand Registrations. At any time following six months after the closing of this offering, the holders of a majority of the registrable securities held by ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C. and the holders of a majority of the registrable securities held by Messrs. Chandramohan and Suriyakumar (or entities in which they control a majority of the voting shares) shall each be entitled (as a group) to request up to two registrations on Form S-1 or similar long-form registration statements, respectively, and two short-form registrations on Form S-2, S-3 or any similar short-form registration statements, respectively. The holders of a majority of all other registrable securities under this agreement are entitled to request one short-form registration.
89
Piggyback Rights. The holders of registrable securities other than those originally requesting registration pursuant to a demand registration can request to participate in, or piggyback on, any demand registration.
Piggyback Registrations. If we propose to register any of our equity securities under the Securities Act (other than pursuant to a demand registration of registrable securities or a registration on Form S-4 or Form S-8) for us or for holders of securities other than the registrable securities, we will offer the holders of registrable securities the opportunity to register their registrable securities.
Conditions and Limitations; Expenses. The registration rights are subject to conditions and limitations, including the right of the underwriters to limit the number of shares to be included in a registration and our right to delay or withdraw a registration statement under specified circumstances. We will pay the registration expenses of the holders of registrable securities in demand registrations and piggyback registrations in connection with the registration rights agreement.
Warrants
At September 30, 2004, after giving effect to our reorganization as a Delaware corporation, we had outstanding warrants to purchase 1,168,842 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $4.61 per share. The warrants expire on April 10, 2010.
Delaware Anti-Takeover Law and Charter and Bylaw Provisions
Provisions of Delaware law and our charter documents could make the acquisition of our company and the removal of incumbent officers and directors more difficult. These provisions are expected to discourage certain types of coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids and to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of our company to negotiate with it first. We believe that the benefits of increased protection of its potential ability to negotiate with the proponent of an unfriendly or unsolicited proposal to acquire or restructure our company outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging such proposals because, among other things, negotiation of such proposals could result in an improvement of their terms.
Section 203. We are subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law. In general, the statute prohibits a publicly-held Delaware corporation from engaging in a business combination with an interested stockholder for a period of three years after the date that the person became an interested stockholder unless, subject to exceptions, the business combination or the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder is approved in a prescribed manner. Generally, a business combination includes a merger, asset or stock sale, or other transaction resulting in a financial benefit to the stockholder. Generally, an interested stockholder is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years prior, did own, 15% or more of the corporations voting stock. These provisions may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our company without further action by the stockholders.
Special Stockholder Meetings. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that special meetings of the stockholders for any purpose or purposes, unless required by law, may only be called by the board of directors, the chairman of the board, if any, the chief executive officer or the president. This limitation on the ability to call a special meeting could make it more difficult for stockholders to initiate actions that are opposed by the board. These actions could include the removal of an incumbent director or the election of a stockholder nominee as a director. They could also include the implementation of a rule requiring stockholder ratification of specific defensive strategies that have been adopted by the board with respect to unsolicited takeover bids. In addition, the limited ability to call a special meeting of stockholders may make it more difficult to change the existing board and management.
90
Board of Directors. Subject to the rights of the holders of any outstanding series of preferred stock, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will authorize only the board of directors to fill vacancies, including newly created directorships. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will also provide that directors may be removed by stockholders only by affirmative vote of holders of two-thirds of the outstanding shares of voting stock.
Supermajority Vote to Amend Charter and Bylaws. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws each will provide that our bylaws may be amended by our stockholders only with a two-thirds vote of the outstanding shares. In addition, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that its provisions related to, among other things, limitation of director liability and indemnification may only be amended by a two-thirds vote of the outstanding shares.
No Stockholder Action by Written Consent. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that stockholder action can be taken only at an annual or special meeting of stockholders and may not be taken by written consent. The amended and restated bylaws will provide that special meetings of stockholders can be called only by the board of directors, the chairman of the board, if any, the chief executive officer and the president. Moreover, the business permitted to be conducted at any special meeting of stockholders is limited to the business brought before the meeting by the board of directors, the chairman of the board, if any, and the President.
Advance Notice Procedures. Our amended and restated bylaws will provide for an advance notice procedure for the nomination, other than by or at the direction of our board of directors, of candidates for election as directors as well as for other stockholder proposals to be considered at annual meetings of stockholders.
Indemnification Provisions
Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will limit the liability of directors to the maximum extent permitted by Delaware law. Delaware law expressly permits a corporation to provide that its directors will not be personally liable for monetary damages for breach of their fiduciary duties as directors, except liability for:
| any breach of their duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders; |
| acts or omissions that are not in good faith or that involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law; |
| unlawful payments of dividends or unlawful stock repurchases or redemptions; or |
| any transaction from which the director derived an improper personal benefit. |
These express limitations do not apply to liabilities arising under the federal securities laws and do not affect the availability of equitable remedies, including injunctive relief or rescission.
The provisions of Delaware law that relate to indemnification expressly state that the rights provided by the statute are not exclusive and are in addition to any rights provided in a certificate of incorporation, bylaws, agreement or otherwise. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that we will indemnify our directors and officers, to the maximum extent permitted by law and that we may indemnify other employees and agents. Our amended and restated bylaws will also permit us to secure insurance on behalf of any officer, director, employee or agent for any liability arising out of actions in his or her capacity as an officer, director, employee or agent. Prior to the completion of this offering, we will obtain an insurance policy that insures our directors and officers against losses, above a deductible amount, from specified types of claims. We believe that these provisions and policies will help us attract and retain qualified persons.
The limited liability and indemnification provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and any related indemnification agreements may
91
At present, there is no pending litigation or proceeding involving any of our directors, officers or employees in which indemnification is sought, nor are we aware of any threatened litigation that may result in claims for indemnification.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to our directors, officers, employees, and agents under our restated certificate of incorporation or any related indemnification agreements we have been advised that, in the opinion of the SEC, this indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.
Transfer Agent and Registrar
The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is Mellon Investor Services LLC.
92
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
No public market for our common stock existed before this offering. Future sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market could cause the prevailing market price for our common stock to decline. A large number of our outstanding shares of common stock will not be available for sale shortly after this offering because of contractual and legal restrictions on resale as described below. Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market after these restrictions lapse, and the potential for such sales, could depress the prevailing market price of our common stock and limit our ability to raise equity capital in the future.
Upon completion of this offering, we will have outstanding an aggregate of shares of common stock, assuming no exercise of the underwriters over-allotment option. All of the shares sold in this offering, other than those sold to our affiliates, will be freely tradable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act. The remaining shares of common stock held by existing stockholders, as of September 30, 2004, are restricted securities. Subject to the restrictions on transfer contained in the lock-up agreements described in Underwriting, restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if registered or if they qualify for an exemption from registration under the Securities Act.
Lock-Up Agreements
Our executive officers, directors, the selling stockholders and holders of substantially all other shares of our common stock have agreed not to dispose of or hedge, directly or indirectly, any shares of our common stock or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for shares of our common stock, until 180 days after the date of this prospectus. Transfers or dispositions can be made sooner with the prior written consent of Goldman, Sachs & Co. and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc.
Rule 144
In general, under Rule 144 of the Securities Act, beginning 90 days after the date of this prospectus, a person who has beneficially owned shares of our common stock for at least one year would be entitled to sell within any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:
| 1% of the shares of common stock then outstanding, which will equal approximately shares immediately after this offering; or |
| the average weekly trading volume of the common stock on the New York Stock Exchange during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 with respect to the sale. |
We believe that holders of common stock issued to them in exchange for units of our predecessors common equity prior to our recapitalization in contemplation of this offering should generally be able to count the period of time during which they held such predecessor common equity for purposes of determining the length of time they have held our common stock for purposes of Rule 144. Sales under Rule 144 must comply with manner of sale provisions and post-sale notice requirements, and may only occur if information about us is publicly available.
Rule 144(k)
Under Rule 144(k) of the Securities Act, a person who has not been one of our affiliates at any time during the 90 days preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned the shares proposed to be sold for at least two years, is entitled to sell those shares without complying with the manner of sale, public information, volume limitation or notice provisions of Rule 144. Therefore, unless otherwise restricted, shares eligible for sale under Rule 144(k) may be sold immediately upon the completion of this offering.
93
Substantially all of the shares of our common stock outstanding prior to this offering are held by CHS IV or other individuals who are our affiliates, and although many of such shares have been held for at least two years, such shares cannot be sold by any such holder pursuant to Rule 144(k) until 90 days after such holder ceases to be an affiliate.
Rule 701
Rule 701 permits our employees, officers, directors or consultants who purchased shares pursuant to a written compensatory plan or contract to resell such shares in reliance upon Rule 144, but without compliance with certain restrictions. Rule 701 provides that affiliates may, under Rule 144, sell their Rule 701 shares 90 days after effectiveness of this registration statement without complying with the holding period requirement and that non-affiliates may sell such shares in reliance on Rule 144 90 days after effectiveness of this registration statement without complying with the holding period, public information, volume limitation or notice requirements of Rule 144.
Registration Rights
After giving effect to our reorganization as a Delaware corporation, the holders of 28,389,681 shares of our common stock, assuming the exercise of outstanding warrants to purchase registrable securities, may demand that we register their shares under the Securities Act or, if we file another registration statement under the Securities Act, may elect to include their shares in such registration. If these shares are registered, they will be freely tradeable without restriction under the Securities Act. For more detailed information regarding these registration rights, please see Description of Capital Stock Registration Rights Agreement.
Stock Options
Upon the completion of this offering, we intend to file a registration statement on Form S-8 under the Securities Act registering approximately 5.8 million shares of our common stock, including shares issuable under our stock plans. The registration statement will become effective upon filing. Accordingly, shares of our common stock registered under the registration statement on Form S-8 will be available for sale in the open market immediately thereafter, after complying with Rule 144 volume limitations applicable to affiliates and with lock-up restrictions.
94
DESCRIPTION OF CERTAIN INDEBTEDNESS
Senior Secured Credit Facilities
We have two senior secured credit facilities, a $130 million senior first priority secured facility, or first priority facility, and a $225 million senior second priority secured facility, or second priority facility, each pursuant to a credit and guaranty agreement dated as of December 18, 2003 between Opco, Holdings, the domestic subsidiaries of Holdings and a syndicate of financial institutions, including Goldman Sachs Credit Partners L.P. Our first priority facility consists of a $100 million senior first priority secured term loan facility, or term facility, and a $30 million senior first priority secured revolving credit facility, or revolving facility. Our second priority facility consists of a $225 million senior second priority secured term loan facility.
The proceeds of the term facility and a portion of the revolving facility, together with substantially all of the proceeds of the second priority facility, were used to refinance our then existing debt. Amounts remaining available under the revolving facility may be used by us for working capital, certain permitted acquisitions and general corporate purposes.
Maturity
The term facility matures in June 2009, the revolving facility matures in December 2008 and the second priority facility matures in December 2009.
Guarantees and Security
Opcos obligations under each of the credit facilities are guaranteed by Holdings and each of its domestic subsidiaries.
In addition, subject to limited exceptions, the first priority facility is secured by first priority security interests in all of Opcos assets and the assets of Holdings and its domestic subsidiaries and 65% of the assets of its foreign subsidiaries. The second priority facility is secured by second priority security interests in the assets securing the first priority facility. The priority of the security interests and related creditor rights between the first priority facility and the second priority facility are subject to an intercreditor agreement.
Interest and Fees
Loans made under the credit facilities bear interest at a floating rate and may be maintained as index rate loans or as LIBOR rate loans. Index rate loans bear interest at the index rate plus the applicable index rate margin. The index rate is defined as the higher of (1) the rate of interest publicly quoted from time to time by The Wall Street Journal as the base rate on corporate loans posted by at least 75% of the nations 30 largest banks, and (2) the Federal Reserve reported overnight funds rate plus 1/2 of 1%. The LIBOR rate loans bear interest at the LIBOR rate plus the applicable LIBOR rate margin.
The applicable margin with respect to the term facility is 2.00% in the case of index rate loans and 3.00% in the case of LIBOR rate loans. The applicable margin for the revolving facility is determined by a grid based on the ratio of the consolidated indebtedness of Holdings and its subsidiaries to the consolidated adjusted EBITDA (as defined in the credit facilities) of Holdings and its subsidiaries for the most recently ended four fiscal quarters and range between 2.00% and 2.75% for LIBOR rate loans and range between 1.00% and 1.75% for index rate loans.
The applicable margin with respect to loans made under the second priority facility is 5.875% in the case of index rate loans and 6.875% in the case of LIBOR rate loans. However, if the ratio of the consolidated indebtedness of Holdings and its subsidiaries over the consolidated adjusted EBITDA (as defined in the credit facilities) of Holdings and its subsidiaries is greater than 4.8:1.0 for any four fiscal quarters, each of the applicable margins set forth above will be increased by 100 basis points.
95
Under the revolving facility, we are also required to pay a fee equal to 0.50% of the total unused commitment amount. We may also draw upon the credit facilities through letters of credit which carry specific fees.
Covenants
Our credit facilities require Holdings to meet certain financial tests, including minimum interest coverage, maximum leverage and minimum fixed charge coverage ratios. The credit facilities also limit Opcos ability and the ability of Holdings and its other domestic subsidiaries to, among other things, incur debt, incur additional liens, make distributions on or repurchase equity, make certain investments, sell certain assets, enter into operating leases, engage in reorganizations or mergers, or change the character of our business. Certain of these covenants are subject to exceptions and materiality qualifiers.
Mandatory Prepayment
We are required to apply any net proceeds received from (i) asset sales, (ii) insurance on account of any loss of any property or assets, or (iii) the incurrence of indebtedness for borrowed money, first to repay amounts outstanding under the term facility, second, to repay amounts outstanding (and to permanently reduce commitments) under the revolving facility, and third, provided there are no amounts outstanding under the first priority facility, to repay amounts outstanding under the second priority facility, subject to the call premium described below.
Upon our receipt of cash proceeds from (i) the issuance of equity securities by us or any of our subsidiaries or (ii) excess cash flow, we are required to apply 75% of such net proceeds, or 50% if the consolidated indebtedness of Holdings and its subsidiaries over the consolidated adjusted EBITDA of Holdings and its subsidiaries is 3.0:1.0 or less for the most recent four fiscal quarters, to repay amounts outstanding under the second priority facility, in an amount not to exceed $67,500,000. We are required to apply the balance of such net proceeds to repay amounts outstanding under the first priority facility as described above.
Optional Prepayment
The term facility and revolving facility may be prepaid in whole or in part without premium or penalty. In the event that there are no amounts outstanding under the term facility and revolving facility, amounts outstanding under the second priority facility may be prepaid in whole or in part subject to the call premium described below.
Call Premium
Subject to certain exceptions, any repayments or prepayments of the second priority facility prior to December 2007 are subject to the payment of a premium ranging from 2.50% to 11.00% of the amount repaid or prepaid.
Events of Default
The credit facilities contain customary events of default, including, payment defaults, defaults under other indebtedness, breach of covenant, breach of representations or warranties, certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or dissolution, judgment defaults, change of control, invalidity of any loan documents or provisions supporting the credit facilities, and defaults or events relating to the employee benefit plans of Holdings or any of its subsidiaries. Certain of the events of default are subject to exceptions and materiality qualifiers. If an event of default occurs under the credit facilities and is not cured within the proscribed grace period, the lenders under the credit facilities will be
96
The terms used in this summary have specific meanings as used in the credit facilities. This summary of the credit facilities may not contain all of the information that is important to you and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by reference to, all of the provisions of the credit agreements and related documents, copies of which are filed as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part. See Where You Can Find More Information.
97
UNDERWRITING
ARC, the selling stockholders and the
underwriters named below have entered into an underwriting
agreement with respect to the shares of common stock being
offered. Subject to certain conditions, each underwriter has
severally agreed to purchase the number of shares of common
stock indicated in the following table. Goldman,
Sachs & Co., J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., Credit
Suisse First Boston LLC, Robert W. Baird & Co.
Incorporated and CIBC World Markets Corp. are the
representatives of the underwriters.
Number of
Underwriters
Shares
The underwriters are committed to take and pay for all of the shares being offered, if any are taken, other than the shares covered by the option described below, unless and until this option is exercised.
If the underwriters sell more shares than the total number set forth in the table above, the underwriters have an option to buy up to an additional shares of common stock from the selling stockholders to cover such sales. They may exercise that option for 30 days. If any shares are purchased pursuant to this option, the underwriters will severally purchase shares in approximately the same proportion as set forth in the table above.
The following tables show the per share and total
underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid to the
underwriters by ARC and the selling stockholders. Such amounts
are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the
underwriters option to
purchase additional
shares.
Paid by the Selling Stockholders
No Exercise
Full Exercise
$
$
$
$
No Exercise
Full Exercise
$
$
$
$
Shares sold by the underwriters to the public will initially be offered at the initial public offering price set forth on the cover of this prospectus. Any shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $ per share from the initial public offering price. Any such securities dealers may resell any shares purchased from the underwriters to certain other brokers or dealers at a discount of up to $ per share from the initial public offering price. If all the shares are not sold at the initial public offering price, the representatives may change the offering price and the other selling terms.
ARC, its officers and directors, the selling stockholders and other stockholders who collectively hold substantially all of ARCs common stock have agreed with the underwriters not to dispose of or
98
Prior to the offering, there has been no public market for the common stock. The initial public offering price has been negotiated among ARC, the selling stockholders and the representatives. Among the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price of the common stock, in addition to prevailing market conditions, will be ARCs historical performance, estimates of its business potential and earnings prospects, an assessment of its management and the consideration of the above factors in relation to market valuation of companies in related businesses.
An application has been made to list the common stock on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol ARP. In order to meet one of the requirements for listing the common stock on the NYSE, the underwriters have undertaken to sell lots of 100 or more shares to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial holders.
In connection with the offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell shares of common stock in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, stabilizing transactions and purchases to cover positions created by short sales. Short sales involve the sale by the underwriters of a greater number of shares than they are required to purchase in the offering. Covered short sales are sales made in an amount not greater than the underwriters option to purchase additional shares from the selling stockholders in the offering. The underwriters may close out any covered short position by either exercising their option to purchase additional shares or purchasing shares in the open market. In determining the source of shares to close out the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase additional shares pursuant to the option granted to them. Naked short sales are any sales in excess of such option. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the common stock in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in the offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of various bids for or purchases of common stock made by the underwriters in the open market prior to the completion of the offering.
The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased shares sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.
Purchases to cover a short position and stabilizing transactions may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the common stock, and together with the imposition of the penalty bid, may stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the market price of the common stock. As a result, the price of the common stock may be higher than the price that otherwise might exist in the open market. If these activities are commenced, they may be discontinued at any time. These transactions may be effected on the New York Stock Exchange, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.
Each underwriter has represented, warranted and agreed that: (i) it has not offered or sold and, prior to the expiry of a period of six months from the date of the closing of this offering, will not offer or sell any shares to persons in the United Kingdom except to persons whose ordinary activities involve them in acquiring, holding, managing or disposing of investments (as principal or agent) for the purposes of their businesses or otherwise in circumstances which have not resulted and will not result in an offer to the public in the United Kingdom within the meaning of the Public Offers of Securities Regulations 1995; (ii) it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated any invitation or inducement to engage in
99
The shares may not be offered or sold, transferred or delivered, as part of their initial distribution or at any time thereafter, directly or indirectly, to any individual or legal entity in the Netherlands other than to individuals or legal entities who or which trade or invest in securities in the conduct of their profession or trade, which includes banks, securities intermediaries, insurance companies, pension funds, other institutional investors and commercial enterprises which, as an ancillary activity, regularly trade or invest in securities.
The shares may not be offered or sold by means of any document other than to persons whose ordinary business is to buy or sell shares or debentures, whether as principal or agent, or in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32) of Hong Kong, and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares may be issued, whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere, which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the securities laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares of common stock which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to professional investors within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571) of Hong Kong and any rules made thereunder.
The prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation or subscription or purchase, of the shares of common stock may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares of common stock be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than under circumstances in which such offer, sale or invitation does not constitute an offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares of common stock to the public in Singapore.
The shares of common stock have not been and will not be registered under the Securities and Exchange Law of Japan (the Securities and Exchange Law) and each underwriter has agreed that it will not offer or sell any shares, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the benefit of, any resident of Japan (which means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan), or to others for re-offering or resale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to a resident of Japan, except pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements of, and otherwise in compliance with, the Securities and Exchange Law and any other applicable laws, regulations and ministerial guidelines of Japan.
At ARCs request, the underwriters have reserved for sale, at the initial public offering price, up to shares offered by this prospectus for sale to some of ARCs directors, officers and employees and related persons. If these persons purchase reserved shares, this will reduce the number of shares available for sale to the general public. Any reserved shares that are not orally confirmed for purchase within one day of the pricing of this offering will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same terms as the other shares offered by this prospectus.
A prospectus in electronic format may be made available on the website maintained by one or more of the lead managers of this offering and may also be made available on websites maintained by other underwriters. The underwriters may agree to allocate a number of shares to underwriters for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Internet distributions will be allocated by the lead managers to underwriters that may make Internet distributions on the same basis as other allocations.
100
The underwriters do not expect sales to discretionary accounts to exceed five percent of the total number of shares offered.
ARC estimates that its share of the total expenses of the offering, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions, will be approximately $ million.
ARC and the selling stockholders have agreed to indemnify the several underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.
Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, various financial advisory and investment and commercial banking services for ARC, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses. An affiliate of Goldman, Sachs & Co. is a lender under ARCs credit facilities, having a commitment to lend up to $5.0 million under the revolving facility which currently has no balance. In addition, in connection with the purchase of certain debt of Holdings which has since been repaid, affiliates of Goldman, Sachs & Co. were issued warrants to purchase common units of Holdings. Upon the reorganization, such affiliates will hold warrants to purchase approximately 1,168,842 shares of ARCs common stock. For more detailed information regarding these warrants, please see Description of Capital Stock Warrants. In connection with a project to construct a new Goldman, Sachs & Co. headquarters in New York City, following a competitive bidding process, the developer, with Goldman, Sachs & Co.s concurrence, has selected ARC to provide reprographics services for the project.
VALIDITY OF COMMON STOCK
The validity of the shares of common stock being offered will be passed upon for American Reprographics Company by Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus, Vlahos & Rudy, LLP, San Francisco, California, and for the underwriters by Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, Los Angeles, California.
EXPERTS
The consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedule as of December 31, 2003 and for the year then ended, included in this prospectus have been so included in reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, given on the authority of said firm as experts in auditing and accounting.
The consolidated financial statements of American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. at December 31, 2002 and for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2002, appearing in this prospectus and registration statement have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
101
WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act with respect to the shares of common stock we are offering. This prospectus contains all information about us and our common stock that may be material to an investor in this offering. The registration statement includes exhibits to which you should refer for additional information about us.
You may inspect a copy of the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules to the registration statement without charge at the offices of the SEC at Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549. You may obtain copies of all or any part of the registration statement from the Public Reference Section of the SEC, 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549 upon the payment of the prescribed fees. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains a website at www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding registrants like us that file electronically with the SEC. You can also inspect our registration statement on this website.
102
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS
F-1
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC
ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Advisors and Members
In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated
balance sheet and the related consolidated statements of
operations, members deficit and comprehensive income,
and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the
financial position of American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.
and its subsidiaries (the Company) at
December 31, 2003, and the results of their operations and
their cash flows for the year then ended in conformity with
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statement
schedule for the year ended December 31, 2003 listed in the
index at Item 16(b) presents fairly, in all material
respects, the information set forth therein when read in
conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements.
These financial statements and the financial statement schedule
are the responsibility of the Companys management; our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements and the financial statement schedule based on our
audit. We conducted our audit of these statements in accordance
with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight
Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and
perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether
the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An
audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements,
assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit
provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated
financial statements, the Company changed its method of
accounting for its redeemable preferred members equity
upon the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standard
No. 150 effective July 1, 2003.
/s/ PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS LLP
Los Angeles, California
F-2
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC
ACCOUNTING FIRM
The Board of Advisors and Members
We have audited the accompanying consolidated
balance sheet of American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. as of
December 31, 2002, and the related consolidated statements
of operations, members equity (deficit), and cash flows
for the years ended December 31, 2001 and 2002. Our audit
also included the financial statement schedule listed to the
index at Item 16(b) for the years ended December 31,
2001 and 2002. These financial statements and schedule are the
responsibility of the Companys management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements and schedule based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the
standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board
(United States). Those standards require that we plan and
perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether
the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An
audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An
audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating
the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that
our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the financial statements referred
to above present fairly, in all material respects, the
consolidated financial position of American Reprographics
Holdings, L.L.C. at December 31, 2002, and the consolidated
results of its operations and its cash flows for the years ended
December 31, 2001 and 2002, in conformity with U.S.
generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion,
the related financial statement schedule, when considered in
relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole,
presents fairly in all material respects the information set
forth therein.
As discussed in Note 1 to the consolidated
financial statements, the Company changed its method of
accounting for derivative financial instruments in 2001 upon the
adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standard
No. 133. The Company also changed its method of accounting
for goodwill and other intangible assets in 2002 upon the
adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standard
No. 142.
Woodland Hills, California
F-3
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS,
L.L.C.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
The accompanying notes are an integral part of
these consolidated financial statements.
F-4
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS,
L.L.C.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF
OPERATIONS
The accompanying notes are an integral part of
these consolidated financial statements.
F-5
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS,
L.L.C.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF MEMBERS
DEFICIT AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
The accompanying notes are an integral part of
these consolidated financial statements.
F-6
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS,
L.L.C.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH
FLOWS
F-7
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH
FLOWS (Continued)
F-8
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS,
L.L.C.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS
1. Description of
Business and Summary of Significant Accounting
Policies
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. (the
Company), formerly known as Ford Graphics Holdings, LLC, is a
California limited liability company organized on
October 24, 1997, and has a finite life through
December 31, 2047. The Company, through its operating
subsidiary, American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., is a leading
provider of digital reprographics services and supplies to
companies operating primarily in the architecture, engineering,
and construction industries throughout the United States.
Corporate Conversion
Transaction
Prior to the consummation of the proposed initial
public offering as discussed in Note 12, the Company will
convert from a California limited liability company (American
Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.) to a Delaware corporation
(American Reprographics Company). The unaudited pro forma data
presented in the consolidated statements of operations gives
effect to the Companys reorganization as a corporation as
if it occurred on January 1, 2001.
As a limited liability company, all income taxes
were paid by the Companys members. As a corporation, the
Company will be responsible for the payment of all federal and
state corporate income taxes. The unaudited pro forma net income
attributable to common members represents the Companys net
income for the period as adjusted to give effect to the
incremental provision for income taxes. See Note 5.
Principles of Consolidation
The consolidated financial statements include the
accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries, all of which are
wholly owned. Intercompany accounts and transactions have been
eliminated in consolidation.
Unaudited Interim Financial
Information
The accompanying unaudited consolidated financial
statements for the interim periods ended September 30, 2003
and 2004 have been prepared in accordance with the rules and
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and,
therefore, do not include all information and notes necessary
for a fair presentation of financial position, results of
operations, and cash flows in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles. The unaudited consolidated financial
statements include the accounts of American Reprographics
Holdings, L.L.C. and its subsidiaries. In the opinion of
management, the unaudited interim period consolidated financial
statements include all adjustments, which consist of normal
recurring adjustments, necessary for a fair presentation of the
financial position, result of operations and cash flows. The
unaudited interim period consolidated financial statements are
not necessarily an indication of the results to be expected for
the full fiscal year. All financial information as of
September 30, 2004 and for the nine months ended
September 30, 2003 and 2004 presented herein are unaudited.
F-9
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Cash Equivalents
Cash equivalents include demand deposits and
short-term investments with a maturity of three months or less
when purchased.
The Company maintains its cash deposits at
numerous banks located throughout the United States, which at
times, may exceed federally insured limits. The Company has not
experienced any losses in such accounts and believes it is not
exposed to any significant risk on cash and cash equivalents.
Concentrations of Credit Risk and
Significant Vendors
Concentrations of credit risk with respect to
trade receivables are limited due to a large, diverse customer
base. No individual customer represented more than 2% of net
sales for any of the three years in the period ended
December 31, 2003 or for the nine months ended
September 30, 2003 and 2004.
The Company performs periodic credit evaluations
of the financial condition of its customers, monitors
collections and payments from customers, and generally does not
require collateral. Receivables are generally due within
30 days. The Company provides for the possible inability to
collect accounts receivable by recording an allowance for
doubtful accounts. The Company writes off an account when it is
considered to be uncollectible. The Company estimates its
allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical experience,
aging of accounts receivable, and information regarding the
creditworthiness of its customers. To date, losses have been
within the range of managements expectations.
The Company contracts with various suppliers.
Although there are a limited number of suppliers that could
supply the Companys inventory, management believes any
shortfalls from existing suppliers would be absorbed from other
suppliers on comparable terms. However, a change in suppliers
could cause a delay in sales and adversely effect results.
Purchases from the Companys three largest
vendors during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002, and
2003, and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004
comprised approximately 49%, 54%, 51%, 46% and 52%,
respectively, of the Companys total purchases of inventory
and supplies.
Inventories
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost
(principally determined on a first-in, first-out basis) or
market. Inventories primarily consist of reprographics materials
for use and resale and equipment for resale. On an ongoing
basis, inventories are reviewed and written down for estimated
obsolescence or unmarketable inventories equal to the difference
between the cost of inventories and the estimated net realizable
value. Charges to increase inventory reserves are recorded as an
increase in cost of goods sold. Estimated inventory obsolescence
has been provided for in the financial statements and has been
within the range of managements expectations. As of
December 31, 2002 and 2003, and September 30, 2004,
the reserves for inventory obsolescence amounted to $273, $278,
and $320, respectively.
F-10
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Property and Equipment
Property and equipment are stated at cost and are
depreciated using the straight-line method over their estimated
useful lives, as follows:
Assets acquired under capital lease arrangements
are recorded at the present value of the minimum lease payments
and are amortized using the straight-line method over the life
of the asset or term of the lease, whichever is shorter. Such
amortization expense is included in depreciation expense.
Leasehold improvements are amortized using the straight-line
method over the shorter of the lease terms or the useful lives
of the improvements. Expenses for repairs and maintenance are
charged to expense as incurred, while renewals and betterments
are capitalized. Gains or losses on the sale or disposal of
property and equipment are reflected in operating income.
The Company accounts for computer software costs
developed for internal use in accordance with Statement of
Position 98-1 (SOP 98-1), Accounting for the
Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal
Use, which requires companies to capitalize certain
qualifying costs incurred during the application development
stage of the related software development project. The primary
use of this software is for internal use and, accordingly, such
capitalized software development costs are amortized on a
straight-line basis over the economic lives of the related
products not to exceed three years. The Companys machinery
and equipment (see Note 3) include $4,535, $4,574 and
$4,228 of capitalized software development costs as of
December 31, 2002 and 2003, and September 30, 2004,
respectively, net of accumulated amortization of $755, $2,519
and $4,085 as of December 31, 2002 and 2003, and
September 30, 2004, respectively. Depreciation expense
includes the amortization of capitalized software development
costs which amounted to $378, $377, $1,763, $1,323 and $1,566
during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003,
and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004,
respectively.
In August 2002, the Company decided to license
internally developed software for use by third party
reprographics companies. In accordance with SOP 98-1, the
Company applies the net revenues from certain of its software
licensing activity to reduce the carrying amount of the
capitalized software costs. Software licensing revenues which
have been offset against the carrying amount of capitalized
software costs amounted to $0, $0, $98, $51, and $134 during the
years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, and the nine
months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively.
Impairment of Long-Lived
Assets
The Company periodically assesses potential
impairments of its long-lived assets in accordance with the
provisions of SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the
Impairment or Disposal of Long-lived Assets. An impairment
review is performed whenever events or changes in circumstances
indicate that the carrying value of the assets may not be
recoverable. Factors considered by the Company include, but are
not limited to, significant underperformance relative to
expected historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of use of the acquired assets
or the strategy for the overall business; and significant
negative industry or economic trends. When the carrying value of
a long-lived asset may not be recoverable based upon the
existence of one or
F-11
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
more of the above indicators of impairment, the
Company estimates the future undiscounted cash flows expected to
result from the use of the asset and its eventual disposition.
If the sum of the expected future undiscounted cash flows and
eventual disposition is less than the carrying amount of the
asset, the Company recognizes an impairment loss. An impairment
loss is reflected as the amount by which the carrying amount of
the asset exceeds the fair value of the asset, based on the fair
market value if available, or discounted cash flows, if not. To
date, the Company has not recognized an impairment charge
related to the write-down of long-lived assets.
Goodwill and Intangible
Assets
Effective January 1, 2002, the Company
adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standard
(SFAS) No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible
Assets, which requires, among other things, the use of a
nonamortization approach for purchased goodwill and certain
intangibles. Under a nonamortization approach, goodwill and
intangibles having an indefinite life are not amortized, but
instead will be reviewed for impairment at least annually or if
an event occurs or circumstances indicate that the carrying
amount may be impaired. Events or circumstances which could
indicate an impairment include a significant change in the
business climate, economic and industry trends, legal factors,
negative operating performance indicators, significant
competition, changes in strategy or disposition of a reporting
unit or a portion thereof. Goodwill impairment testing is
performed at the reporting unit level.
SFAS 142 requires that goodwill be tested
for impairment using a two-step process. The first step of the
goodwill impairment test, used to identify potential impairment,
compares the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying
amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting
unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit
is not considered to be impaired and the second step of the
impairment test is unnecessary. If the carrying amount of a
reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the
goodwill impairment test must be performed to measure the amount
of impairment loss, if any. The second step of the goodwill
impairment test compares the implied fair value of reporting
unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. The
implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner
as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination.
If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds
the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is
recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
Application of the goodwill impairment test
requires judgment, including the identification of reporting
units, assignment of assets and liabilities to reporting units,
assignment of goodwill to reporting units, and determination of
the fair value of each reporting unit. The fair value of each
reporting unit is estimated using a discounted cash flow
methodology. This requires significant judgments including
estimation of future cash flows, which is dependent on internal
forecasts, estimation of the long-term rate of growth for our
business, the useful life over which cash flows will occur, and
determination of our weighted average cost of capital. Changes
in these estimates and assumptions could materially affect the
determination of fair value and/or goodwill impairment for each
reporting unit.
In accordance with SFAS 142, the Company
completed the first step of the transitional goodwill impairment
test during May 2002 and the annual impairment test in September
2002 and determined based on such tests that no impairment of
goodwill was indicated. The Company has selected
September 30 as the date on which it will perform its
annual goodwill impairment test. Based on the
F-12
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Companys valuation of goodwill, no
impairment charges related to the write-down of goodwill were
recognized for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003.
During the year ended December 31, 2001, the Company
wrote-off $3,438 of goodwill recorded from an acquisition
completed during 2000 because the business was closed in 2001
due to underperformance.
Had the Company adopted SFAS No. 142 on
January 1, 2001, and, as such, goodwill was not amortized
effective on that date, the Companys unaudited pro forma
net income attributable to common members for 2001 would have
been higher by $5,274 or $0.14 per common member unit.
Prior to January 1, 2002, goodwill related
to businesses purchased was amortized on a straight-line basis
over 40 years.
In connection with its acquisitions subsequent to
July 1, 2001, the Company has applied the provisions of
SFAS No. 141 Business Combinations, using the
purchase method of accounting. The assets and liabilities
assumed were recorded at their estimated fair values as
determined by the Companys management based on information
currently available and current assumptions as to future
operations. The excess purchase price over those fair values was
recorded as goodwill. For its acquisitions during 2001 through
September 30, 2004, the Companys management
attributed the entire excess purchase price to goodwill.
Management determined based on its experience with acquisitions
of reprographics companies, as well as its knowledge of dynamics
within the reprographics industry, there were no other
recognizable intangible assets acquired apart from goodwill.
The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill
from December 31, 2002 through September 30, 2004 are
summarized as follows:
The additions to goodwill include the excess
purchase price over fair value of net assets acquired,
adjustments to acquisition costs and certain earnout payments.
See Note 2.
Separable intangible assets that have finite
useful lives are amortized over their useful lives. An impaired
asset is written down to fair value. Intangible assets with
finite useful lives consist primarily of not-to-compete
covenants and are amortized over the expected period of benefit
which ranges from two to four years using the straight-line
method. Such intangible assets amount to $2,125, $2,125 and
$2,125 less accumulated amortization of $1,829, and $1,960 and
$2,029 at December 31, 2002 and 2003 and September 30,
2004, respectively, and are included in other assets in the
accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
Deferred Financing Costs
Direct costs incurred in connection with
indebtedness agreements are capitalized as incurred and
amortized on a straight line basis over the term of the related
indebtedness, which approximates the effective interest method.
At December 31, 2002 and 2003, and September 30, 2004
the Company has deferred financing costs of $6,688, $8,288, and
$7,183, respectively, net of
F-13
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
accumulated amortization of $3,493, $47, and
$1,508, respectively. As discussed further in Note 4, the
Company wrote-off $6,318 of deferred financing costs in 2003 as
a result of the refinancing of the Companys credit
facilities in December 2003. Approximately $1,189 of deferred
financing costs written-off were incurred during 2003.
Derivative Financial
Instruments
In 2001, the Company adopted
SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative
Instruments and Hedging Activities
(SFAS No. 133), and its related amendments. As a
result of the adoption of SFAS No. 133, the Company
recognizes all derivative financial instruments, such as its
interest rate swap contracts, as either assets or liabilities in
the consolidated financial statements at fair value.
The accounting for changes in the fair value
(i.e., unrealized gains or losses) of a derivative instrument
depends on whether it has been designated and qualifies as part
of a hedging relationship and further, on the type of hedging
relationship. Derivatives that are not hedges must be adjusted
to fair value through current earnings.
The Company enters into interest rate swaps to
manage its exposure to changes in interest rates. Interest rate
swaps also allow the Company to raise funds at floating rates
and effectively swap them into fixed rates. These agreements
involve the exchange of floating-rate for fixed-rate payments
without the exchange of the underlying principal amount.
During 2000, the Company entered into two
interest rate swap agreements with an aggregate notional amount
of $117,500 which changed the nature of the interest rate paid
on a portion of its long-term debt. Under the agreements, the
Company paid fixed rates of 6.44% and 6.73% and received a
variable rate at the lower of the Eurodollar rate or 7% on the
notional amount. The differential between the fixed and variable
rates was settled monthly and was recognized as an increase or
decrease in interest expense related to the debt. These
agreements were designed to hedge the variable portion of the
interest rates on the credit facilities up to the notional
amount to the extent the Eurodollar rate remained at 7% or
lower. However, these agreements did not qualify as hedges under
SFAS No. 133 and, therefore, the change in fair value
of these interest rate swap agreements has been recorded as
interest expense.
The adoption of SFAS No. 133 in 2001
resulted in an adjustment for the cumulative effect of an
accounting change of $3,060 which was recognized as a charge to
other comprehensive income (loss) in the Companys
consolidated statements of members (deficit) and
comprehensive income (loss) for the year ended December 31,
2001. This charge was amortized as interest expense related to
the interest rate swap contract in the accompanying consolidated
statements of operations over the term of the swap which expired
in September 2003 using the effective-interest method.
During 2001, the Company recorded additional
interest expense of $5,590 based on the negative change in
market value of the interest rate swap agreements, including
$1,113 of amortization of the original transition adjustment.
During 2002 and 2003, the Company recorded an interest benefit
of $1,636 and $3,954, respectively, based on the improvement in
the market value of the interest rate swap agreements as
compared to the prior year, net of $1,113 and $834,
respectively, of amortization of the original transition
adjustment. The agreements expired in September 2003.
In September 2003, the Company entered into a new
interest rate swap agreement with an initial notional amount of
$111,160. Under the terms of this swap agreement, the Company
pays a
F-14
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
fixed rate of 2.29% and receives a variable rate
on the notional amount equal to the Eurodollar rate. The swap
agreement provides for a quarterly reduction of $1,863 in the
notional amount of the swap starting in October 2003 until July
2005, when the notional amount of the swap will be reduced to
$95,988 until its expiration in September 2005. Because this
swap agreement has been designated and qualifies as a cash flow
hedge under SFAS No. 133, the Company has recorded the
fair value of this swap agreement in the Companys
consolidated balance sheet in Other long term
liabilities with a corresponding adjustment to other
comprehensive income (loss) as of and for the year ended
December 31, 2003 and for the nine months ended
September 30, 2004, respectively. This swap agreement had a
negative fair value of $822 and a positive fair value of $62 as
of December 31, 2003 and September 30, 2004,
respectively. The counterparty to this interest rate swap is a
financial institution with a high credit rating. Management does
not believe that there is a significant risk of nonperformance
by the counterparty. For the year ended December 31, 2003
and the nine months ended September 30, 2004, the Company
determined that its interest rate swap qualified as an effective
hedge as defined by SFAS 133.
In January 2004, the Company entered into two
interest rate collar agreements, referred to as the front-end
and the back-end interest rate collar agreements. The front-end
interest rate collar agreement has an initial notional amount of
$22,566 which is increased quarterly to reflect reductions in
the notional amount of our interest rate swap agreement, such
that the notional amount of the swap agreement, together with
the notional amount of the front-end interest rate collar
agreement, remains not less than 40% of the aggregate principal
amount outstanding on our 2003 Senior Credit Facility. The
front-end interest rate collar agreement expires in September
2005. The back-end interest rate collar agreement becomes
effective upon expiration of the swap agreement and front-end
interest rate collar agreement in September 2005 and has a fixed
notional amount of $111,000. The back-end interest rate collar
agreement expires in December 2006. At September 30, 2004,
the fair value of these interest rate collar agreements was
$(405).
Adoption of Statement of Financial
Accounting Standard No. 150
Effective July 1, 2003, the Company adopted
SFAS No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial
Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and
Equity. This statement establishes standards for
classifying and measuring as liabilities certain financial
instruments that embody obligations of the issuer and have
characteristics of both liabilities and equity. The scope of
this pronouncement includes mandatorily redeemable equity
instruments.
Upon the adoption of SFAS No. 150, the
Companys mandatorily redeemable preferred membership units
(the Preferred Units) of $25,791 and $27,285 as of
December 31, 2003 and September 30, 2004,
respectively, have been classified as long-term liabilities in
the Companys consolidated balance sheet as they are
redeemable at a fixed and determinable date (upon or after the
earlier of the occurrence of a qualified IPO or April 10,
2010). Dividends and accretion related to the Preferred Units,
which previously had been recorded below net income as a charge
in determining net income available to common members have been
charged to interest expense in the accompanying consolidated
statement of operations since adoption of this standard on
July 1, 2003 and amounted to $1,825 and $2,872 during the
year ended December 31, 2003 and the nine months ended
September 30, 2004. In accordance with
SFAS No. 150, dividends and accretion related to the
mandatorily redeemable preferred membership units recorded prior
to July 1, 2003 have not been reclassified to interest
expense. Prior to the adoption of SFAS 150, dividends paid
on the Preferred Units were accounted for as a direct reduction
to members equity, and the Preferred
F-15
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Units were presented between liabilities and
members deficit in the Companys consolidated balance
sheet.
Fair Values of Financial
Instruments
The following methods and assumptions were used
by the Company in estimating the fair value of its financial
instruments for disclosure purposes:
The Company applies the provisions of the
Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) Staff Accounting
Bulletin (SAB) No. 104, Revenue Recognition in
Financial Statements, which provides guidance on the
recognition, presentation and disclosure of revenue in financial
statements filed with the SEC. SAB No. 104 outlines the
basic criteria that must be met to recognize revenue and
provides guidance for disclosure related to revenue recognition
policies. In general, the Company recognizes revenue when
(i) persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists,
(ii) shipment of products has occurred or services have
been rendered, (iii) the sales price charged is fixed or
determinable and (iv) collection is reasonably assured.
The Company recognizes revenues from
reprographics services when services have been rendered while
revenues from the resale of reprographics supplies and equipment
are recognized upon shipment.
In addition, the Company has established
contractual pricing for certain large national customer accounts
(Premier Accounts). These contracts generally establish uniform
pricing at all branches for Premier Accounts. Revenues earned
from the Companys Premier Accounts are recognized in the
same manner as non-premier account revenues and the Company has
no additional performance obligations.
F-16
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Included in revenues are fees charged to
customers for shipping, handling and delivery services. Such
revenues amounted to $18,836, $20,500, $23,060, $17,755 and
$19,251 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and
2003, and for the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and
2004, respectively.
Revenues from software licensing activities are
recognized over the term of the license. Revenues from
membership fees are recognized over the term of the membership
agreement. Revenues from software licensing activities and
membership revenues comprise less than 1% of the Companys
consolidated revenues during the years ended December 31,
2001, 2002 and 2003, and the nine months ended
September 30, 2003 and 2004.
Management provides for returns, discounts and
allowances based on historic experience and adjusts such
allowances as considered necessary. To date, such provisions
have been within the range of managements expectations.
SFAS No. 130, Reporting
Comprehensive Income, establishes guidelines for the
reporting and display of comprehensive income and its components
in financial statements. Comprehensive income generally
represents all changes in members equity (deficit), except
those resulting from investments by or distributions to members.
The Companys comprehensive income includes the change in
fair value of derivative instruments and is included in the
consolidated statement of members deficit and
comprehensive income.
The provisions of SFAS No. 131,
Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related
Information, require public companies to report financial
and descriptive information about their reportable operating
segments. The Company identifies reportable segments based on
how management internally evaluates separate financial
information, business activities and management responsibility.
On that basis and based on operating segments that have similar
economic characteristics, products and services and class of
customers which have been aggregated, the Company operates in a
single reportable business segment.
The Company recognizes revenues in geographic
areas based on the location to which the product was shipped or
services have been rendered. Operations outside the United
States of America have been immaterial to date.
The following summary presents the Companys
revenues for each of the Companys significant products and
service lines:
F-17
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and
approximated $2,232, $2,036, $1,807, $1,437 and $1,730 during
the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, and the
nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004,
respectively. Shipping and handling costs incurred by the
Company are included in cost of sales.
The Company accounts for grants of options to
purchase its common membership units to key personnel in
accordance with SFAS No. 123, Accounting for
Stock-Based Compensation. In December 2002, the Financial
Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued
SFAS No. 148, Accounting for Stock-Based
Compensation Transition and Disclosure,
effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2002.
SFAS No. 148 amends SFAS No. 123 to provide
alternative methods of transition to the fair value method of
accounting for stock-based employee compensation.
SFAS No. 148 also amends the disclosure provisions of
SFAS No. 123 to require disclosure in the summary of
significant accounting policies of the effects of an
entitys accounting policy with respect to stock-based
employee compensation on reported net income and earnings per
share in annual and interim financial statements.
SFAS No. 148 does not amend SFAS No. 123 to
require companies to account for their employee stock-based
awards using the fair value method. The disclosure provisions
are required, however, for all companies with stock-based
employee compensation, regardless of whether they utilize the
fair value method of accounting described in
SFAS No. 123 or the intrinsic value method described
in Accounting Principles Board (APB) Opinion
No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to
Employees.
The Company has adopted the disclosure
requirements of SFAS No. 148 effective January 1,
2003. The adoption of this standard did not have a significant
impact on the Companys financial condition or operating
results.
The Company accounts for grants of options to
employees to purchase its common membership units using the
intrinsic value method in accordance with APB Opinion
No. 25 and FIN No. 44, Accounting for
Certain Transactions Involving Stock Compensation. As
permitted by SFAS No. 123 and as amended by
SFAS No. 148, the Company has chosen to continue to
account for such option grants under APB Opinion No. 25 and
provide the expanded disclosures specified in
SFAS No. 123, as amended by SFAS No. 148.
Had compensation cost for the Companys
option grants been determined based on their fair value at the
grant date for awards consistent with the provisions of
SFAS No. 123, the Companys unaudited pro forma
net income attributable to common members and earnings per
common member unit for the years ended December 31, 2001,
2002, and 2003 and the nine months ended
F-18
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
September 30, 2003 and 2004 would have been
decreased to the adjusted pro forma amounts indicated below:
F-19
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
For purposes of computing the pro forma
disclosures required by SFAS No. 123, the fair value
of each option granted to employees and directors is estimated
using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following
weighted-average assumptions for the years ended
December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003 and for the nine months
ended September 30, 2003 and 2004: dividend yields of 0%
for all periods; expected volatility of 0%, 0%, 36%, 32.4% and
28.3%, respectively; risk-free interest rates of 3.5%, 3.5%,
2.6%, 2.4%, and 2.9%, respectively; and expected lives of
5 years, 4 years, 2 years, 2 years and
2.5 years, respectively. Prior to the one year period
preceding the anticipated initial public offering, the Company
used the minimum value method to determine fair value of option
grants.
The Black-Scholes option valuation model was
developed for use in estimating the fair value of traded
options, which do not have vesting restrictions and are fully
transferable. In addition, option valuation models require the
input of highly subjective assumptions, including the expected
stock price volatility. Because the Companys employee
stock options have characteristics significantly different from
those of traded options, and because changes in the subjective
input assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimate,
in managements opinion, the existing models do not
necessarily provide a reliable single measure of the fair value
of its employee stock options.
Research and development activities relate to the
development of software primarily for internal use. Costs
incurred for research and development are comprised of
a) amounts capitalized in accordance with SOP 98-1 as
discussed in Property and Equipment in Note 1,
and b) amounts which are expensed as incurred. During the
twelve months ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, and
the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, the
Company expensed costs incurred for research and development
activities of $464, $569, $874, $616, and $527, respectively.
The preparation of financial statements in
conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America requires management to make estimates
and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities
at the date of the financial statements, and the reported
amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.
Actual results could differ from those estimates.
The Company accounts for earnings per common
member unit in accordance with SFAS No. 128,
Earnings per Share. Basic earnings per common member
unit is computed by dividing unaudited pro forma net income
attributable to common members by the weighted-average number of
common member units outstanding. Diluted earnings per common
member unit is computed similar to basic earnings per unit
except that the denominator is increased to include the number
of additional common member units that would have been
outstanding if the potential common member units had been issued
and if the additional common member units were dilutive. Common
member unit equivalents are excluded from the computation if
their effect is anti-dilutive. There are no common member unit
equivalents excluded for antidilutive effects for the periods
presented below. The Companys common member unit
equivalents consist of member unit options issued under the
Companys Equity Option Plan as well as warrants to
purchase common member
F-20
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
units issued during 2000 to certain creditors of
the Company as discussed further in the long-term debt
section (Note 4).
Basic and diluted earnings per common unit were
calculated using the following units for the years ended
December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 and the nine months ended
September 30, 2003 and 2004:
In April 2002, the FASB issued
SFAS No. 145, Rescission of FASB Statements
No. 4, 44, and 64, Amendment of FASB Statement No. 13,
and Technical Corrections. SFAS No. 145 updates,
clarifies, and simplifies existing accounting pronouncements.
This statement rescinds SFAS No. 4, which required all
gains and losses from extinguishment of debt to be aggregated
and, if material, classified as an extraordinary item, net of
related income tax effect. As a result, the criteria in
Accounting Principles Board No. 30 will now be used to
classify those gains and losses. SFAS No. 64 amended
SFAS No. 4 and is no longer necessary as
SFAS No. 4 has been rescinded. SFAS No. 44
has been rescinded as it is no longer necessary.
SFAS No. 145 amends SFAS No. 13 to require
that certain lease modifications that have economic effects
similar to sale-leaseback transactions be accounted for in the
same manner as sale-lease transactions. This statement also
makes technical corrections to existing pronouncements. While
those corrections are not substantive in nature, in some
instances, they may change accounting practice. The
Companys adoption of SFAS No. 145 did not have a
material impact on the Companys financial position,
results of operations, or cash flows.
In June 2002, the FASB issued
SFAS No. 146, Accounting for Costs Associated
with Exit or Disposal Activities. SFAS No. 146
nullifies Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue
No. 94-3, Liability Recognition for Certain Employee
Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity,
under which a liability for an exit cost was recognized as of
the date of an entitys commitment to an exit plan.
SFAS No. 146 requires that a liability for a cost
associated with an exit or disposal activity be recognized at
fair value when the liability is incurred. The Companys
adoption of this standard effective January 1, 2003 had no
impact on its financial position, results of operations or cash
flows.
In November 2002, the FASB issued FASB
Interpretation No. 45 (FIN 45), Guarantors
Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including
Indirect Guarantees of Indebted-
F-21
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
ness of Others. This interpretation
elaborates on disclosures required in financial statements
concerning obligations under certain guarantees. It also
clarifies the requirements related to the recognition of
liabilities by a guarantor at the inception of certain
guarantees. The Companys adoption of FIN 45 did not
have a material impact on the Companys financial position,
results of operations or cash flows.
In December 2002, the FASB issued
SFAS No. 148, Accounting for Stock-Based
Compensation Transition and Disclosure, an
amendment of SFAS No. 123. SFAS No. 148
provides alternative methods of transition for a voluntary
change to the fair value based method of accounting for
stock-based employee compensation. In addition,
SFAS No. 148 amends the disclosure requirements of
SFAS No. 123 to require more prominent and more
frequent disclosures in financial statements about the effects
of stock-based compensation. This statement is effective for
financial statements for fiscal years ending after
December 15, 2002. The Companys adoption of
SFAS No. 148 did not have any impact on the
Companys financial statements as management does not have
any intention to change to the fair value method.
In April 2003, the FASB issued
SFAS No. 149, Amendment of Statement 133 on
Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities.
SFAS No. 149 amends and clarifies the financial
accounting and reporting of derivative instruments, including
certain derivative instruments embedded in other contracts
(collectively referred to as derivatives) and for hedging
activities under SFAS No. 133, Accounting for
Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities. This
Statement is effective for contracts entered into or modified
after June 30, 2003, except for certain hedging
relationships designated after June 30, 2003. The adoption
of SFAS No. 149 did not have a material effect on the
Companys financial position, results of operations or cash
flows.
In May 2003, the FASB issued SFAS
No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments
with Characteristics of Both Liabilities and Equity
(SFAS 150). SFAS 150 requires issuers to classify as
liabilities (or assets in some circumstances) three classes of
freestanding financial instruments that embody obligations for
the issuer. SFAS 150 is effective for financial instruments
entered into or modified after May 31, 2003, and is
otherwise effective at the beginning of the first interim period
beginning after June 15, 2003. The Company adopted
SFAS 150 on July 1, 2003, which resulted in
classifying mandatorily redeemable preferred membership units as
a liability in the balance sheet and related dividends and
accretion being charged to interest expense in the statement of
operations. See Note 1, Adoption of Statement of Financial
Accounting Standard No. 150, to the consolidated financial
statements for more detail.
In January 2003, the FASB issued FASB
Interpretation No. 46 (FIN 46), Consolidation of
Variable Interest Entities, which addresses the consolidation of
business enterprises (variable interest entities) to which the
usual condition (ownership of a majority voting interest) of
consolidation does not apply. The interpretation focuses on
financial interests that indicate control. It concludes that in
the absence of clear control through voting interests, a
companys exposure (variable interest) to the economic
risks and potential rewards from the variable interest
entitys assets and activities are the best evidence of
control. Variable interests are rights and obligations that
convey economic gains or losses from changes in the values of
the variable interest entitys assets and liabilities.
Variable interests may arise from financial instruments, service
contracts, nonvoting ownership interests and other arrangements.
If an enterprise holds a majority of the variable interests of
an entity, it would be considered the primary beneficiary. The
primary beneficiary would be required to include the assets,
liabilities and the results of operations of the variable
interest entity in its financial statements. In
F-22
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
December 2003, the FASB issued a revision to
FIN 46 to address certain implementation issues. The
adoption of FIN 46 and FIN 46 (revised) had no
material impact on the Companys results of operations,
financial position or cash flows.
The Company acquired a group of reprographics
companies in September 2000 (the Acquired Business). In
connection with the acquisition of the Acquired Business, the
Company issued 1,161,290 common membership units of the
Company (the Purchase Consideration Units) to a former owner of
the Acquired Business valued at $6,000 based on
managements estimate of the fair value of such units at
the date of issuance. The Company granted the former owner of
the Acquired Business an option (the Put Option) to sell the
Purchase Consideration Units back to the Company for a price
equal to the Net Equity Value, as defined, of each Purchase
Consideration Unit, payable in cash. In August 2002, the former
owner exercised the Put Option. The Company paid $6,256 in cash
to the former owner in 2002 as consideration for the redemption
of the Purchase Consideration Units resulting in a reduction of
redeemable common members capital of $8,081 and an increase to
accumulated earnings of $1,825.
In 2001, the Company paid $1,428 of bonuses to
management of the Acquired Business specifically related to the
acquisition of the Acquired Business. The $1,428 has been
classified in the accompanying consolidated statements of
operations as costs incurred in connection with acquisition
activities in 2001.
During 2001, the Company acquired the capital
stock or assets and liabilities of fourteen reprographics
companies in the United States. The aggregate purchase price of
such acquisitions, including related acquisition costs, amounted
to approximately $32,577, for which the Company paid
approximately $22,506 in cash and issued $10,071 of notes
payable to the former owners of the acquired companies.
During 2002, the Company acquired the capital
stock or assets and liabilities of eight reprographics companies
in the United States. The aggregate purchase price of such
acquisitions, including related acquisition costs, amounted to
approximately $34,404, for which the Company paid approximately
$34,088 in cash and issued $316 of notes payable to the former
owners of the acquired companies. In connection with the
acquisition of a reprographics company in 2002, the Company paid
bonuses totaling $1,500 to a group of management employees of
the acquired company. Such bonuses have been classified in the
accompanying consolidated statements of operations as costs
incurred in connection with acquisition activities in 2002.
During 2003, the Company acquired the assets and
liabilities of four reprographics companies in the United
States. In addition, the Company also acquired certain assets of
a reprographics company in bankruptcy. The aggregate purchase
price of such acquisitions, including related acquisition costs,
amounted to approximately $870, which the Company paid in cash.
During the nine months ended September 30,
2004, the Company acquired the assets and liabilities of three
reprographics companies in the United States. The aggregate
purchase price of such acquisitions, including related
acquisition costs, amounted to approximately $1,418, for which
the Company paid $1,168 in cash and issued $250 of notes payable
to the former owners of the acquired companies.
F-23
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
The results of operations of the companies
acquired during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002,
and 2003, and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and
2004 have been included in the consolidated financial statements
from their respective dates of acquisition. Such acquisitions
were accounted for using the purchase method of accounting, and,
accordingly, the assets and liabilities of the acquired entities
have been recorded at their estimated fair values at the dates
of acquisition. The excess purchase price over the net assets
acquired has been allocated to goodwill. For income tax
purposes, $2,240, $23,934, $217 and $827 of goodwill resulting
from acquisitions completed during the years ended
December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003, and September 30,
2004, respectively, are amortized over a 15-year period.
The assets and liabilities of the entities
acquired during each period are as follows:
The following summary presents the Companys
unaudited proforma results, as if the acquisitions had been
completed at the beginning of each year presented:
The above proforma information is presented for
comparative purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of
what actually would have occurred had the acquisitions been
completed as
F-24
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
of the beginning of each period presented, nor
are they necessarily indicative of future consolidated results.
Certain acquisition agreements entered into by
the Company contain earnout agreements which provide for
additional consideration (Earnout Payments) to be paid if the
acquired entitys results of operations exceed certain
targeted levels measured on an annual basis generally from four
to five years after the acquisition. Targeted levels are
generally set above the historical experience of the acquired
entity at the time of acquisition. Earnout Payments are recorded
as additional purchase price and are to be paid annually in
cash. Accrued expenses in the accompanying consolidated balance
sheets include $2,142, $374 and $265 of Earnout Payments payable
as of December 31, 2002 and 2003 and September 30,
2004, respectively, to former owners of acquired companies based
on the earnings of acquired entities. The increase to goodwill
as of December 31, 2002 and 2003 and as of
September 30, 2004 as a result of the earnouts was $1,307,
$374, and $265, respectively.
The earnout provisions generally contain limits
on the amount of Earnout Payments that may be payable over the
term of the agreement. The Companys estimate of the
aggregate amount of additional consideration that may be payable
over the terms of the earnout agreements subsequent to
September 30, 2004 is approximately $822.
In accordance with FAS 141, the Company made
certain adjustments to goodwill as a result of changes to the
purchase price of acquired entities, during the one year period
subsequent to the acquisition. The increase to goodwill as of
December 31, 2002 and 2003 and as of September 30,
2004 as a result of purchase price adjustments was $126, $371
and $1,239, respectively.
Property and equipment consist of the following:
Machinery and equipment includes $29,687, $28,209
and $32,220 of equipment recorded under capital lease agreements
with related accumulated amortization of $14,081, $15,291 and
$17,900 at December 31, 2002 and 2003, and
September 30, 2004, respectively.
F-25
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Long-term debt consists of the following:
F-26
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
During 2000, the Company entered into a credit
agreement with a group of financial institutions which provided
the Company with a Senior Credit Facility consisting of a
$45,000 Senior Secured Revolving Facility, a $65,000 Senior
Secured Tranche A Term Loan Facility, and a $170,000
Senior Secured Tranche B Term Loan Facility. The
Company also received $54,412 and $38,088 in gross cash proceeds
from the issuance during 2000 of senior subordinated Opco Notes
(the Opco Notes) and senior subordinated Holdings Notes (the
Holdings Notes, and collectively with the Opco Notes, the
Notes), respectively. The Company capitalized $9,239 of loan
fees incurred in connection with the credit facilities
negotiated in 2000.
Concurrent with the issuance of the Notes, the
Company granted the holders of the Notes warrants to purchase up
to an aggregate of 1,168,842 common units of the Company. Such
warrants (the Warrants) are exercisable at any time subsequent
to the grant date at an exercise price of $4.61 per
warrant. The estimated aggregate fair value of the Warrants was
$1,039 using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model based on the
following assumptions: expected volatility of 15%, risk-free
interest rate of 6%, and an expected life of 10 years. The
fair value of the Warrants was recorded as a discount on the
related Notes and was being amortized as interest expense over
the term of the Notes. As a result of the debt refinancing
completed by the Company in December 2003 (as discussed further
below), the Company wrote off $616 of unamortized discount on
the Warrants in December 2003. None of the Warrants have been
exercised as of September 30, 2004.
In May 2002, the Company negotiated an amendment
to the credit agreement which provided a $20,000 Senior Secured
Tranche B-1 Term Loan Facility. The Company used the
net proceeds from the Tranche B-1 Term Loan Facility
to finance its acquisition of the assets of a reprographics
company in May 2002. During 2002, the Company capitalized $950
in loan fees incurred in connection with the amendment
negotiated in May 2002.
Interest on the Holdings Notes accreted monthly
based on an accretion schedule specified in the Holdings Notes
agreement and was added to the outstanding principal balance of
the Holdings Notes (the Accreted Value) until April 2005. The
effective interest rate on the Holdings Notes during its entire
nine-year term through April 2009 was approximately 19.6%. The
difference between the Accreted Value and the carrying amount of
the Holdings Notes represented a discount (the Accretion
Discount) which was being amortized over the nine-year term of
the Holdings Notes using the effective interest method. The
Holdings Notes were repaid in December 2003 in connection with
the Companys refinancing of its borrowings discussed below.
F-27
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
In December 2003, the Company refinanced its
borrowings under its then existing senior credit facilities, the
Notes and the Holdings Notes by entering into a new credit
agreement with a group of financial institutions which provides
the Company a $355,000 Senior Secured Credit Facility (the 2003
Senior Credit Facility). Such credit facility is comprised of a
$130,000 First Priority Facility (consisting of a $30,000 Senior
Revolving Credit Facility and a $100,000 Senior Term
Loan Credit Facility) and a $225,000 Second Priority
Facility. At December 31, 2003, $771 of the $30,000 Senior
Revolving Credit Facility has been utilized for the issuance of
letters of credit related to the Companys workers
compensation and automobile insurance policies. There were no
outstanding borrowings against such letters of credit as of
September 30, 2004.
As a result of the debt refinancing completed in
December 2003, the Company recorded a $14,921 loss on early debt
extinguishment, comprised of the following: a) the
write-off of $6,318 in capitalized loan fees related to the
Companys credit facilities existing prior to the debt
refinancing; b) $4,728 in early redemption premiums related
to the Notes paid by the Company upon completion of the debt
refinancing; and c) the write off of $3,875 in unamortized
discounts related to the Warrants and the Accretion Discount.
The Company also capitalized $8,335 of new loan fees incurred in
connection with the 2003 Senior Credit Facility, of which $176
was included in prepaid expenses as of December 31, 2002.
Borrowings under the First Priority Revolving
Credit Facility bear interest at either (i) a Eurodollar
rate plus a margin (the Applicable Margin) that ranges from 2%
to 2.75% per annum, depending on the Companys
Leverage Ratio, as defined, or (ii) an Index Rate, as
defined, plus the Applicable Margin less 1% per annum. The
First Priority Revolving Credit Facility is also subject to a
commitment fee equal to 0.50% of the average daily unused
portion of such revolving facility. Borrowings under the First
Priority Term Loan Facility bear interest at either
(i) a Eurodollar rate plus 3% per annum, or
(ii) an Index Rate, as defined, plus 2% per annum.
Borrowings under the Second Priority Facility
bear interest at either (i) a Eurodollar rate, subject to a
Eurodollar rate minimum of 1.75% per annum, plus a margin
of either 6.875% or 7.875% per annum, depending on the
Companys Leverage Ratio, as defined in the credit
agreement, or (ii) a Base Rate, as defined in the credit
agreement, plus a margin of either 5.875% or 6.875% per
annum, depending on the Companys Leverage Ratio, as
defined in the credit agreement.
The Companys overall weighted average
interest rate on its long term debt was approximately 8.9%, 8.4%
and 7.4% for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2003,
and nine months ended September 30, 2004.
Under the terms of the 2003 Senior Credit
Facility, the Company is subject to mandatory principal
prepayments equal to 75% of Consolidated Excess Cash Flow, as
defined, starting in the year ending December 31, 2004, or
up to 75% of the net proceeds of equity offerings. Mandatory
prepayments from such sources (the Permitted Payments) are
applied first to the Second Priority Facility in an aggregate
amount not to exceed $67,500, with any excess above $67,500
applied to the First Priority Facility. In July 2004, the
Company made a mandatory principal prepayment on its Second
Priority Credit Facility in the amount of $11,636 based on 75%
of its Consolidated Excess Cash Flow, as defined, during the six
months ended June 30, 2004. Mandatory principal prepayments
are also required equal to 100% of the net proceeds from asset
sales and insurance proceeds that each exceed $5 million in
aggregate, as well as 100% of net proceeds from new debt
offerings. Mandatory prepayments from such sources are applied
to the First Priority Facility until it is
F-28
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
fully paid, followed by the Second Priority
Facility. With the exception of Permitted Payments as discussed
above, prepayments on the Second Priority Facility carry a
penalty during the first three years of its term equal to a
percentage of the prepayment, as follows: Year 1
11%; Year 2 7.5%; and Year 3 2.5%.
Borrowings under the 2003 Senior Credit Facility
are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Company.
The 2003 Senior Credit Facility also contains restrictive
covenants which, among other things, provide limitations on
capital expenditures, and restrictions on indebtedness and
distributions to the Companys equity holders.
Additionally, the Company is required to meet debt covenants
based on certain financial ratio thresholds applicable to the
First and Second Priority Facilities, as follows with ratio
thresholds as of September 30, 2004: (i) First
Priority Facility Interest Coverage Ratio not lower
than 1.70, Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio not lower than 1.25,
Leverage Ratio not higher than 5.10, and First Priority Senior
Debt Leverage Ratio not higher than 1.75, each as defined; and
(ii) Second Priority Facility Leverage Ratio
not higher than 5.30, as defined. The Company is in compliance
with all such covenants as of September 30, 2004.
Minimum future maturities of long-term debt and
capital lease obligations as of December 31, 2003 are as
follows:
A substantial portion of the Companys
business is operated in a limited liability company (LLC), taxed
as a partnership. As a result, the members of the LLC pay the
income taxes on the earnings, not the LLC. Accordingly, no
income taxes have been provided on these earnings. The LLC had
book income of $6,620, $13,225, $1,692, $12,809 and $18,613
during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003,
and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004,
respectively, which are not subject to tax at the LLC level.
As discussed in Note 1, the Company will
convert from a California limited liability company to a
Delaware corporation immediately prior to the completion of the
proposed public offering. The unaudited pro forma incremental
income tax provision included in the statement of operations
reflects the additional income tax expense that would have been
reported if the Company had been a corporation effective
January 1, 2001.
F-29
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
The following table includes the consolidated
provision for income taxes related to that portion of the
Companys business not operated as an LLC and the unaudited
pro forma income tax provision reflecting the incremental income
tax expense that would have been reported if the LLC portion of
the business had been a corporation resulting in a pro forma
income tax provision, as follows:
The consolidated deferred tax assets and
liabilities consist of the following:
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are included
in prepaid expenses and other current assets and other long-term
liabilities, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated
balance sheets.
F-30
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
A reconciliation of the statutory federal income
tax rate to the Companys pro forma effective tax rate is
as follows:
Non-deductible other items include meals and
entertainment, certain acquisition costs and other items that,
individually, are not significant.
The Company leases machinery, equipment, and
office and operational facilities under noncancelable operating
lease agreements. Certain lease agreements for the
Companys facilities generally contain renewal options and
provide for annual increases in rent based on the local Consumer
Price Index. The following is a schedule of the Companys
future minimum lease payments as of December 31, 2003:
Total rent expense under operating leases,
including month-to-month rentals, amounted to $30,157, $32,143,
$36,161, $26,850 and $27,612 during the years ended
December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003, and the nine months
ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively. Under
certain lease agreements, the Company is responsible for other
costs such as property taxes, insurance, maintenance, and
utilities.
The Company is involved in a dispute with a state
tax authority related to an unresolved sales tax issue which
arose from such state tax authoritys audit findings from
their sales tax audit of certain operating divisions of the
Company for the period from October 1998 to September 2001. The
unresolved issue relates to the application of sales taxes on
certain discounts granted by the
F-31
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Company to its customers. Based on the position
taken by the state tax authority on this unresolved issue, they
have claimed that an additional $1,179 of sales taxes are due
from the Company for the period in question, plus $372 of
interest. The Company strongly disagrees with the state tax
authoritys position and has filed a petition for
redetermination requesting an appeals conference to resolve this
issue. A date for the appeals conference originally scheduled in
July 2004 has been postponed at the request of the state tax
authority to December 14, 2004. The Companys accrued
expenses in its consolidated balance sheet as of
December 31, 2003 and September 30, 2004 include $151
of reserves related to this unresolved matter based on certain
components of the state tax authoritys audit findings
which the Company is not disputing.
The Company has an agreement to pay its Chief
Executive Officer (CEO) and its Chief Operating
Officer (COO) each a fee equal to 1% of the
aggregate consideration paid by the Company in connection with
any acquisition. The Company recorded fees of $623, $653, $9, $3
and $28 during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003,
and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004,
respectively, for which the Company is obligated to pay its CEO
and COO in connection with this agreement. Such fees are
expensed as incurred and are included in selling, general and
administrative expenses.
The Company has entered into employment
agreements with certain of its management employees which
require annual gross salary payments which range from $40 to
$200 per annum. The employment agreements range from a period of
one to three years and include a provision for annual bonuses
based on specific performance criteria. In the event that such
key management employees are terminated without cause, the
Company is contractually obligated to pay the remaining balance
due on the employment contracts.
The following is a schedule of the Companys
future minimum annual payments under such employment agreements
as of December 31, 2003:
The Companys operating agreement provides
for the indemnification of its officers and members of its board
of advisors under certain circumstances for acts and omissions
which may not be covered by any directors and
officers liability insurance. The operating agreement
provides for the Company, among other things, to indemnify its
officers and board members against certain liabilities that may
arise by reason of their status or service as officers and board
members (other than liabilities arising from willful misconduct
of a culpable nature), to advance their expenses incurred as a
result of any proceeding against them as to which they could be
indemnified, and to obtain officers and directors
insurance if available on reasonable terms. There have been no
events to date which would require the Company to indemnify its
officers or members of its board of Advisors.
The Company is a creditor and participant in the
Chapter 7 Bankruptcy of Louis Frey Company, Inc., or LF
Co., which is pending in the United States Bankruptcy Court,
Southern District of New York. We managed LF Co. under a
contract from May through September of 2003. LF Co. filed for
Bankruptcy protection in August 2003, and the proceeding was
converted to a Chapter 7 liquidation
F-32
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
in October 2003. On or about June 30, 2004,
the Bankruptcy Estate Trustee filed a complaint in the LF Co.
Bankruptcy proceeding against the Company, which was amended on
or about July 19, 2004, alleging, among other things,
breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duties, conversion,
unjust enrichment, tortious interference with contract, unfair
competition and false commercial promotion in violation of The
Lanham Act, misappropriation of trade secrets and fraud
regarding the Companys handling of the assets of LF Co.
The Trustee claims damages of not less than $9.5 million,
as well as punitive damages and treble damages with respect to
the Lanham Act claims. Previously, on or about October 10,
2003, a secured creditor of LF Co., Merrill Lynch Business
Financial Services, Inc., or Merrill, had filed a complaint in
the LF Co. Bankruptcy proceeding against the Company, which
was most recently amended on or about July 6, 2004.
Merrills claims are duplicated in the Trustees suit.
The Company, in turn, has filed answers and counterclaims
denying liability to the Trustee and seeking reimbursement of
all costs and damages sustained as a result of the
Trustees actions and in the Companys efforts to
assist LF Co. Discovery has commenced and is ongoing in each of
these cases. The Company believes that it has meritorious
defenses as well as substantial counterclaims against Merrill
Lynch and the Trustee. The Company intends to vigorously contest
the above matters. Based on the discovery and depositions to
date, the Company does not believe that the outcome of the above
matters will have a material adverse impact on its results of
operations or financial condition.
The Company may be involved in litigation and
other legal matters from time to time in the normal course of
business. Management does not believe that the outcome of any of
these matters will have a material adverse effect on the
Companys consolidated financial position, results of
operations or cash flows.
The Company leases several of its facilities
under operating lease agreements with entities owned by certain
of its executive officers and other related parties which expire
through July 2019. Rental expense on these facilities amounted
to $2,683, $2,281, $2,209, $1,589 and $1,938 during the years
ended December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003, and the nine
months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively.
The Company has a management agreement with an
equity investor (the Management Agreement) which requires the
Company to pay annual management fees to the equity investor as
compensation for certain management services rendered to the
Company. In accordance with the Management Agreement, the
management fees charged to the Company are subject to an annual
increases based on the Companys earnings but shall not
exceed $1,000 annually. The Management Agreement expires in
April 2005 and is automatically renewable. However, the
Companys board of advisors has the ability to terminate
the Management Agreement under certain circumstances as defined
in the Management Agreement. In addition, the Management
Agreement will terminate upon completion of the Companys
initial public offering. Management fees paid by the Company to
the equity investor amounted to $803, $889, $858, $622 and $618
during the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003,
and the nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004,
respectively.
The Company sells certain products and services
to Thomas Reprographics, Inc. and Albinson Inc., each of which
is owned or controlled by William Thomas, who beneficially owns
more than 5% of the common equity in the Company. These
companies purchased products and services from the Company of
approximately $215 and $95 during the twelve months ended
December 31, 2002 and
F-33
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
2003, respectively, and $90 and $45 during the
nine months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively.
The Company sponsors a defined contribution plan
(the Plan) covering substantially all employees who are at least
21 years of age and have satisfied a service requirement
ranging from three to six months through December 31, 2001.
Effective January 2002, the Plan was amended to remove the
minimum service requirement. Plan participants may contribute up
to 19% of their annual eligible compensation, subject to
contribution limitations imposed by the Internal Revenue
Service. The Company matches up to 20% of participant
contributions to a maximum of 4% of their annual eligible
compensation. The Companys total expense under these plans
amounted to $501, $388, $544, $413 and $467 during the years
ended December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003, and the nine
months ended September 30, 2003 and 2004, respectively.
In January 2001, the Company established the
American Reprographics Holdings, LLC Unit Option Plan (the
Option Plan) which permits the grant of options (the Options) to
key personnel to purchase up to 1,735,415 common membership
units of the Company (the Option Units). Options granted under
the Option Plan are nontransferable and may be exercised at an
option price to be determined by the Companys board of
advisors provided that the option price is not less than 85% of
the fair market value of such unit of grant date.
In the event of a key personnels
termination of employment with the Company, Option Units
attributable to the exercise of an Option shall generally be
subject to redemption by the Company at a redemption price
generally equal to the fair market value per common membership
unit. In limited circumstances, the Option Units could be
repurchased at the Option exercise price. As of
September 30, 2004, a repurchase of any units under the
Option Plan was not expected. The option to repurchase the
Option Units shall terminate in the event of an initial public
offering.
The Company has granted Options to certain key
personnel in accordance with the terms of the Option Plan at
exercise prices equal to managements estimate of the fair
value of the common membership units at the date of issuance
(except for 2004 grants described below). A summary of the
activity related to the Companys Option Plan is as follows:
F-34
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Of the total options outstanding, 297,000,
485,000, 806,250 and 1,059,500 options were exercisable at
December 31, 2001, 2002, and 2003 and September 30,
2004, respectively, at exercise prices ranging from $4.75 to
$6.14 per option.
During the nine months ended September 30,
2004, the Company granted options to purchase common membership
units to employees with exercise prices ranging from $5.62 to
$6.14 per unit. The Company recorded a deferred compensation
charge of $3,074 in connection with the issuance as the exercise
price of the units was less than the estimated fair market value
of the Companys membership units as of the date of grant
after giving consideration to the anticipated fair value of the
membership units during the one-year period preceeding the
proposed initial public offering. The Company will amortize the
deferred compensation charge over the vesting period of the
options, generally five years. As of September 30, 2004,
the Company has amortized $332 of the deferred compensation
charge.
Each common membership unit is entitled to one
vote with respect to any action presented for a vote of the
Companys members. Except for units issued in accordance
with the Option Plan, common membership units may be transferred
without the consent of the board of advisors under certain
conditions specified in the Companys Amended and Restated
Operating Agreement. During the year ended December 31,
2002, the Company redeemed all outstanding redeemable common
membership units. See Note 2.
Holders of the Companys mandatorily
redeemable preferred units are entitled to receive a yield of
13.25% of its Liquidation Value per annum for the first three
years starting in April 2000, and increasing to 15% of the
Liquidation Value per annum thereafter. The discount inherent in
the yield for the first three years was recorded as an
adjustment to the carrying amount of the mandatorily redeemable
preferred units. This discount was amortized as a dividend over
the initial three years. Of the total yield on the mandatorily
redeemable preferred units, 48% is mandatorily payable quarterly
in cash to the mandatorily redeemable preferred unit holders.
The unpaid portion of the yield accumulates annually and is
added to the Liquidation Value of the mandatorily redeemable
preferred units. Such units have an aggregate liquidation
preference over common units of $20 million plus
accumulated and unpaid yield. Mandatorily redeemable preferred
units have no voting rights.
Mandatorily redeemable preferred units are
redeemable without premium or penalty, wholly or in part, at the
Companys option at any time, for the Liquidation Value,
including any unpaid yield. Redeemable preferred units are
mandatorily redeemable on the earlier to occur of (i) an
initial public offering of the Company (to the extent of 25% of
the net proceeds thereof), (ii) a sale of equity or assets
of the Company or any of its principal operating subsidiaries
after retirement in full of the Companys debt under its
senior credit facilities, or (iii) April 10, 2010. At
December 31, 2002 and 2003, and September 30, 2004,
the Company had 20,000 redeemable preferred membership units
issued and outstanding.
F-35
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Distributions to Members
In accordance with the Companys Amended and
Restated Operating Agreement, cash distributions will be made
first, to all preferred members based on their tax liability
imposed on the yield earned on their preferred units; second, to
all common members, based on their tax liability imposed on the
Companys earnings. The Amended and Restated Operating
Agreement also provides for certain members who receive less
than their proportionate share of cash distributions, at their
election or the election of the Companys management, to be
granted an additional cash distribution to bring their
proportionate share of cash distributions equal to the rest of
the Companys common members. Any remaining cash available
for distribution will be distributed, at the discretion of the
Companys board of advisors, first to all preferred members
to the extent of the Liquidation Value of their preferred units;
second, to all common members, except to those common members
where such distribution would cause or increase a deficit to
their capital accounts.
Quarterly financial data for the years ended
December 31, 2002 and 2003 and the three months ended
March 31, June 30, and September 30, 2004 are as
follows:
F-36
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
In November 2004, the Company made a mandatory
principal prepayment on its Second Priority Credit Facility in
the amount of $5,133 based on 75% of its Consolidated Excess
Cash Flow, as defined in its debt agreement, during the three
months ended September 30, 2004. In November 2004, the
Company also made a voluntary principal prepayment on its First
Priority Credit Facility in the amount of $4,200.
F-37
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Initial Public Offering and Pro Forma
Balance Sheet
The Company filed a registration statement with
the SEC in October 2004 to sell a certain amount of its common
equity in an initial public offering (the IPO). Prior to the
consummation of the planned IPO, the Company will convert from a
California limited liability company (American Reprographics
Holdings, L.L.C.) to a Delaware corporation (American
Reprographics Company or ARC). In this reorganization, the
Companys common members will exchange their common member
units for common stock of ARC. Each option and warrant issued to
purchase the Companys common member units will be
exchanged for an option and warrant exercisable for shares of
ARCs common stock with the same exercise prices and
vesting terms as the original grants. As required by the
Companys operating agreement, ARC will repurchase all of
the mandatorily redeemable preferred membership units of the
Company upon closing of the IPO with a portion of the net
proceeds of the offering.
In connection with the planned IPO, the Company
will adopt the 2005 Stock Plan (the Stock Plan) which will
provide for discretionary grants of incentive stock options to
employees, including officers and employee directors, and for
the discretionary grant of nonstatutory stock options,
restricted stock, restricted stock units, and stock appreciation
rights to employees, directors and consultants. The Stock Plan
will also provide for the periodic automatic grant of
nonstatutory stock options to non-employee directors. The Stock
Plan authorizes the Company to grant options to purchase up to
5,000,000 shares of common stock. The Company will also
adopt an Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP) to
provide an incentive to attract, retain and reward eligible
employees of the Company. The ESPP authorizes the Company to
grant options to purchase 750,000 shares of common stock.
In connection with the Companys operating
agreement, cash distributions are to be made to members of the
Company to pay taxes that the members will owe for their share
of the Companys profits as a limited liability company
through the date of the effective date of the IPO. The cash
distributions will be calculated at the highest combined federal
and state income tax rates applicable for tax withholding
purposes, currently 43%. Accordingly, the Company estimates that
it will make a cash distribution to all of its members in the
amount of approximately $596 upon the consummation of the IPO.
In addition, due to their tax attributes, certain members in the
past have elected to receive less than their proportionate share
of distributions for such taxes as a result of a difference in
the tax basis of their equity interest in the Company. In
accordance with the terms of the Companys operating
agreement, an additional distribution of approximately $10,500
will be made to such members in connection with the consummation
of the IPO to bring their proportionate share of tax
distributions equal to the rest of the Companys common
members. These distributions are not accrued at
September 30, 2004, but will become payable and recorded
immediately prior to the reorganization and consummation of the
IPO.
The pro forma balance sheet information at
September 30, 2004 included at page F-4 includes the
effects of the distributions discussed above and the deferred
income tax benefit of approximately $15.9 million resulting
from the conversion from a California limited liability company
to a Delaware corporation. The current portion of the deferred
income tax benefit of approximately $2.1 million is
included in prepaid expenses and other current assets.
F-38
No dealer,
salesperson or other person is authorized to give any
information or to represent anything not contained in this
prospectus. You must not rely on any unauthorized information or
representations. This prospectus is an offer to sell only the
shares offered hereby, but only under circumstances and in
jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. The information
contained in this prospectus is current only as of its date.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Through and
including ,
2005 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all
dealers effecting transactions in these securities, whether or
not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a
prospectus. This is in addition to a dealers obligation to
deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with
respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.
Shares
Goldman, Sachs & Co.
Representatives of the Underwriters
F-2
F-4
F-5
F-6
F-7
F-9
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.:
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.
/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP
December 31,
September 30, 2004
Pro Forma
2002
2003
Actual
(Note 12)
(Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)
$
24,995
$
17,315
$
12,008
$
12,008
60,080
56,663
65,675
65,675
7,223
5,937
5,861
5,861
6,448
5,661
6,662
8,726
98,746
85,576
90,206
92,270
46,079
37,268
36,132
36,132
242,134
243,668
245,999
245,999
6,688
8,288
7,183
7,183
2,030
2,043
1,689
1,689
13,828
$
395,677
$
376,843
$
381,209
$
397,101
$
19,426
$
18,742
$
19,981
$
19,981
10,102
9,906
9,392
9,392
13,508
14,622
21,550
21,550
11,098
2,142
374
265
265
4,788
24,409
25,123
10,685
10,685
74,375
68,767
61,873
72,971
354,199
334,217
320,415
320,415
25,791
27,285
27,285
2,984
5,397
5,497
5,497
431,558
434,172
415,070
426,168
23,903
26,117
26,228
29,302
29,302
(2,742
)
(2,742
)
(139,734
)
(142,343
)
(147,072
)
(134,553
)
54,667
59,608
86,994
79,269
(834
)
(822
)
(343
)
(343
)
(59,784
)
(57,329
)
(33,861
)
(29,067
)
$
395,677
$
376,843
$
381,209
$
397,101
Nine Months Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Dollars in thousands, except per unit amounts)
(Unaudited)
$
338,124
$
324,402
$
315,995
$
242,507
$
253,367
39,875
52,290
59,311
42,719
53,736
42,702
42,232
40,654
31,112
29,195
420,701
418,924
415,960
316,338
336,298
243,710
247,778
252,028
190,266
196,668
176,991
171,146
163,932
126,072
139,630
102,576
101,805
101,252
76,127
81,167
5,731
218
131
99
69
1,428
1,500
3,438
63,818
67,623
62,549
49,846
58,394
304
541
1,024
1,080
574
(47,530
)
(39,917
)
(39,390
)
(28,958
)
(24,506
)
(14,921
)
16,592
28,247
9,262
21,968
34,462
5,802
6,304
4,321
4,417
7,076
10,790
21,943
4,941
17,551
27,386
(3,107
)
(3,291
)
(1,730
)
(1,730
)
$
7,683
$
18,652
$
3,211
$
15,821
$
27,386
$
0.21
$
0.51
$
0.09
$
0.45
$
0.77
$
0.21
$
0.51
$
0.09
$
0.42
$
0.73
$
7,683
$
18,652
$
3,211
$
15,821
$
27,386
2,622
6,275
1,407
5,568
8,375
$
5,061
$
12,377
$
1,804
$
10,253
$
19,011
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.29
$
0.54
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.27
$
0.51
36,628,801
36,406,220
35,480,289
35,477,881
35,487,511
36,757,814
36,723,031
37,298,349
37,307,083
37,488,816
Retained Earnings
(Accumulated Deficit)
Accumulated
Common
Common
Accumulated
Other
Membership
Members
Deferred
Distributions to
Accumulated
Comprehensive
Units
Capital
Compensation
Members
Earnings
Income (Loss)
Total
(Dollars in thousands)
35,467,511
$
26,117
$
$
(128,530
)
$
21,934
$
$
(80,479
)
10,790
10,790
(3,060
)
(3,060
)
1,113
1,113
8,843
(3,411
)
(3,411
)
(1,447
)
(1,447
)
(325
)
(325
)
(2,081
)
(2,081
)
35,467,511
26,117
(135,794
)
32,724
(1,947
)
(78,900
)
21,943
21,943
1,113
1,113
23,056
(3,897
)
(3,897
)
(1,543
)
(1,543
)
(325
)
(325
)
1,825
1,825
35,467,511
26,117
(139,734
)
54,667
(834
)
(59,784
)
4,941
4,941
834
834
(822
)
(822
)
4,953
20,000
111
111
(1,670
)
(1,670
)
(858
)
(858
)
(81
)
(81
)
35,487,511
26,228
(142,343
)
59,608
(822
)
(57,329
)
3,074
(3,074
)
332
332
27,386
27,386
479
479
27,865
(4,729
)
(4,729
)
35,487,511
$
29,302
$
(2,742
)
$
(147,072
)
$
86,994
$
(343
)
$
(33,861
)
Nine Months
Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)
$
10,790
$
21,943
$
4,941
$
17,551
$
27,386
949
475
1,494
682
816
1,698
1,144
1,110
68
135
248
223
68
16,203
17,680
18,228
13,950
12,739
5,731
218
131
99
69
1,239
1,350
1,559
1,154
1,855
15,217
9,740
8,565
6,187
2,182
491
1,812
2,248
825
3,438
3,875
5,129
332
5,332
(1,395
)
1,802
(191
)
(10,287
)
1,388
718
1,034
733
29
1,402
2,058
410
421
(572
)
(10,521
)
2,659
(2,144
)
2,915
7,531
53,151
56,413
48,237
46,909
42,579
(8,659
)
(5,209
)
(4,992
)
(3,348
)
(4,772
)
(27,822
)
(40,355
)
(3,116
)
(2,635
)
(2,893
)
(584
)
(354
)
(228
)
(30
)
54
(37,065
)
(45,918
)
(8,336
)
(6,013
)
(7,611
)
Nine Months
Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)
$
5,220
$
32,000
$
337,750
$
$
1,000
(20,350
)
(35,507
)
(375,613
)
(28,695
)
(36,191
)
(950
)
(8,159
)
(736
)
(355
)
111
111
(3,411
)
(10,153
)
(1,670
)
(1,827
)
(4,729
)
(18,541
)
(14,610
)
(47,581
)
(31,147
)
(40,275
)
(2,455
)
(4,115
)
(7,680
)
9,749
(5,307
)
31,565
29,110
24,995
24,995
17,315
$
29,110
$
24,995
$
17,315
$
34,744
$
12,008
$
32,469
$
29,891
$
28,190
$
18,593
$
19,375
$
4,471
$
4,233
$
1,966
$
1,921
$
4,427
$
1,447
$
1,543
$
858
$
858
$
$
325
$
325
$
81
$
81
$
$
2,081
$
(1,825
)
$
$
$
$
8,975
$
5,685
$
4,443
$
3,772
$
6,274
$
10,071
$
316
$
$
$
250
$
$
$
(822
)
$
$
479
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
10 - 20 years
3 - 7 years
3 - 7 years
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
$
242,134
1,534
243,668
2,331
$
245,999
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Cash and cash
equivalents:
The carrying amounts
reported in the balance sheets for cash and cash equivalents
approximate their fair value due to the relatively short period
to maturity of these instruments.
Short- and long-term debt (excluding the
Holdings and Opco Notes):
The
carrying amounts of the Companys borrowings reported in
the consolidated balance sheets approximate their fair value
based on the Companys current incremental borrowing rates
for similar types of borrowing arrangements or since the
floating rates change with market conditions.
Holdings and Opco
Notes:
The carrying amount of the
Companys fixed interest rate borrowings under the Holdings
and Opco Notes reported in the consolidated balance sheet at
December 31, 2002 may not approximate their fair value
because of changes in market interest rates. It was not
practicable to estimate the fair value of the Holdings and Opco
Notes because the terms of such notes payable were unique to the
Company and its capitalization structure and there was no public
market for such notes payable. As discussed further in
Note 4, the Company redeemed the Holdings and Opco Notes
before their maturity in connection with the refinancing of the
Companys credit facilities in December 2003.
Interest rate swap
agreements:
The fair values of the
interest rate swap agreements, as previously disclosed, are the
amounts at which they could be settled based on estimated market
rates.
Revenue Recognition
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Comprehensive Income
Segment and Geographic
Reporting
Nine Months Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
338,124
$
324,169
$
315,227
$
241,958
$
252,234
39,874
52,290
59,311
42,719
53,736
42,703
42,231
40,654
31,112
29,195
234
768
549
1,133
$
420,701
$
418,924
$
415,960
$
316,338
$
336,298
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Advertising and Shipping and Handling
Costs
Accounting for Equity-Based
Compensation
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Nine Months
Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
5,061
$
12,377
$
1,804
$
10,253
$
19,011
332
(146
)
(112
)
(86
)
(90
)
(342
)
$
4,915
$
12,265
$
1,718
$
10,163
$
19,001
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.29
$
0.54
(0.01
)
$
0.13
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.29
$
0.54
$
0.14
$
0.34
$
0.05
$
0.27
$
0.51
(0.01
)
(0.01
)
$
0.13
$
0.33
$
0.05
$
0.27
$
0.51
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Research and development
expenses
Use of Estimates
Earnings Per Common Member
Unit
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
Nine Months Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
36,628,801
36,406,220
35,480,289
35,477,881
35,487,511
25,065
120,597
985,991
997,133
1,169,236
103,948
196,214
832,069
832,069
832,069
36,757,814
36,723,031
37,298,349
37,307,083
37,488,816
Recent Accounting
Pronouncements
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
1.
Description of Business and Summary of
Significant Accounting
Policies (Continued)
2.
Acquisitions
2.
Acquisitions (Continued)
December 31,
September 30,
2002
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
34,404
$
870
$
1,418
77
12
6
4,835
83
35
4,360
32
558
624
34
21
411
34
10,307
161
654
1,234
75
13
109
5
18
32
8,964
81
591
$
25,440
$
789
$
827
Nine Months Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
$
482,780
$
441,871
$
423,360
$
322,890
$
336,992
$
9,485
$
13,510
$
1,929
$
10,346
$
19,048
$
0.26
$
0.37
$
0.05
$
0.29
$
0.54
$
0.26
$
0.37
$
0.05
$
0.28
$
0.51
2.
Acquisitions (Continued)
3.
Property and Equipment
December 31,
September 30,
2002
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
79,095
$
76,030
$
80,876
14,379
15,143
16,239
2,268
3,086
2,948
95,742
94,259
100,063
(49,663
)
(56,991
)
(63,931
)
$
46,079
$
37,268
$
36,132
4.
Long-Term Debt
December 31,
September 30,
2002
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
$
15,000
$
100,000
99,250
225,000
213,364
47,668
165,925
19,900
54,412
68,252
10,623
7,510
5,027
16,549
14,064
15,314
383,329
361,574
332,955
4.
Long-Term Debt
(Continued)
December 31,
September 30,
2002
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
(721
)
(4,000
)
(2,234
)
(1,855
)
378,608
359,340
331,100
(24,409
)
(25,123
)
(10,685
)
$
354,199
$
334,217
$
320,415
4.
Long-Term Debt
(Continued)
4.
Long-Term Debt
(Continued)
Long-Term
Capital Lease
Debt
Obligations
$
18,957
$
6,889
3,722
4,567
1,696
2,367
635
1,467
47,875
721
272,391
128
$
345,276
16,139
2,075
$
14,064
5.
Income Taxes
5.
Income Taxes (Continued)
Nine Months
Ended
Year Ended December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
(Unaudited)
$
2,096
$
4,394
$
1,562
$
1,360
$
4,930
1,524
1,419
947
809
1,321
3,620
5,813
2,509
2,169
6,251
1,964
442
1,130
1,920
409
218
49
682
328
416
2,182
491
1,812
2,248
825
5,802
6,304
4,321
4,417
7,076
2,622
6,275
1,407
5,568
8,375
$
8,424
$
12,579
$
5,728
$
9,985
$
15,451
December 31,
2002
2003
$
1,387
$
1,179
52
28
1,439
1,207
(993
)
(1,700
)
(1,546
)
(2,494
)
(75
)
(2,614
)
(4,194
)
$
(1,175
)
$
(2,987
)
5.
Income Taxes (Continued)
Nine Months
Year Ended
Ended
December 31,
September 30,
2001
2002
2003
2003
2004
34
%
34
%
34
%
34
%
34
%
9
7
12
6
5
7
8
2
3
1
4
8
3
3
51
%
45
%
62
%
45
%
45
%
6.
Commitments and Contingencies
Third
Related
Party
Party
Total
$
28,329
$
2,612
$
30,941
20,499
2,470
22,969
10,769
2,260
13,029
6,075
2,239
8,314
3,217
2,252
5,469
7,849
9,111
16,960
$
76,738
$
20,944
$
97,682
6.
Commitments and Contingencies
(Continued)
$
990
438
68
$
1,496
6.
Commitments and Contingencies
(Continued)
7.
Related Party Transactions
7.
Related Party Transactions
(Continued)
8.
Retirement Plans
9.
Equity Option Plan
Year Ended December 31,
2001
2002
2003
Weighted
Weighted
Weighted
Average
Average
Average
Number
Exercise
Number
Exercise
Number
Exercise
of Units
Price
of Units
Price
of Units
Price
$
667,500
$
4.87
1,421,500
$
5.07
667,500
4.87
761,500
5.25
39,500
5.55
(7,500
)
(4.87
)
(15,000
)
(4.87
)
667,500
$
4.87
1,421,500
$
5.07
1,446,000
$
5.09
9.
Equity Option
Plan (Continued)
10.
Members Equity and Redeemable Membership
Units
Common and Redeemable Common Membership
Units
Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Membership
Units
10.
Members Equity and Redeemable Membership
Units (Continued)
11.
Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)
Quarter Ended
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
December 31,
2002
2002
2002
2002
$
100,772
$
110,078
$
107,549
$
100,525
$
42,352
$
46,813
$
43,739
$
38,242
$
7,469
$
6,864
$
5,489
$
2,121
$
6,680
$
6,034
$
4,653
$
1,285
$
4,628
$
3,874
$
3,053
$
822
$
0.13
$
0.11
$
0.08
$
0.02
$
0.13
$
0.11
$
0.08
$
0.02
11.
Quarterly Financial Data
(Unaudited) Continued
Quarter Ended
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
December 31,
2003
2003
2003
2003
$
105,272
$
108,882
$
102,184
$
99,622
$
42,292
$
44,551
$
39,229
$
37,860
$
5,469
$
9,237
$
2,845
$
(12,610
)
$
4,633
$
8,343
$
2,845
$
(12,610
)
$
3,606
$
5,065
$
1,582
$
(8,449
)
$
0.10
$
0.14
$
0.05
$
(0.24
)
$
0.10
$
0.14
$
0.04
$
(0.23
)
Quarter Ended
March 31,
June 30,
September 30,
2004
2004
2004
$
110,518
$
115,615
$
110,165
$
45,919
$
49,424
44,287
$
8,729
$
10,441
8,216
$
8,729
$
10,441
8,216
$
6,165
$
7,068
5,778
$
0.17
$
0.20
$
0.16
$
0.16
$
0.19
$
0.15
12.
Subsequent Events (Unaudited)
Debt Repayment
Page
1
11
21
22
22
23
23
23
24
25
27
29
31
55
74
84
86
89
93
95
98
101
101
102
F-1
PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN
PROSPECTUS
The following table sets forth the costs and
expenses, other than underwriting discounts and commissions,
payable by the registrant in connection with the sale of common
stock being registered. All amounts are estimates except the SEC
registration fee and the New York Stock Exchange listing fee.
Section 102 of the Delaware General
Corporation Law, as amended, allows a corporation to eliminate
the personal liability of a director of a corporation to the
corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach
of fiduciary duty as a director, except where the director
breached his or her duty of loyalty to the corporation or its
stockholders, failed to act in good faith, engaged in
intentional misconduct or knowingly violated a law, authorized
the payment of a dividend or approved a stock purchase or
redemption in violation of Delaware corporate law or obtained an
improper personal benefit.
Section 145 of the Delaware General
Corporation Law provides, among other things, that a corporation
may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened
to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed
action, suit or proceeding (other than an action by or in the
right of the corporation) by reason of the fact that the person
is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the
corporation, or is or was serving at the corporations
request as a director, officer, employee or agent of another
corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other
enterprise, against expenses, including attorneys fees,
judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and
reasonably incurred by the person in connection with the action,
suit or proceeding. The power to indemnify applies (i) if
such person is successful on the merits or otherwise in defense
of any action, suit or proceeding or (ii) if such person
acted in good faith and in a manner he reasonably believed to be
in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and
with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no
reasonable cause to believe his conduct was unlawful. The power
to indemnify applies to actions brought by or in the right of
the corporation as well, but only to the extent of defense
expenses (including attorneys fees but excluding amounts
paid in settlement) actually and reasonably incurred by the
indemnified person and not to any satisfaction of judgment or
settlement of the claim itself, and with the further limitation
that in such actions no indemnification shall be made in the
event such person is adjudged liable to the corporation unless a
court believes that in light of all the circumstances
indemnification should apply.
II-1
Section 174 of the Delaware General
Corporation Law provides, among other things, that a director
who willfully and negligently approves an unlawful payment of
dividends or an unlawful stock purchase or redemption may be
held liable for such actions. A director who was either absent
when the unlawful actions were approved or dissented at the time
may avoid liability by causing his or her dissent to such
actions to be entered in the books containing the minutes of the
meetings of the board of directors at the time the action
occurred or immediately after the absent director receives
notice of the unlawful acts.
Article VI of the registrants Amended and
Restated Certificate of Incorporation will provide that the
liability of the directors for monetary damages shall be
eliminated to the fullest extent under applicable law.
The registrants Bylaws provide that it may
indemnify any person who is or was a director, officer or
employee of the registrant to the fullest extent permitted by
Delaware law. The indemnification provisions contained in the
registrants Bylaws are not exclusive of any other rights
to which a person may be entitled by law, agreement or vote of
stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise.
The registrant has entered, and will enter, into
indemnification agreements with each officer and director which
provide indemnification under certain circumstances for acts and
omissions which may not be covered by any directors and
officers liability insurance. The indemnification
agreements may require the registrant, among other things, to
indemnify its officers and directors against certain liabilities
that may arise by reason of their status or service as officers
and directors (other than liabilities arising from willful
misconduct of a culpable nature), to advance their expenses
incurred as a result of any proceeding against them as to which
they could be indemnified, and to obtain officers and
directors insurance if available on reasonable terms.
The form of Underwriting Agreement, filed as
Exhibit 1.1 to the Registration Statement, provides for
indemnification of the registrant and its controlling persons
against certain liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended (the Securities Act).
Since December 1, 2001, the
registrants predecessor, American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C. (Holdings), has sold and issued the following
unregistered securities:
The issuances of the above securities were deemed
to be exempt from registration under the Securities Act in
reliance on:
The recipients of securities in each such
transaction represented their intentions to acquire the
securities for investment only and not with a view to or for
sale in connection with any distribution thereof. All recipients
had adequate access, through their relationships with the
registrant, to information about the registrant.
II-2
(a) Exhibits
II-3
II-4
(b) Financial Statement Schedules
Schedule II Valuation and
Qualifying Accounts for the years ended December 31, 2001,
2002 and 2003, and for the six months ended September 30,
2004 appears on page II-7. All other schedules have been
omitted because the information required to be set forth therein
is not applicable or is shown on the financial statements or
notes thereto.
The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to
provide to the underwriters, at the closing specified in the
underwriting agreement, certificates in such denominations and
registered in such names as required by the underwriters to
permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities
arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to directors,
officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to
the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been
advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange
Commission, such indemnification is against public policy as
expressed in the Securities Act, and is, therefore,
unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification
against such liabilities (other than the payment by the
registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer,
or controlling person of the registrant in the successful
defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the
securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the
opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:
II-5
Item 13.
Other Expenses of Issuance and
Distribution
Amount
to be Paid
$
29,141
*
175,000
950,000
970,000
35,000
20,000
230,859
$
2,410,000
*
To be filed by amendment.
Item 14.
Indemnification of Directors and
Officers
Item 15.
Recent Sales of Unregistered
Securities
Holdings issued 20,000 common units to a
consultant for cash consideration of $110,712 on May 22,
2003; and
Holdings has issued options to certain employees
to purchase an aggregate of 1,735,415 common units under
Holdings unit option plan, 22,500 of which have been
exercised at a purchase price of $5.25 per unit.
Rule 701 promulgated under the Securities
Act; or
Section 4(2) of the Securities Act as
transactions by an issuer not involving any public offering.
Item 16.
Exhibits and Financial Statement
Schedules
Number
Description
1
.1
Form of Underwriting Agreement.
3
.1
Certificate of Incorporation of American
Reprographics Company.**
3
.2
Bylaws of American Reprographics Company.**
3
.3
Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of
Incorporation to be effective upon closing.
3
.4
Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws to be
effective upon closing.
4
.1
Specimen Stock Certificate.
5
.1
Opinion of Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus, Vlahos &
Rudy, LLP regarding the legality of the common stock being
registered.
10
.1
Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of
December 18, 2003, among American Reprographics Company,
L.L.C., American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., certain
subsidiaries of American Reprographics Company, as guarantors,
and the lenders named therein.**
10
.2
Second Lien Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated
as of December 18, 2003, among American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C., American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.,
certain subsidiaries of American Reprographics Company, as
guarantors, and the lenders named therein.**
10
.3
Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
December 18, 2003, between American Reprographics Company,
L.L.C. and General Electric Capital Corporation and Goldman
Sachs Credit Partners L.P., as collateral agents.**
10
.4
2004 Bonus Plan, dated March 24, 2004,
between American Reprographics Company and Mr. Legg.**
10
.5
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit
Option Plan II, adopted effective as of January 1,
2001.**
10
.6
Amendment No. 1 dated as of July 1,
2003 to American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit Option
Plan II.**
10
.7
Form of American Reprographics Company 2005 Stock
Plan.*
10
.8
Forms of Stock Option Agreements under the 2005
Stock Plan.**
10
.9
American Reprographics Company 2005 Employee
Stock Purchase Plan.**
10
.10
Lease Agreement, dated November 19, 1997,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. (formerly Ford
Graphics Group, L.L.C.) and Sumo Holdings LA, LLC.**
10
.11
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings San Jose, LLC.**
10
.12
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings Irvine, LLC.**
10
.13
Lease Agreement, dated December 1, 1997,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings
Sacramento, LLC (Oakland Property).**
10
.14
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. (formerly Ford Graphics Group, L.L.C.) and Sumo
Holdings Sacramento, LLC (Sacramento Property).**
10
.15
Lease Agreement, dated December 7, 1995,
between Leet-Melbrook, Inc. and Sumo Holdings Maryland, LLC (as
successor lessor).**
10
.16
Lease Agreement, dated September 23, 2003,
between American Reprographics Company (dba Consolidated
Reprographics) and Sumo Holdings Costa Mesa, LLC.**
Number
Description
10
.17
Management Agreement, dated April 10, 2000,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. and CHS
Management IV, L.P.**
10
.18
Termination Agreement to Management Agreement,
dated November 29, 2004, between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and CHS Management IV, L.P.*
10
.19
Indemnification Agreement, dated April 10,
2000, among American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., American
Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C.,
Mr. Chandramohan, Mr. Suriyakumar, Micro Device, Inc.,
Dietrich-Post Company, ZS Ford L.P., and ZS Ford L.L.C.**
10
.20
Investor Registration Rights Agreement, dated
April 10, 2000, among American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., Mr. Chandramohan,
Mr. Suriyakumar, GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P.
and GS Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.21
First Amendment to Investor Registration Rights
Agreement, among American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC
Acquisition Co., L.L.C., Mr. Chandramohan,
Mr. Suriyakumar, GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P., GS
Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P., Stone Street Fund
2000, L.P. and Bridge Street Special Opportunities Fund, 2000,
L.P.
10
.22
Warrant Agreement, dated April 10, 2000,
between American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. and each of
GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P. and GS Mezzanine
Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.23
First Amendment to Warrant Agreement, dated
September 8, 2000, between American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C. and each of GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P. and
GS Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.24
Investor Unitholders Agreement, dated
April 10, 2000, among American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., GS Mezzanine
Partners II, L.P. and GS Mezzanine Partners II
Offshore, L.P.**
10
.25
Termination Agreement of Investor Unitholders
Agreement, dated November 29, 2004, among American
Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C.,
GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P., GS Mezzanine
Partners II Offshore, L.P., Stone Street Fund 2000, L.P.
and Bridge Street Special Opportunities Fund, 2000, L.P.*
10
.26
Form of Indemnification Agreement between
American Reprographics Company and each of its Officers and
Directors.**
10
.27
Forms of Restricted Stock Award Agreements under
2005 Stock Plan.*
10
.28
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement
under 2005 Stock Plan.*
16
.1
Letter from Ernst & Young LLP Regarding
Change in Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm dated
October 15, 2004.**
21
.1
List of Subsidiaries.**
23
.1
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP,
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.*
23
.2
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP,
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.*
23
.3
Consent of Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus, Vlahos &
Rudy, LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
24
.1
Power of Attorney.**
*
Filed herewith.
**
Previously filed.
To be filed by amendment.
Item 17.
Undertakings
(1) For purposes of determining any
liability under the Securities Act, the information omitted from
the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration
statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a
form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to
Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities
Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as
of the time it was declared effective.
(2) For the purpose of determining any
liability under the Securities Act, each post-effective
amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to
be a new registration statement relating to the securities
offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that
time shall be deemed to be the initial
bona fide
offering
thereof.
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities
Act of 1933, the registrant has duly caused Amendment No. 1
to this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Glendale,
State of California on December 3, 2004.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities
Act of 1933, Amendment No. 1 to this registration statement
has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and
on the dates indicated:
II-6
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY
By:
/s/ SATHIYAMURTHY CHANDRAMOHAN
Sathiyamurthy Chandramohan
Chief Executive Officer
Signature
Title
Date
/s/ SATHIYAMURTHY CHANDRAMOHAN
Sathiyamurthy Chandramohan
Chief Executive Officer; Chairman of the Board of
Directors (Principal Executive Officer)
December 3, 2004
*
Kumarakulasingam Suriyakumar
President;
Chief Operating Officer; Director
December 3, 2004
*
Mark W. Legg
Chief Financial Officer; Secretary (Principal
Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)
December 3, 2004
*
Andrew W. Code
Director
December 3, 2004
*
Thomas J. Formolo
Director
December 3, 2004
*
Manuel Perez de la Mesa
Director
December 3, 2004
*By:
/s/ SATHIYAMURTHY CHANDRAMOHAN
Sathiyamurthy Chandramohan
Attorney-in-Fact
Schedule II
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS, LLC
Balance at
Charges to
Balance at
Beginning of
Cost and
End of
Period
Expenses
Deductions
Period
(Dollars in thousands)
$
1,974
$
682
$
(781
)
$
1,875
247
68
(18
)
297
$
2,221
$
750
$
(799
)
$
2,172
$
1,875
$
816
$
(543
)
$
2,148
297
135
(159
)
273
$
2,172
$
951
$
(702
)
$
2,421
$
2,148
$
1,698
$
(1,056
)
$
2,790
273
248
(243
)
278
$
2,421
$
1,946
$
(1,299
)
$
3,068
$
2,790
$
1,110
$
(612
)
$
3,288
278
68
(26
)
320
$
3,068
$
850
$
(617
)
$
3,301
II-7
EXHIBIT INDEX
The following exhibits are filed as part of this
Form S-1 Registration Statement.
Number
Description
1
.1
Form of Underwriting Agreement.
3
.1
Certificate of Incorporation of American
Reprographics Company.**
3
.2
Bylaws of American Reprographics Company.**
3
.3
Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of
Incorporation to be effective upon closing.
3
.4
Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws to be
effective upon closing.
4
.1
Specimen Stock Certificate.
5
.1
Opinion of Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus, Vlahos &
Rudy, LLP regarding the legality of the common stock being
registered.
10
.1
Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated as of
December 18, 2003, among American Reprographics Company,
L.L.C., American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., certain
subsidiaries of American Reprographics Company, as guarantors,
and the lenders named therein.**
10
.2
Second Lien Credit and Guaranty Agreement, dated
as of December 18, 2003, among American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C., American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C.,
certain subsidiaries of American Reprographics Company, as
guarantors, and the lenders named therein.**
10
.3
Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of
December 18, 2003, between American Reprographics Company,
L.L.C. and General Electric Capital Corporation and Goldman
Sachs Credit Partners L.P., as collateral agents.**
10
.4
2004 Bonus Plan, dated March 24, 2004,
between American Reprographics Company and Mr. Legg.**
10
.5
American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit
Option Plan II, adopted effective as of January 1,
2001.**
10
.6
Amendment No. 1, dated as of July 1,
2003, to American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. Unit Option
Plan II.**
10
.7
Form of American Reprographics Company 2005 Stock
Plan.*
10
.8
Forms of Stock Option Agreements under the 2005
Stock Plan.**
10
.9
American Reprographics Company 2005 Employee
Stock Purchase Plan.**
10
.10
Lease Agreement, dated November 19, 1997,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. (formerly Ford
Graphics Group, L.L.C.) and Sumo Holdings LA, LLC.**
10
.11
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings San Jose, LLC.**
10
.12
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings Irvine, LLC.**
10
.13
Lease Agreement, dated December 1, 1997,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. and Sumo Holdings
Sacramento, LLC (Oakland Property).**
10
.14
Lease Agreement between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. (formerly Ford Graphics Group, L.L.C.) and Sumo
Holdings Sacramento, LLC (Sacramento Property).**
10
.15
Lease Agreement, dated December 7, 1995,
between Leet-Melbrook, Inc. and Sumo Holdings Maryland, LLC (as
successor lessor).**
10
.16
Lease Agreement, dated September 23, 2003,
between American Reprographics Company (dba Consolidated
Reprographics) and Sumo Holdings Costa Mesa, LLC.**
10
.17
Management Agreement, dated April 10, 2000,
between American Reprographics Company, L.L.C. and CHS
Management IV, L.P.**
Number
Description
10
.18
Termination Agreement to Management Agreement,
dated November 29, 2004, between American Reprographics
Company, L.L.C. and CHS Management IV, L.P.*
10
.19
Indemnification Agreement, dated April 10,
2000, among American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., American
Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C.,
Mr. Chandramohan, Mr. Suriyakumar, Micro Device, Inc.,
Dietrich-Post Company, ZS Ford L.P., and ZS Ford L.L.C.**
10
.20
Investor Registration Rights Agreement, dated
April 10, 2000, among American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., Mr. Chandramohan,
Mr. Suriyakumar, GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P. and GS
Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.21
First Amendment to Investor Registration Rights
Agreement, among American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC
Acquisition Co., L.L.C., Mr. Chandramohan,
Mr. Suriyakumar, GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P., GS
Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P., Stone Street Fund
2000, L.P. and Bridge Street Special Opportunities Fund 2000,
L.P.
10
.22
Warrant Agreement, dated April 10, 2000,
between American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C. and each of
GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P. and GS Mezzanine
Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.23
First Amendment to Warrant Agreement, dated
September 8, 2000, between American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C. and each of GS Mezzanine Partners II, L.P. and GS
Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P.**
10
.24
Investor Unitholders Agreement, dated
April 10, 2000, among American Reprographics Holdings,
L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., GS Mezzanine
Partners II, L.P. and GS Mezzanine Partners II
Offshore, L.P.**
10
.25
Termination Agreement of Investor Unitholders
Agreement, dated November 29, 2004, among American
Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., GS
Mezzanine Partners II, L.P., GS Mezzanine Partners II
Offshore, L.P., Stone Street Fund 2000, L.P. and Bridge Street
Special Opportunities Fund 2000, L.P.*
10
.26
Form of Indemnification Agreement between
American Reprographics Company and each of its Officers and
Directors.**
10
.27
Forms of Restricted Stock Award Agreements under
2005 Stock Plan.*
10
.28
Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement
under 2005 Stock Plan.*
16
.1
Letter from Ernst & Young LLP Regarding
Change in Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm dated
October 15, 2004.**
21
.1
List of Subsidiaries.**
23
.1
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP,
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.*
23
.2
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP,
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.*
23
.3
Consent of Hanson, Bridgett, Marcus, Vlahos &
Rudy, LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
24
.1
Power of Attorney.**
*
Filed herewith.
**
Previously filed.
To be filed by amendment.
EXHIBIT 10.7
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY
FORM OF 2005 STOCK PLAN
ADOPTED _______________
APPROVED BY SHAREHOLDERS _________________
TERMINATION DATE: __________________
1. PURPOSES.
(a) ELIGIBLE STOCK AWARD RECIPIENTS. The persons eligible to receive Stock Awards are Employees, Directors and Consultants. Only Non-Employee Directors are eligible to receive Options under Section 8.
(b) AVAILABLE STOCK AWARDS. The Plan provides for the grant of the following Stock Awards: (i) Incentive Stock Options, (ii) Nonstatutory Stock Options, (iii) Restricted Stock Purchase Awards, (iv) Restricted Stock Awards, and (v) Restricted Stock Unit Awards.
(c) GENERAL PURPOSE. The Company, by means of the Plan, seeks to secure and retain the services of the group of persons eligible to receive Stock Awards, to provide incentives for such persons to exert maximum efforts for the success of the Company and its Affiliates and to provide a means by which eligible recipients of Stock Awards may be given an opportunity to benefit from increases in the value of the Common Stock.
2. DEFINITIONS.
(a) "AFFILIATE" means any parent corporation or subsidiary corporation of the Company, whether now or hereafter existing, as those terms are defined in Sections 424(e) and (f), respectively, of the Code.
(b) "ANNUAL MEETING" means the annual meeting of the stockholders of the Company.
(c) "BOARD" means the Board of Directors of the Company.
(d) "CAPITALIZATION ADJUSTMENT" has the meaning ascribed to that term in
Section 12(a).
(e) "CAUSE" means, with respect to a Participant, the occurrence of any of the following: (i) such Participant's commission of any felony or any crime involving fraud, dishonesty or moral turpitude under the laws of the United States or any state thereof; (ii) such Participant's attempted commission of, or participation in, a fraud or act of dishonesty against the Company; (iii) such Participant's intentional and material violation of any contract or agreement between the Participant and the Company or any statutory duty owed to the Company; (iv) such Participant's unauthorized use or disclosure of the Company's confidential information or trade secrets or (v) such Participant's gross misconduct. The determination that a termination is for Cause shall be made by the Company in its discretion. Any determination by the Company that the Continuous Service of a Participant was terminated by reason of dismissal without Cause for
the purposes of outstanding Stock Awards held by such Participant shall have no impact upon any determination of the rights or obligations of the Company or such Participant for any other purpose.
(f) "CHANGE IN CONTROL" means the occurrence, in a single transaction or in a series of related transactions, of any one or more of the following events:
(i) any Exchange Act Person becomes the Owner, directly or indirectly, of securities of the Company representing more than fifty percent (50%) of the combined voting power of the Company's then outstanding securities other than by virtue of a merger, consolidation or similar transaction. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a Change in Control shall not be deemed to occur (A) on account of the acquisition of securities of the Company by an investor, any affiliate thereof or any other Exchange Act Person from the Company in a transaction or series of related transactions the primary purpose of which is to obtain financing for the Company through the issuance of equity securities or (B) solely because the level of Ownership held by any Exchange Act Person (the "SUBJECT PERSON") exceeds the designated percentage threshold of the outstanding voting securities as a result of a repurchase or other acquisition of voting securities by the Company reducing the number of shares outstanding, provided that if a Change in Control would occur (but for the operation of this sentence) as a result of the acquisition of voting securities by the Company, and after such share acquisition, the Subject Person becomes the Owner of any additional voting securities that, assuming the repurchase or other acquisition had not occurred, increases the percentage of the then outstanding voting securities Owned by the Subject Person over the designated percentage threshold, then a Change in Control shall be deemed to occur;
(ii) there is consummated a merger, consolidation or similar transaction involving (directly or indirectly) the Company and, immediately after the consummation of such merger, consolidation or similar transaction, the shareholders of the Company immediately prior thereto do not Own, directly or indirectly, either (A) outstanding voting securities representing more than fifty percent (50%) of the combined outstanding voting power of the surviving Entity in such merger, consolidation or similar transaction or (B) more than fifty percent (50%) of the combined outstanding voting power of the parent of the surviving Entity in such merger, consolidation or similar transaction, in each case in substantially the same proportions as their Ownership of the outstanding voting securities of the Company immediately prior to such transaction;
(iii) there is consummated a sale, lease, license or other disposition of all or substantially all of the consolidated assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries, other than a sale, lease, license or other disposition of all or substantially all of the consolidated assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries to an Entity, more than fifty percent (50%) of the combined voting power of the voting securities of which are Owned by shareholders of the Company in substantially the same proportions as their Ownership of the outstanding voting securities of the Company immediately prior to such sale, lease, license or other disposition; or
(iv) individuals who, on the date this Plan is adopted by the Board, are members of the Board (the "INCUMBENT BOARD") cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority of the members of the Board; provided, however, that if the appointment or election (or
nomination for election) of any new Board member was approved or recommended by a majority vote of the members of the Incumbent Board then still in office, such new member shall, for purposes of this Plan, be considered as a member of the Incumbent Board.
Notwithstanding the foregoing or any other provision of this Plan, the definition of Change in Control (or any analogous term) in an individual written agreement between the Company or any Affiliate and the Participant shall supersede the foregoing definition with respect to Stock Awards subject to such agreement (it being understood, however, that if no definition of Change in Control or any analogous term is set forth in such an individual written agreement, the foregoing definition shall apply).
(g) "CODE" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
(h) "COMMITTEE" means a committee of one (1) or more members of the Board appointed by the Board in accordance with Section 3(c).
(i) "COMMON STOCK" means the common stock of the Company.
(j) "COMPANY" means American Reprographics Company, a Delaware corporation.
(k) "CONSULTANT" means any person, including an advisor, who (i) is engaged by the Company or an Affiliate to render consulting or advisory services and is compensated for such services or (ii) is serving as a member of the Board of Directors of an Affiliate and is compensated for such services. However, service solely as a Director, or payment of a fee for such services, shall not cause a Director to be considered a "Consultant" for purposes of the Plan.
(l) "CONTINUOUS SERVICE" means that the Participant's service with the Company or an Affiliate, whether as an Employee, Director or Consultant, is not interrupted or terminated. A change in the capacity in which the Participant renders service to the Company or an Affiliate as an Employee, Consultant or Director or a change in the entity for which the Participant renders such service, provided that there is no interruption or termination of the Participant's service with the Company or an Affiliate, shall not terminate a Participant's Continuous Service. For example, a change in status from an Employee of the Company to a Consultant of an Affiliate or to a Director shall not constitute an interruption of Continuous Service. The Board or the chief executive officer of the Company, in that party's discretion, may determine whether Continuous Service shall be considered interrupted in the case of any leave of absence approved by that party, including sick leave, military leave or any other personal leave. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a leave of absence shall be treated as Continuous Service for purposes of vesting in a Stock Award only to such extent as may be provided in the Company's leave of absence policy or in the written terms of the Participant's leave of absence.
(m) "CORPORATE TRANSACTION" means the occurrence, in a single transaction or in a series of related transactions, of any one or more of the following events:
(i) a sale or other disposition of all or substantially all, as determined by the Board in its discretion, of the consolidated assets of the Company and its Subsidiaries;
(ii) a sale or other disposition of at least ninety percent (90%) of the outstanding securities of the Company;
(iii) a merger, consolidation or similar transaction following which the Company is not the surviving corporation; or
(iv) a merger, consolidation or similar transaction following which the Company is the surviving corporation but the shares of Common Stock outstanding immediately preceding the merger, consolidation or similar transaction are converted or exchanged by virtue of the merger, consolidation or similar transaction into other property, whether in the form of securities, cash or otherwise.
(n) "COVERED EMPLOYEE" means the chief executive officer and the four (4) other highest compensated officers of the Company for whom total compensation is required to be reported to shareholders under the Exchange Act, as determined for purposes of Section 162(m) of the Code.
(o) "DIRECTOR" means a member of the Board.
(p) "DISABILITY" means the permanent and total disability of a person within the meaning of Section 22(e)(3) of the Code.
(q) "EMPLOYEE" means any person employed by the Company or an Affiliate. However, service solely as a Director, or payment of a fee for such services, shall not cause a Director to be considered an "Employee" for purposes of the Plan.
(r) "ENTITY" means a corporation, partnership or other entity.
(s) "EXCHANGE ACT" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
(t) "EXCHANGE ACT PERSON" means any natural person, Entity or "group" (within the meaning of Section 13(d) or 14(d) of the Exchange Act), except that "Exchange Act Person" shall not include (i) the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, (ii) any employee benefit plan of the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company or any trustee or other fiduciary holding securities under an employee benefit plan of the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company, (iii) an underwriter temporarily holding securities pursuant to an offering of such securities, or (iv) an Entity Owned, directly or indirectly, by the shareholders of the Company in substantially the same proportions as their Ownership of stock of the Company.
(u) "FAIR MARKET VALUE" means, as of any date, the value of the Common Stock determined as follows:
(i) If the Common Stock is listed on any established stock exchange or traded on the New York Stock Exchange, the Fair Market Value of a share of Common Stock shall be the closing sales price for such stock (or the closing bid, if no sales were reported) as quoted on such exchange (or the exchange or market with the greatest volume of trading in the Common Stock) on the last market trading day prior to the day of determination, as reported in The Wall Street Journal or such other source as the Board deems reliable.
(ii) In the absence of such markets for the Common Stock, the Fair Market Value shall be determined by the Board in good faith.
(v) "INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION" means an Option intended to qualify as an incentive stock option within the meaning of Section 422 of the Code and the regulations promulgated thereunder.
(w) "IPO DATE" means the effective date of the initial public offering of the Common Stock.
(x) "NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTOR" means a Director who either (i) is not a current Employee or Officer of the Company or an Affiliate, does not receive compensation, either directly or indirectly, from the Company or an Affiliate for services rendered as a consultant or in any capacity other than as a Director (except for an amount as to which disclosure would not be required under Item 404(a) of Regulation S-K promulgated pursuant to the Securities Act ("REGULATION S-K")), does not possess an interest in any other transaction for which disclosure would be required under Item 404(a) of Regulation S-K, and is not engaged in a business relationship for which disclosure would be required pursuant to Item 404(b) of Regulation S-K; or (ii) is otherwise considered a "non-employee director" for purposes of Rule 16b-3.
(y) "NONSTATUTORY STOCK OPTION" means an Option not intended to qualify as an Incentive Stock Option.
(z) "OFFICER" means a person who is an officer of the Company within the meaning of Section 16 of the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.
(aa) "OPTION" means an option to purchase shares of Common Stock granted pursuant to the Plan.
(bb) "OPTION AGREEMENT" means a written agreement between the Company and an Optionholder evidencing the terms and conditions of an Option grant. Each Option Agreement shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.
(cc) "OPTIONHOLDER" means a person to whom an Option is granted pursuant to the Plan or, if applicable, such other person who holds an outstanding Option.
(dd) "OUTSIDE DIRECTOR" means a Director who either (i) is not a current employee of the Company or an "affiliated corporation" (within the meaning of Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 162(m) of the Code), is not a former employee of the Company or an "affiliated corporation" who receives compensation for prior services (other than benefits under a tax-qualified retirement plan) during the taxable year, has not been an officer of the Company or an "affiliated corporation", and does not receive remuneration from the Company or an "affiliated corporation," either directly or indirectly, in any capacity other than as a Director or (ii) is otherwise considered an "outside director" for purposes of Section 162(m) of the Code.
(ee) "OWN," "OWNED," "OWNER," "OWNERSHIP" A person or Entity shall be deemed to "Own," to have "Owned," to be the "Owner" of, or to have acquired "Ownership" of securities if such person or Entity, directly or indirectly, through any contract, arrangement, understanding,
relationship or otherwise, has or shares voting power, which includes the power to vote or to direct the voting, with respect to such securities.
(ff) "PARTICIPANT" means a person to whom a Stock Award is granted pursuant to the Plan or, if applicable, such other person who holds an outstanding Stock Award.
(gg) "PLAN" means this American Reprographics Company 2005 Stock Plan, as amended and restated.
(hh) "RESTRICTED STOCK AWARD" means an award of shares of Common Stock which is granted pursuant to the terms and conditions of Section 7(b).
(ii) "RESTRICTED STOCK AWARD AGREEMENT" means a written agreement between the Company and a holder of a Stock Bonus Award evidencing the terms and conditions of a Stock Bonus Award grant. Each Stock Bonus Award Agreement shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.
(jj) "RESTRICTED STOCK PURCHASE AWARD" means an award of shares of Common Stock which is granted pursuant to the terms and conditions of Section 7(a).
(kk) "RESTRICTED STOCK PURCHASE AWARD AGREEMENT" means a written agreement between the Company and a holder of a Restricted Stock Purchase Award evidencing the terms and conditions of a Restricted Stock Purchase Award grant. Each Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.
(ll) "RESTRICTED STOCK UNIT AWARD" means a right to receive shares of Common Stock which is granted pursuant to the terms and conditions of Section 7(c).
(mm) "RESTRICTED STOCK UNIT AWARD AGREEMENT" means a written agreement between the Company and a holder of a Restricted Stock Unit Award evidencing the terms and conditions of a Restricted Stock Unit Award grant. Each Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.
(nn) "RULE 16b-3" means Rule 16b-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act or any successor to Rule 16b-3, as in effect from time to time.
(oo) "SECURITIES ACT" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
(pp) "STOCK AWARD" means any right granted under the Plan, including an Option, a Restricted Stock Purchase Award, or a Restricted Stock Unit Award.
(qq) "STOCK AWARD AGREEMENT" means a written agreement between the Company and a Participant evidencing the terms and conditions of a Stock Award grant. Each Stock Award Agreement shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.
(rr) "SUBSIDIARY" means, with respect to the Company, (i) any corporation of which more than fifty percent (50%) of the outstanding capital stock having ordinary voting power to elect a majority of the board of directors of such corporation (irrespective of whether, at the time,
stock of any other class or classes of such corporation shall have or might have voting power by reason of the happening of any contingency) is at the time, directly or indirectly, Owned by the Company, and (ii) any partnership in which the Company has a direct or indirect interest (whether in the form of voting or participation in profits or capital contribution) of more than fifty percent (50%).
(ss) "TEN PERCENT SHAREHOLDER" means a person who Owns (or is deemed to Own pursuant to Section 424(d) of the Code) stock possessing more than ten percent (10%) of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of the Company or of any of its Affiliates.
3. ADMINISTRATION.
(a) ADMINISTRATION BY BOARD. The Board shall administer the Plan unless and until the Board delegates administration of the Plan to a Committee, as provided in Section 3(c).
(b) POWERS OF BOARD. The Board shall have the power, subject to, and within the limitations of, the express provisions of the Plan:
(i) To determine from time to time which of the persons eligible under the Plan shall be granted Stock Awards; when and how each Stock Award shall be granted; what type or combination of types of Stock Award shall be granted; the provisions of each Stock Award granted (which need not be identical), including the time or times when a person shall be permitted to receive Common Stock pursuant to a Stock Award; and the number of shares of Common Stock with respect to which a Stock Award shall be granted to each such person.
(ii) To construe and interpret the Plan and Stock Awards granted under it, and to establish, amend and revoke rules and regulations for its administration. The Board, in the exercise of this power, may correct any defect, omission or inconsistency in the Plan or in any Stock Award Agreement, in a manner and to the extent it shall deem necessary or expedient to make the Plan fully effective.
(iii) To effect, at any time and from time to time, with the consent of any adversely affected Optionholder, (1) the reduction of the exercise price of any outstanding Option under the Plan, (2) the cancellation of any outstanding Option under the Plan and the grant in substitution therefor of (A) a new Option under the Plan or another equity plan of the Company covering the same or a different number of shares of Common Stock, (B) a Restricted Stock Purchase Award, (C) a Restricted Stock Award, (D) a Restricted Stock Unit Award, (E) cash and/or (F) other valuable consideration (as determined by the Board, in its discretion), or (3) any other action that is treated as a repricing under generally accepted accounting principles.
(iv) To amend the Plan or a Stock Award as provided in Section 13.
(v) To terminate or suspend the Plan as provided in Section 14.
(vi) Generally, to exercise such powers and to perform such acts as the Board deems necessary or expedient to promote the best interests of the Company and that are not in conflict with the provisions of the Plan.
(vii) To adopt such procedures and sub-plans as are necessary or appropriate to permit participation in the Plan by Employees who are foreign nationals or employed outside the United States.
(c) DELEGATION TO COMMITTEE.
(i) GENERAL. The Board may delegate some or all of the administration of the Plan to a Committee or Committees of one (1) or more members of the Board, and the term "COMMITTEE" shall apply to any person or persons to whom such authority has been delegated. If administration is delegated to a Committee, the Committee shall have, in connection with the administration of the Plan, the powers theretofore possessed by the Board that have been delegated to the Committee, including the power to delegate to a subcommittee any of the administrative powers the Committee is authorized to exercise (and references in this Plan to the Board shall thereafter be to the Committee or subcommittee), subject, however, to such resolutions, not inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan, as may be adopted from time to time by the Board. The Board may retain the authority to concurrently administer the Plan with the Committee and may, at any time, revest in the Board some or all of the powers previously delegated.
(ii) SECTION 162(m) AND RULE 16b-3 COMPLIANCE. In the discretion of the Board, the Committee may consist solely of two or more Outside Directors, in accordance with Section 162(m) of the Code, and/or solely of two or more Non-Employee Directors, in accordance with Rule 16b-3. In addition, the Board or the Committee, in its discretion, may (1) delegate to a committee of one or more members of the Board who need not be Outside Directors the authority to grant Stock Awards to eligible persons who are either (a) not then Covered Employees and are not expected to be Covered Employees at the time of recognition of income resulting from such Stock Award, or (b) not persons with respect to whom the Company wishes to comply with Section 162(m) of the Code, and/or (2) delegate to a committee of one or more members of the Board who need not be Non-Employee Directors the authority to grant Stock Awards to eligible persons who are not then subject to Section 16 of the Exchange Act.
(d) DELEGATION TO AN OFFICER. The Board may delegate to one or more
Officers of the Company the authority to do one or both of the following: (i)
designate Officers and Employees of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to be
recipients of Stock Awards and (ii) determine the number of shares of Common
Stock to be subject to such Stock Awards granted to such Officers and Employees
of the Company; provided, however, that the Board resolutions regarding such
delegation shall specify the total number of shares of Common Stock that may be
subject to the Stock Awards granted by such Officer and that such Officer may
not grant a Stock Award to himself or herself. Notwithstanding anything to the
contrary in this Section 3(d), the Board may not delegate to an Officer
authority to determine the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock pursuant to
Section 2(u)(ii) above.
(e) EFFECT OF BOARD'S DECISION. All determinations, interpretations and constructions made by the Board in good faith shall not be subject to review by any person and shall be final, binding and conclusive on all persons.
4. SHARES SUBJECT TO THE PLAN.
(a) SHARE RESERVE. Subject to the provisions of Section 12(a) relating to Capitalization Adjustments, the shares of Common Stock that may be issued pursuant to Stock Awards shall not exceed in the aggregate five million (5,000,000) shares of Common Stock plus an automatic annual increase to be added on the first day of the fiscal year of the Company for a period beginning on the first day of the fiscal year that begins on January 1, 2006, and ending on (and including) the first day of the fiscal year that begins on January 1, 2010, equal to the least of the following amounts: (i) one percent (1%) of the Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock on the day preceding the first day of the applicable Company fiscal year (rounded to the nearest whole share), (ii) three hundred thousand (300,000) shares of Common Stock, or (iii) an amount as may be determined by the Board.
(b) REVERSION OF SHARES TO THE SHARE RESERVE. If any Stock Award shall for any reason expire or otherwise terminate, in whole or in part, without having been exercised in full, or if any shares of Common Stock issued to a Participant pursuant to a Stock Award are forfeited to or repurchased by the Company, including, but not limited to, any repurchase or forfeiture caused by the failure to meet a contingency or condition required for the vesting of such shares, then the shares of Common Stock not issued under such Stock Award, or forfeited to or repurchased by the Company, shall revert to and again become available for issuance under the Plan. If any shares subject to a Stock Award are not delivered to a Participant because such shares are withheld for the payment of taxes or the Stock Award is exercised through a reduction of shares subject to the Stock Award (i.e., "net exercised"), the number of shares that are not delivered to the Participant shall remain available for issuance under the Plan. If the exercise price of any Stock Award is satisfied by tendering shares of Common Stock held by the Participant (either by actual delivery or attestation), then the number of shares so tendered shall remain available for issuance under the Plan. For purposes of qualification under Section 422 of the Code, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Section 4(b) and subject to the provisions of Section 12(a) relating to Capitalization Adjustments, the aggregate maximum number of shares of Common Stock that may be issued as Incentive Stock Options shall be six million five hundred thousand (6,500,000) shares of Common Stock. In addition, the aggregate maximum number of shares of Common Stock that may be issued as Restricted Stock Awards shall be ten percent (10%) of the total of the Company's outstanding shares of Common Stock, as determined with respect to each Restricted Stock Award at the time such award is granted.
(c) SOURCE OF SHARES. The shares of Common Stock subject to the Plan may be unissued shares or reacquired shares, bought on the market or otherwise.
5. ELIGIBILITY.
(a) ELIGIBILITY FOR SPECIFIC STOCK AWARDS. Incentive Stock Options may be granted only to Employees. Stock Awards other than Incentive Stock Options may be granted to Employees, Directors and Consultants.
(b) TEN PERCENT SHAREHOLDERS. A Ten Percent Shareholder shall not be granted an Incentive Stock Option unless the exercise price of such Option is at least one hundred ten
percent (110%) of the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock on the date of grant and the Option is not exercisable after the expiration of five (5) years from the date of grant.
(c) SECTION 162(m) LIMITATION ON ANNUAL GRANTS. Subject to the provisions of Section 12(a) relating to Capitalization Adjustments, at such time as the Company may be subject to the applicable provisions of Section 162(m) of the Code, no Employee shall be eligible to be granted Options covering more than five hundred thousand (500,000) shares of Common Stock during any calendar year.
(d) CONSULTANTS. A Consultant shall not be eligible for the grant of a Stock Award if, at the time of grant, a Form S-8 Registration Statement under the Securities Act ("FORM S-8") is not available to register either the offer or the sale of the Company's securities to such Consultant because of the nature of the services that the Consultant is providing to the Company, because the Consultant is not a natural person, or because of any other rule governing the use of Form S-8.
6. OPTION PROVISIONS.
Each Option shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as the Board shall deem appropriate. All Options shall be separately designated Incentive Stock Options or Nonstatutory Stock Options at the time of grant, and, if certificates are issued, a separate certificate or certificates shall be issued for shares of Common Stock on exercise of each type of Option. The provisions of separate Options need not be identical, but each Option shall include (through incorporation of provisions hereof by reference in the Option or otherwise) the substance of each of the following provisions:
(a) TERM. The Board shall determine the term of an Option; provided however that, subject to the provisions of Section 5(b) regarding Ten Percent Shareholders, no Incentive Stock Option shall be exercisable after the expiration of ten (10) years from the date on which it was granted.
(b) EXERCISE PRICE OF AN OPTION. Subject to the provisions of Section 5(b) regarding Ten Percent Shareholders, the exercise price of each Option shall be not less than one hundred percent (100%) of the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Option on the date the Option is granted. Notwithstanding the foregoing, an Incentive Stock Option may be granted with an exercise price lower than that set forth in the preceding sentence if such Option is granted pursuant to an assumption or substitution for another option in a manner satisfying the provisions of Section 424(a) of the Code.
(c) CONSIDERATION. The purchase price of Common Stock acquired pursuant to
an Option shall be paid, to the extent permitted by applicable law, either (i)
in cash at the time the Option is exercised or (ii) at the discretion of the
Board at the time of the grant of the Option (or subsequently in the case of a
Nonstatutory Stock Option) (1) by delivery to the Company (either by actual
delivery or attestation) of other Common Stock at the time the Option is
exercised, (2) by a "net exercise" of the Option (as further described below),
(3) pursuant to a program developed under Regulation T as promulgated by the
Federal Reserve Board that, prior to the issuance of Common Stock, results in
either the receipt of cash (or check) by the Company or the
receipt of irrevocable instructions to pay the aggregate exercise price to the Company from the sales proceeds or (4) in any other form of legal consideration that may be acceptable to the Board. Unless otherwise specifically provided in the Option, the purchase price of Common Stock acquired pursuant to an Option that is paid by delivery to the Company of other Common Stock acquired, directly or indirectly from the Company, shall be paid only by shares of the Common Stock of the Company that have been held for more than six (6) months (or such longer or shorter period of time required to avoid a charge to earnings for financial accounting purposes). At any time that the Company is incorporated in Delaware, payment of the Common Stock's "par value," as defined in the Delaware General Corporation Law, shall not be made by deferred payment.
In the case of a "net exercise" of an Option, the Company will not require a payment of the exercise price of the Option from the Participant but will reduce the number of shares of Common Stock issued upon the exercise by the largest number of whole shares that has a Fair Market Value that does not exceed the aggregate exercise price. With respect to any remaining balance of the aggregate exercise price, the Company shall accept a cash payment from the Participant. Shares of Common Stock will no longer be outstanding under an Option (and will therefore not thereafter be exercisable) following the exercise of such Option to the extent of (i) shares used to pay the exercise price of an Option under the "net exercise", (ii) shares actually delivered to the Participant as a result of such exercise and (iii) shares withheld for purposes of tax withholding.
(d) TRANSFERABILITY OF AN INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION. An Incentive Stock Option shall not be transferable except by will or by the laws of descent and distribution and shall be exercisable during the lifetime of the Optionholder only by the Optionholder. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Optionholder may, by delivering written notice to the Company, in a form provided by or otherwise satisfactory to the Company, designate a third party who, in the event of the death of the Optionholder, shall thereafter be entitled to exercise the Option.
(e) TRANSFERABILITY OF A NONSTATUTORY STOCK OPTION. A Nonstatutory Stock Option shall be transferable to the extent provided in the Option Agreement. If the Nonstatutory Stock Option does not provide for transferability, then the Nonstatutory Stock Option shall not be transferable except by will or by the laws of descent and distribution and shall be exercisable during the lifetime of the Optionholder only by the Optionholder. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Optionholder may, by delivering written notice to the Company, in a form provided by or otherwise satisfactory to the Company, designate a third party who, in the event of the death of the Optionholder, shall thereafter be entitled to exercise the Option.
(f) VESTING GENERALLY. The total number of shares of Common Stock subject to an Option may vest and therefore become exercisable in periodic installments that may be equal. The Option may be subject to such other terms and conditions on the time or times when it may be exercised (which may be based on performance or other criteria) as the Board may deem appropriate. The vesting provisions of individual Options may vary. The provisions of this Section 6(f) are subject to any Option provisions governing the minimum number of shares of Common Stock as to which an Option may be exercised.
(g) TERMINATION OF CONTINUOUS SERVICE. In the event that an Optionholder's Continuous Service terminates (for reasons other than Cause or upon the Optionholder's death or Disability), the Optionholder may exercise his or her Option (to the extent that the Optionholder was entitled to exercise such Option as of the date of termination of Continuous Service) but only within such period of time ending on the earlier of (i) the expiration of the term of the Option as set forth in the Option Agreement or (ii) the date three (3) months following the termination of the Optionholder's Continuous Service (or such longer or shorter period specified in the Option Agreement). If, after termination of Continuous Service, the Optionholder does not exercise his or her Option within the time specified herein or in the Option Agreement (as applicable), the Option shall terminate.
(h) EXTENSION OF TERMINATION DATE. An Optionholder's Option Agreement may provide that if the exercise of the Option following the termination of the Optionholder's Continuous Service (for reasons other than Cause or upon the Optionholder's death or Disability) would be prohibited at any time solely because the issuance of shares of Common Stock would violate the registration requirements under the Securities Act, then the Option shall terminate on the earlier of (i) the expiration of the term of the Option set forth in the Option Agreement or (ii) the expiration of a period of three (3) months after the termination of the Optionholder's Continuous Service during which the exercise of the Option would not be in violation of such registration requirements.
(i) DISABILITY OF OPTIONHOLDER. In the event that an Optionholder's
Continuous Service terminates as a result of the Optionholder's Disability, the
Optionholder may exercise his or her Option (to the extent that the Optionholder
was entitled to exercise such Option as of the date of termination of Continuous
Service), but only within such period of time ending on the earlier of (i) the
expiration of the term of the Option as set forth in the Option Agreement or
(ii) the date twelve (12) months following such termination of Continuous
Service (or such longer or shorter period specified in the Option Agreement).
If, after termination of Continuous Service, the Optionholder does not exercise
his or her Option within the time specified herein or in the Option Agreement
(as applicable), the Option shall terminate.
(j) DEATH OF OPTIONHOLDER. In the event that (i) an Optionholder's Continuous Service terminates as a result of the Optionholder's death or (ii) the Optionholder dies within the period (if any) specified in the Option Agreement after the termination of the Optionholder's Continuous Service for a reason other than death, then the Option may be exercised (to the extent the Optionholder was entitled to exercise such Option as of the date of death) by the Optionholder's estate, by a person who acquired the right to exercise the Option by bequest or inheritance or by a person designated to exercise the option upon the Optionholder's death pursuant to Section 6(d) or 6(e), but only within the period ending on the earlier of (i) the expiration of the term of such Option as set forth in the Option Agreement or (ii) the date eighteen (18) months following the date of death (or such longer or shorter period specified in the Option Agreement). If, after the Optionholder's death, the Option is not exercised within the time specified herein or in the Option Agreement (as applicable), the Option shall terminate.
(k) TERMINATION FOR CAUSE. In the event that an Optionholder's Continuous Service is terminated for Cause, the Option shall terminate upon the termination date of such
Optionholder's Continuous Service, and the Optionholder shall be prohibited from exercising his or her Option from and after the time of such termination of Continuous Service.
(l) EARLY EXERCISE. The Option may include a provision whereby the Optionholder may elect at any time before the Optionholder's Continuous Service terminates to exercise the Option as to any part or all of the shares of Common Stock subject to the Option prior to the full vesting of the Option. Any unvested shares of Common Stock so purchased may be subject to a repurchase option in favor of the Company or to any other restriction the Board determines to be appropriate. The Company shall not be required to exercise its repurchase option until at least six (6) months (or such longer or shorter period of time required to avoid a charge to earnings for financial accounting purposes) have elapsed following exercise of the Option unless the Board otherwise specifically provides in the Option.
7. PROVISIONS OF STOCK AWARDS OTHER THAN OPTIONS.
(a) RESTRICTED STOCK PURCHASE AWARDS. Each Restricted Stock Purchase Award
Agreement shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as
the Board shall deem appropriate. At the Board's election, shares of Common
Stock may be (i) held in book entry form subject to the Company's instructions
until any restrictions relating to the Restricted Stock Purchase Award lapse; or
(ii) evidenced by a certificate, which certificate shall be held in such form
and manner as determined by the Board. The terms and conditions of Restricted
Stock Purchase Award Agreements may change from time to time, and the terms and
conditions of separate Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreements need not be
identical, provided, however, that each Restricted Stock Purchase Award
Agreement shall include (through incorporation of the provisions hereof by
reference in the agreement or otherwise) the substance of each of the following
provisions:
(i) PURCHASE PRICE. At the time of the grant of a Restricted Stock Purchase Award, the Board will determine the price to be paid by the Participant for each share subject to the Restricted Stock Purchase Award. To the extent required by applicable law, the price to be paid by the Participant for each share of the Restricted Stock Purchase Award will not be less than the par value of a share of Common Stock.
(ii) CONSIDERATION. At the time of the grant of a Restricted Stock Purchase Award, the Board will determine the consideration permissible for the payment of the purchase price of the Restricted Stock Purchase Award. The purchase price of Common Stock acquired pursuant to the Restricted Stock Purchase Award shall be paid either: (i) in cash at the time of purchase or (ii) in any other form of legal consideration that may be acceptable to the Board and permissible under the Delaware General Corporation Law.
(iii) VESTING. Shares of Common Stock acquired under a Restricted Stock Purchase Award may be subject to a share repurchase right or option in favor of the Company in accordance with a vesting schedule to be determined by the Board.
(iv) TERMINATION OF PARTICIPANT'S CONTINUOUS SERVICE. In the event that a Participant's Continuous Service terminates, the Company shall have the right, but not the obligation, to repurchase or otherwise reacquire, any or all of the shares of Common Stock held
by the Participant that have not vested as of the date of termination under the terms of the Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement. At the Board's election, the repurchase right may be at the least of: (i) the Fair Market Value on the relevant date or (ii) the Participant's original cost. The Company shall not be required to exercise its repurchase option until at least six (6) months (or such longer or shorter period of time required to avoid a charge to earnings for financial accounting purposes) have elapsed following the purchase of the restricted stock unless otherwise determined by the Board or provided in the Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement.
(v) TRANSFERABILITY. Rights to purchase or receive shares of Common Stock granted under a Restricted Stock Purchase Award shall be transferable by the Participant only upon such terms and conditions as are set forth in the Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement, as the Board shall determine in its discretion, and so long as Common Stock awarded under the Restricted Stock Purchase Award remains subject to the terms of the Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement.
(b) RESTRICTED STOCK AWARDS. Each Restricted Stock Award Agreement shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as the Board shall deem appropriate. At the Board's election, shares of Common Stock may be (i) held in book entry form subject to the Company's instructions until any restrictions relating to the Restricted Stock Award lapse; or (ii) evidenced by a certificate, which certificate shall be held in such form and manner as determined by the Board. The terms and conditions of Restricted Stock Award Agreements may change from time to time, and the terms and conditions of separate Restricted Stock Award Agreements need not be identical, but each Restricted Stock Award Agreement shall include (through incorporation of provisions hereof by reference in the agreement or otherwise) the substance of each of the following provisions:
(i) CONSIDERATION. A Restricted Stock Award may be awarded in consideration for past services actually rendered to the Company or an Affiliate.
(ii) VESTING. Shares of Common Stock awarded under the Restricted Stock Award Agreement may be subject to forfeiture to the Company in accordance with a vesting schedule to be determined by the Board.
(iii) TERMINATION OF PARTICIPANT'S CONTINUOUS SERVICE. In the event a Participant's Continuous Service terminates, any or all of the shares of Common Stock held by the Participant which have not vested as of the date of termination of Continuous Service shall be forfeited under the terms of the Restricted Stock Award Agreement.
(iv) TRANSFERABILITY. Rights to acquire shares of Common Stock under the Restricted Stock Award Agreement shall be transferable by the Participant only upon such terms and conditions as are set forth in the Restricted Stock Award Agreement, as the Board shall determine in its discretion, so long as Common Stock awarded under the Restricted Stock Award Agreement remains subject to the terms of the Restricted Stock Award Agreement.
(c) RESTRICTED STOCK UNIT AWARDS. A Restricted Stock Unit Award shall be denominated in units equivalent to a number of shares of Common Stock and shall represent a
promise to pay the value of such units upon vesting. Each Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as the Board shall deem appropriate. The terms and conditions of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements may change from time to time, and the terms and conditions of separate Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreements need not be identical, provided, however, that each Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement shall include (through incorporation of the provisions hereof by reference in the agreement or otherwise) the substance of each of the following provisions:
(i) VESTING. At the time of the grant of a Restricted Stock Unit Award, the Board shall impose such restrictions or conditions to the vesting of the Restricted Stock Unit Award as it, in its discretion, deems appropriate.
(ii) PAYMENT. A Restricted Stock Unit Award, net of any withholding obligations, may, to the extent vested, be settled by the delivery of shares of Common Stock, their cash equivalent, any combination thereof or in any other form of consideration as determined by the Board and contained in the Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement.
(iii) ADDITIONAL RESTRICTIONS. At the time of the grant of a Restricted Stock Unit Award, the Board, as it deems appropriate, may impose such restrictions or conditions that delay the delivery of the shares of Common Stock (or their cash equivalent) subject to a Restricted Stock Unit Award after the vesting of such Restricted Stock Unit Award.
(iv) DIVIDEND EQUIVALENTS. Dividend equivalents may be credited in respect of shares of Common Stock covered by a Restricted Stock Unit Award, as determined by the Board and contained in the Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement. At the discretion of the Board, such dividend equivalents may be converted into additional shares of Common Stock covered by the Restricted Stock Unit Award in such manner as determined by the Board. Any additional shares covered by the Restricted Stock Unit Award credited by reason of such dividend equivalents will be subject to all the terms and conditions of the underlying Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement to which they relate.
8. NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTORS' NONSTATUTORY STOCK OPTION PROGRAM.
Without any further action by the Board, automatic Option grants shall be
made under the Plan in accordance with this Section 8 to Non-Employee Directors
who meet the criteria specified in Section 8(a). All Options granted under this
Section 8 shall be Nonstatutory Stock Options and shall be in such form as may
be approved by the Board, subject to the provisions of the Plan and Section 8.
(a) NON-DISCRETIONARY GRANTS. Without any further action of the Board, on the date of each Annual Meeting, commencing with the first Annual Meeting on or after the IPO Date, each person who is then a Non-Employee Director shall be automatically granted a Nonstatutory Option having a value (on the date of grant) equal to $50,000 of the annual cash compensation (excluding Committee fees) then payable by the Company to such Non-Employee Director, for his or her service as Non-Employee Director since the later of: (i) the last preceding Annual Meeting, or (ii) the date on which such person is elected or appointed for the first time to be a Non-Employee Director. For this purpose, the value of an Option, and thus the number of shares
of Common Stock granted under such Option, shall be determined under the Black-Scholes option pricing formula, and any fractional shares shall be rounded to the nearest whole number of shares.
(b) OPTION PROVISIONS. Each Option granted under this Section 8 shall include (through incorporation by reference in the Option or otherwise) the substance of each of the provisions of Section 6, except that no Option granted under this Section 8 shall be exercisable after the expiration of ten (10) years after the date on which it was granted and the exercise price of each Option granted under this Section 8 shall be one hundred percent (100%) of the Fair Market Value of the Common Stock subject to the Option on the date the Option is granted.
9. COVENANTS OF THE COMPANY.
(a) AVAILABILITY OF SHARES. During the terms of the Stock Awards, the Company shall keep available at all times the number of shares of Common Stock required to satisfy such Stock Awards.
(b) SECURITIES LAW COMPLIANCE. The Company shall seek to obtain from each regulatory commission or agency having jurisdiction over the Plan such authority as may be required to grant Stock Awards and to issue and sell shares of Common Stock upon exercise of the Stock Awards; provided, however, that this undertaking shall not require the Company to register under the Securities Act the Plan, any Stock Award or any Common Stock issued or issuable pursuant to any such Stock Award. If, after reasonable efforts, the Company is unable to obtain from any such regulatory commission or agency the authority which counsel for the Company deems necessary for the lawful issuance and sale of Common Stock under the Plan, the Company shall be relieved from any liability for failure to issue and sell Common Stock upon exercise of such Stock Awards unless and until such authority is obtained.
10. USE OF PROCEEDS FROM STOCK.
Proceeds from the sale of Common Stock pursuant to Stock Awards shall constitute general funds of the Company.
11. MISCELLANEOUS.
(a) ACCELERATION OF EXERCISABILITY AND VESTING. The Board shall have the power to accelerate the time at which a Stock Award may first be exercised or the time during which a Stock Award or any part thereof will vest in accordance with the Plan, notwithstanding the provisions in the Stock Award stating the time at which it may first be exercised or the time during which it will vest.
(b) SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS. No Participant shall be deemed to be the holder of, or to have any of the rights of a holder with respect to, any shares of Common Stock subject to such Stock Award unless and until such Participant has satisfied all requirements for exercise of the Stock Award pursuant to its terms.
(c) NO EMPLOYMENT OR OTHER SERVICE RIGHTS. Nothing in the Plan, any Stock Award Agreement or other instrument executed thereunder or any Stock Award granted pursuant
thereto shall confer upon any Participant any right to continue to serve the Company or an Affiliate in the capacity in effect at the time the Stock Award was granted or shall affect the right of the Company or an Affiliate to terminate (i) the employment of an Employee with or without notice and with or without cause, (ii) the service of a Consultant pursuant to the terms of such Consultant's agreement with the Company or an Affiliate or (iii) the service of a Director pursuant to the Bylaws of the Company or an Affiliate, and any applicable provisions of the corporate law of the state in which the Company or the Affiliate is incorporated, as the case may be.
(d) INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION $100,000 LIMITATION. To the extent that the aggregate Fair Market Value (determined at the time of grant) of Common Stock with respect to which Incentive Stock Options are exercisable for the first time by any Optionholder during any calendar year (under all plans of the Company and its Affiliates) exceeds one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000), the Options or portions thereof that exceed such limit (according to the order in which they were granted) shall be treated as Nonstatutory Stock Options, notwithstanding any contrary provision of the applicable Option Agreement(s).
(e) INVESTMENT ASSURANCES. The Company may require a Participant, as a condition of exercising or acquiring Common Stock under any Stock Award, (i) to give written assurances satisfactory to the Company as to the Participant's knowledge and experience in financial and business matters and/or to employ a purchaser representative reasonably satisfactory to the Company who is knowledgeable and experienced in financial and business matters and that he or she is capable of evaluating, alone or together with the purchaser representative, the merits and risks of exercising the Stock Award; and (ii) to give written assurances satisfactory to the Company stating that the Participant is acquiring Common Stock subject to the Stock Award for the Participant's own account and not with any present intention of selling or otherwise distributing the Common Stock. The foregoing requirements, and any assurances given pursuant to such requirements, shall be inoperative if (1) the issuance of the shares of Common Stock upon the exercise or acquisition of Common Stock under the Stock Award has been registered under a then currently effective registration statement under the Securities Act or (2) as to any particular requirement, a determination is made by counsel for the Company that such requirement need not be met in the circumstances under the then applicable securities laws. The Company may, upon advice of counsel to the Company, place legends on stock certificates issued under the Plan as such counsel deems necessary or appropriate in order to comply with applicable securities laws, including, but not limited to, legends restricting the transfer of the Common Stock.
(f) WITHHOLDING OBLIGATIONS. To the extent provided by the terms of a Stock Award Agreement, the Company may in its discretion, satisfy any federal, state or local tax withholding obligation relating to a Stock Award by any of the following means (in addition to the Company's right to withhold from any compensation paid to the Participant by the Company) or by a combination of such means: (i) causing the Participant to tender a cash payment; (ii) withholding shares of Common Stock from the shares of Common Stock issued or otherwise issuable to the Participant in connection with the Stock Award; or (iii) by such other method as may be set forth in the Stock Award Agreement.
12. ADJUSTMENTS UPON CHANGES IN STOCK.
(a) CAPITALIZATION ADJUSTMENTS. If any change is made in, or other event occurs with respect to, the Common Stock subject to the Plan or subject to any Stock Award without the receipt of consideration by the Company through merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, reincorporation, stock dividend, dividend in property other than cash, stock split, liquidating dividend, combination of shares, exchange of shares, change in corporate structure or other transaction not involving the receipt of consideration by the Company (each a "CAPITALIZATION ADJUSTMENT"), then (i) the Plan will be appropriately adjusted in the class(es) and maximum number of securities subject to the Plan pursuant to Sections 4(a) and 4(b) and the maximum number of securities subject to award to any person pursuant to Section 5(c) and (ii) the outstanding Stock Awards will be appropriately adjusted in the class(es) and number of securities and price per share of Common Stock subject to such outstanding Stock Awards. The Board shall make such adjustments, and its determination shall be final, binding and conclusive. (Notwithstanding the foregoing, the conversion of any convertible securities of the Company shall not be treated as a transaction "without receipt of consideration" by the Company.)
(b) DISSOLUTION OR LIQUIDATION. In the event of a dissolution or liquidation of the Company, all outstanding Stock Awards (other than Stock Awards consisting of vested Common Stock not subject to the Company's right of repurchase) shall terminate immediately prior to the completion of such dissolution or liquidation, and Common Stock subject to the Company's repurchase option may be repurchased by the Company notwithstanding the fact that the holder of such stock is still in Continuous Service; provided however that, the Board may, in its discretion, cause some or all Stock Awards to be fully vested, exercisable and/or no longer subject to repurchase (to the extent such Stock Awards have not previously expired or terminated) before the dissolution or liquidation is completed but contingent on its completion.
(c) CORPORATE TRANSACTION. In the event of a Corporate Transaction, any surviving corporation or acquiring corporation may assume or continue any or all Stock Awards outstanding under the Plan or may substitute similar stock awards for Stock Awards outstanding under the Plan (including but not limited to, awards to acquire the same consideration paid to the shareholders of the Company, as the case may be, pursuant to the Corporate Transaction), and any reacquisition or repurchase rights held by the Company in respect of Common Stock issued pursuant to Stock Awards may be assigned by the Company to the successor of the Company (or the successor's parent company), if any, in connection with such Corporate Transaction. In the event that any surviving corporation or acquiring corporation does not assume or continue all such outstanding Stock Awards or substitute similar stock awards for all such outstanding Stock Awards, then with respect to Stock Awards that have been not assumed, continued or substituted and that are held by Participants whose Continuous Service has not terminated prior to the effective time of the Corporate Transaction, the vesting of such Stock Awards (and, if applicable, the time at which such Stock Awards may be exercised) shall (contingent upon the effectiveness of the Corporate Transaction) be accelerated in full to a date prior to the effective time of such Corporate Transaction as the Board shall determine (or, if the Board shall not determine such a date, to the date that is five (5) days prior to the effective time of the Corporate Transaction), and such Stock Awards shall terminate if not exercised (if applicable) at or prior to such effective time and any reacquisition or repurchase rights held by the Company with respect to such Stock Awards shall (contingent upon the effectiveness of the Corporate Transaction) lapse. With
respect to any other Stock Awards outstanding under the Plan that have not been assumed, continued or substituted, the vesting of such Stock Awards (and, if applicable, the time at which such Stock Award may be exercised) shall not be accelerated, unless otherwise provided in a written agreement between the Company or any Affiliate and the holder of such Stock Award, and such Stock Awards shall terminate if not exercised (if applicable) prior to the effective time of the Corporate Transaction.
(d) CHANGE IN CONTROL. A Stock Award may be subject to additional acceleration of vesting and exercisability upon or after a Change in Control as may be provided in the Stock Award Agreement for such Stock Award or as may be provided in any other written agreement between the Company or any Affiliate and the Participant, but in the absence of such provision, no such acceleration shall occur.
13. AMENDMENT OF THE PLAN AND STOCK AWARDS.
(a) AMENDMENT OF PLAN. Subject to the limitations, if any, of applicable law, the Board at any time, and from time to time, may amend the Plan. However, except as provided in Section 12(a) relating to Capitalization Adjustments, no amendment shall be effective unless approved by the shareholders of the Company to the extent shareholder approval is necessary to satisfy applicable law.
(b) SHAREHOLDER APPROVAL. The Board, in its discretion, may submit any other amendment to the Plan for shareholder approval, including, but not limited to, amendments to the Plan intended to satisfy the requirements of Section 162(m) of the Code and the regulations thereunder regarding the exclusion of performance-based compensation from the limit on corporate deductibility of compensation paid to Covered Employees.
(c) CONTEMPLATED AMENDMENTS. It is expressly contemplated that the Board may amend the Plan in any respect the Board deems necessary or advisable to provide eligible Employees with the maximum benefits provided or to be provided under the provisions of the Code and the regulations promulgated thereunder relating to Incentive Stock Options and/or to bring the Plan and/or Incentive Stock Options granted under it into compliance therewith.
(d) NO IMPAIRMENT OF RIGHTS. Rights under any Stock Award granted before
amendment of the Plan shall not be impaired by any amendment of the Plan unless
(i) the Company requests the consent of the Participant and (ii) the Participant
consents in writing.
(e) AMENDMENT OF STOCK AWARDS. The Board at any time, and from time to
time, may amend the terms of any one or more Stock Awards, including, but not
limited to, amendments to provide terms more favorable than previously provided
in the agreement evidencing a Stock Award, subject to any specified limits in
the Plan that are not subject to Board discretion; provided, however, that the
rights under any Stock Award shall not be impaired by any such amendment unless
(i) the Company requests the consent of the Participant and (ii) the Participant
consents in writing.
14. TERMINATION OR SUSPENSION OF THE PLAN.
(a) PLAN TERM. The Board may suspend or terminate the Plan at any time.
Unless sooner terminated, the Plan shall terminate on the day before the tenth
(10th) anniversary of the date the Plan is adopted by the Board or approved by
the shareholders of the Company, whichever is earlier. No Stock Awards may be
granted under the Plan while the Plan is suspended or after it is terminated.
(b) NO IMPAIRMENT OF RIGHTS. Suspension or termination of the Plan shall not impair rights and obligations under any Stock Award granted while the Plan is in effect except with the written consent of the Participant.
15. EFFECTIVE DATE OF PLAN.
The Plan shall become effective immediately upon the date on which membership units of American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., a California limited liability company, are contributed to the Company, but no Stock Award shall be exercised (or, in the case of Restricted Stock Awards, shall be granted) unless and until the Plan has been approved by the shareholders of the Company, which approval shall be within twelve (12) months before or after the date the Plan is adopted by the Board.
16. CHOICE OF LAW.
The law of the State of California shall govern all questions concerning the construction, validity and interpretation of this Plan, without regard to such state's conflict of laws rules.
Exhibit 10.18
TERMINATION AGREEMENT
This Termination Agreement ("Agreement") is entered into as of November 29, 2004 by and among American Reprographics Company, L.L.C., a California limited liability company ("Company"), American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., a California limited liability company ("Holdings") and CHS Management IV, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership ("CHS").
RECITALS
A. On April 10, 2000, Company and CHS entered into an agreement that set forth the terms pursuant to which CHS would provide certain management services for Company and its subsidiaries and affiliates, including, without limitation, consultation regarding the business and operations of Company, locating investment opportunities for Company and other management services reasonably requested by Company ("Management Agreement").
B. American Reprographics Company, a Delaware corporation, is a newly formed corporation ("Newco"). In connection with the underwritten public offering of Newco's common stock (the "IPO"), each holder of Holdings' common units prior to the IPO shall exchange their outstanding Holdings common units for an equal number of shares of Newco's common stock.
C. Company, Holdings and CHS desire to terminate the Management Agreement and any and all other agreements between CHS and Company or Holdings pursuant to which CHS has contracted to provide management services or financial advisory services to Company or Holdings on the terms set forth herein.
NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:
AGREEMENT
1. Termination of Management Agreement. The Management Agreement and any and all other agreements between CHS and Company or Holdings pursuant to which CHS has contracted to provide management services or financial advisory services to Company or Holdings are hereby terminated effective upon the closing date of the IPO ("Closing Date"). Beginning on the Closing Date, each of CHS, Company and Holdings shall have no further rights or obligations under the Management Agreement or under any and all other agreements between CHS and Company or Holdings pursuant to which CHS has contracted to provide management services or financial advisory services to Company or Holdings; provided however, that: (i) the fees payable by Company to CHS under the Management Agreement (the "Management Fee") shall be prorated through the Closing Date; (ii) Company's obligation under the Management Agreement to pay to CHS the Management Fee for the period prior to the Closing Date shall survive such termination; and (iii) Company's obligation under the Management Agreement to reimburse CHS for expenses incurred by CHS for the period prior to the Closing Date shall survive such termination.
2. Entire Agreement; Amendment. This Termination Agreement constitutes the entire agreement between Company and CHS pertaining to the subject matter contained herein, and supersedes all prior and contemporaneous agreements, representations and undertakings of the parties. No supplement, modification or amendment of this Termination Agreement shall be binding unless executed in writing by all the parties.
3. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed and enforced in accordance with, the laws of the State of California without regard to its conflict of law rules and principles.
4. Counterparts. This Termination Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which taken together shall constitute the same agreement.
5. Deadline. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, if the Closing Date does not occur before April 1, 2005, then this Agreement shall automatically terminate (and shall be null and void) in its entirety.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties execute this Agreement as of the date first above written.
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY, L.L.C.
a California limited liability company
By: /s/ Mark Legg --------------------------------------- Printed Name: Mark Legg -------------------------------- Title: CFO -------------------------------------- |
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS, L.L.C.
a California limited liability company
By: /s/ Mark Legg --------------------------------------- Printed Name: Mark Legg -------------------------------- Title: CFO -------------------------------------- |
CHS MANAGEMENT IV, L.P.
a Delaware limited partnership
By: Code Hennessy & Simmons, L.L.C.
By: /s/ Thomas Formolo --------------------------------------- Printed Name: Thomas Formolo ------------------------------- Title: Partner -------------------------------------- |
Exhibit 10.25
TERMINATION AGREEMENT OF
INVESTOR UNITHOLDERS AGREEMENT
This Termination Agreement of Investor Unitholders Agreement ("Termination Agreement") is dated for reference purposes November 29, 2004, and is entered into by and among (i) American Reprographics Holdings, L.L.C., a California limited liability company ("Holdings"), (ii) ARC Acquisition Co., L.L.C., a Delaware limited liability company ("Acquisition Co."), and (iii) GS Mezzanine Partner II, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership ("GS Mezzanine"), GS Mezzanine Partners II Offshore, L.P., a Cayman Islands exempted limited partnership ("GS Offshore"), Stone Street Fund 2000, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership ("Stone Street") and Bridge Street Special Opportunities Fund 2000, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership ("Bridge Street") (GS Mezzanine, GS Offshore, Stone Street and Bridge Street are collectively referred to herein as the "GS Parties").
RECITALS
A. Holdings, Acquisition Co., GS Mezzanine and GS Offshore entered into an Investor Unitholders Agreement dated April 10, 2000 ("Unitholders Agreement").
B. Stone Street and Bridge Street became parties to the Unitholders Agreement when GS Mezzanine and GS Offshore assigned rights under the Unitholders Agreement to Stone Street and Bridge Street.
C. American Reprographics Company, a Delaware corporation, is a newly formed corporation ("Newco"). In connection with the underwritten public offering of Newco's common stock (the "IPO"), each holder of Holdings' common units prior to the IPO shall exchange their outstanding Holdings common units for an equal number of shares of Newco's common stock.
D. Holdings, Acquisition Co. and the GS Parties desire to mutually agree upon the termination of the Unitholders Agreement, to be effective upon the closing date of the IPO.
NOW, THEREFORE, for good and valuable consideration, the sufficiency of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto agree as follows:
AGREEMENT
1. Termination of Unitholders Agreement. The Unitholders Agreement is hereby terminated effective as of the closing date of the IPO ("Closing Date"). Beginning on the Closing Date, Holdings, Acquisition Co. and the GS Parties each shall have no further rights or obligations under the Unitholders Agreement. Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary herein, if the Closing Date does not occur prior to April 1, 2005, then this Termination Agreement shall have no effect and shall be null and void for all purposes.
2. Entire Agreement; Amendment. This Termination Agreement constitutes the entire agreement between Holdings, Acquisition Co. and the GS Parties pertaining to the subject matter contained herein, and supersedes all prior and contemporaneous agreements, representations and undertakings of the parties. No supplement, modification or amendment of this Termination Agreement shall be binding unless executed in writing by all the parties.
3. Warranty. Each of the GS Parties warrants that it has full power, right and authority to enter into this Termination Amendment without the consent or approval of any other person. Each of the GS Parties further warrants that it has not assigned any of its rights under the Unitholders Agreement to any other person.
4. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed and enforced in accordance with, the laws of the State of California without regard to its conflict of law rules and principles.
5. Counterparts. This Termination Agreement may be executed in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original, but all of which taken together shall constitute the same agreement.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereby agree to each and all of the above provisions.
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS HOLDINGS, L.L.C.
a California limited liability company
By: /s/ Mark Legg ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: Mark Legg ------------------------------------- Title: CFO -------------------------------------------- |
ARC ACQUISITION CO., L.L.C.
a Delaware limited liability company
By: /s/ Thomas Formolo ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: Thomas Formolo ------------------------------------- Title: -------------------------------------------- |
GS MEZZANINE PARTNERS II, L.P.
a Delaware limited partnership
By: GS Mezzanine Advisors II, L.L.C.
its general partner
By: /s/ John E. Bowman ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: John E. Bowman -------------------------------------- Title: Vice President -------------------------------------------- |
GS MEZZANINE PARTNERS II OFFSHORE, L.P.
a Cayman Islands exempted limited partnership
By: GS Mezzanine Advisors II, L.L.C.
its general partner
By: /s/ John E. Bowman ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: John E. Bowman -------------------------------------- Title: Vice President ------------------------------------------- |
STONE STREET FUND 2000, L.P
a Delaware limited partnership
By: Stone Street 2000, L.L.C.
its general partner
By: /s/ John E. Bowman ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: John E. Bowman -------------------------------------- Title: Vice President -------------------------------------------- |
BRIDGE STREET SPECIAL OPPORTUNITIES
FUND 2000, L.P. a Delaware limited partnership
By: Bridge Street Special Opportunities
2000, L.L.C. its general partner
By: /s/ John E. Bowman ---------------------------------------------- Printed Name: John E. Bowman -------------------------------------- Title: Vice President -------------------------------------------- |
EXHBIT 10.27
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY
2005 STOCK PLAN
FORM OF RESTRICTED STOCK BONUS AWARD AGREEMENT
Pursuant to the Restricted Stock Bonus Award Grant Notice ("Grant Notice") and this Restricted Stock Bonus Award Agreement (collectively, the "Award") and in consideration of your past services, American Reprographics Company (the "Company") has awarded you a restricted stock bonus under its 2005 Stock Plan (the "Plan") for the number of shares of the Company's Common Stock subject to the Award as indicated in the Grant Notice. Defined terms not explicitly defined in this Restricted Stock Bonus Award Agreement but defined in the Plan shall have the same definitions as in the Plan.
The details of your Award are as follows:
1. VESTING. Subject to the limitations contained herein, your Award will vest as provided in the Grant Notice, provided that vesting will cease upon the termination of your Continuous Service.
2. NUMBER OF SHARES. The number of shares subject to your Award may be adjusted from time to time for Capitalization Adjustments, as provided in the Plan.
3. SECURITIES LAW COMPLIANCE. You may not be issued any shares under your Award unless the shares are either (i) then registered under the Securities Act or (ii) the Company has determined that such issuance would be exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Your Award must also comply with other applicable laws and regulations governing the Award, and you will not receive such shares if the Company determines that such receipt would not be in material compliance with such laws and regulations.
4. RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL. Shares that are received under your Award are subject to any right of first refusal that may be described in the Company's bylaws in effect at such time the Company elects to exercise its right.
5. RIGHT OF REACQUISITION.
(a) To the extent provided in the Company's bylaws, as amended from time to time, the Company shall have the right to reacquire all or any part of the shares received pursuant to your Award (a "Reacquisition Right").
(b) To the extent a Reacquisition Right is not provided in the Company's bylaws, as amended from time to time, the Company shall have a Reacquisition Right as to the shares you received pursuant to your Award that have not as yet vested in accordance with the Vesting Schedule on the Grant Notice ("Unvested Shares") on the following terms and conditions:
(i) The Company shall, simultaneously with termination of your Continuous Service, automatically reacquire for no consideration all of the Unvested Shares,
unless the Company agrees to waive its Reacquisition Right as to some or all of the Unvested Shares. Any such waiver shall be exercised by the Company by written notice to you or your representative (with a copy to the Escrow Holder as defined below) within ninety (90) days after the termination of your Continuous Service, and the Escrow Holder may then release to you the number of Unvested Shares not being reacquired by the Company. If the Company does not waive its Reacquisition Right as to all of the Unvested Shares, then upon such termination of your Continuous Service, the Escrow Holder shall transfer to the Company the number of shares the Company is reacquiring.
(ii) The Company shall have the right to reacquire Unvested shares for no monetary consideration (that is, for $0.00).
(iii) The shares issued under your Award shall be held in escrow pursuant to the terms of the Joint Escrow Instructions attached to the Grant Notice as Attachment IV. You agree to execute two (2) Assignment Separate From Certificate forms (with date and number of shares blank) substantially in the form attached to the Grant Notice as Attachment III and deliver the same, along with the certificate or certificates evidencing the shares, for use by the escrow agent pursuant to the terms of the Joint Escrow Instructions.
(iv) Subject to the provisions of your Award, you shall, during the term of your Award, exercise all rights and privileges of a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares deposited in escrow. You shall be deemed to be the holder of the shares for purposes of receiving any dividends which may be paid with respect to such shares and for purposes of exercising any voting rights relating to such shares, even if some or all of such shares have not yet vested and been released from the Company's Reacquisition Right.
(v) If, from time to time, there is any stock dividend, stock split or other change in the character or amount of any of the outstanding stock of the corporation the stock of which is subject to the provisions of your Award, then in such event any and all new, substituted or additional securities to which you is entitled by reason of your ownership of the shares acquired under your Award shall be immediately subject to the Reacquisition Right with the same force and effect as the shares subject to this Reacquisition Right immediately before such event.
6. RESTRICTIVE LEGENDS. The shares issued under your Award shall be endorsed with appropriate legends determined by the Company.
7. AWARD NOT A SERVICE CONTRACT. Your Award is not an employment or service contract, and nothing in your Award shall be deemed to create in any way whatsoever any obligation on your part to continue in the employ of the Company or an Affiliate, or on the part of the Company or an Affiliate to continue your employment. In addition, nothing in your Award shall obligate the Company or an Affiliate, their respective shareholders, boards of directors, Officers or Employees to continue any relationship that you might have as a Director or Consultant for the Company or an Affiliate.
8. WITHHOLDING OBLIGATIONS.
(a) At the time your Award is made, or at any time thereafter as requested by the Company, you hereby authorize withholding from payroll and any other amounts payable to you, and otherwise agree to make adequate provision for any sums required to satisfy the federal, state, local and foreign tax withholding obligations of the Company or an Affiliate, if any, which arise in connection with your Award.
(b) Unless the tax withholding obligations of the Company and/or any Affiliate are satisfied, the Company shall have no obligation to issue a certificate for such shares or release such shares from any escrow provided for herein.
9. TAX CONSEQUENCES. The acquisition and vesting of the shares may have adverse tax consequences to you that may avoided or mitigated by filing an election under Section 83(b) of the Internal Revenue Code, as amended (the "Code"). Such election must be filed within thirty (30) days after the date of your Award. YOU ACKNOWLEDGE THAT IT IS YOUR OWN RESPONSIBILITY, AND NOT THE COMPANY'S, TO FILE A TIMELY ELECTION UNDER CODE SECTION 83(B), EVEN IF YOU REQUEST THE COMPANY TO MAKE THE FILING ON YOUR BEHALF.
10. NOTICES. Any notices provided for in your Award or the Plan shall be given in writing and shall be deemed effectively given upon receipt or, in the case of notices delivered by the Company to you, five (5) days after deposit in the United States mail, postage prepaid, addressed to you at the last address you provided to the Company.
11. MISCELLANEOUS.
(a) The rights and obligations of the Company under your Award shall be transferable to any one or more persons or entities, and all covenants and agreements hereunder shall inure to the benefit of, and be enforceable by the Company's successors and assigns. Your rights and obligations under your Award may only be assigned with the prior written consent of the Company.
(b) You agree upon request to execute any further documents or instruments necessary or desirable in the sole determination of the Company to carry out the purposes or intent of your Award.
(c) You acknowledge and agree that you have reviewed your Award in its . entirety, have had an opportunity to obtain the advice of counsel prior to executing and accepting your Award and fully understand all provisions of your Award.
12. GOVERNING PLAN DOCUMENT. Your Award is subject to all the provisions of the Plan, the provisions of which are hereby made a part of your Award, and is further subject to all interpretations, amendments, rules and regulations which may from time to time be promulgated and adopted pursuant to the Plan. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of your Award and those of the Plan, the provisions of the Plan shall control.
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY
2005 STOCK PLAN
FORM OF RESTRICTED STOCK PURCHASE AWARD AGREEMENT
American Reprographics Company (the "Company") wishes to sell to you, and you wish to purchase, shares of Common Stock from the Company, pursuant to the provisions of the Company's 2005 Stock Plan (the "Plan").
Therefore, pursuant to the terms of the Restricted Stock Purchase Award Grant Notice ("Grant Notice") and this Restricted Stock Purchase Award Agreement ("Agreement") (collectively, the "Award"), the Company grants you right to purchase the number of shares of Common Stock indicated in the Grant Notice. Defined terms not explicitly defined in this Agreement but defined in the Plan shall have the same definitions as in the Plan.
The details of your Award are as follows:
1. AGREEMENT TO PURCHASE. You hereby agree to purchase from the Company, and the Company hereby agrees to sell to you, the aggregate number of shares of Common Stock specified in your Grant Notice at the specified Purchase Price per Share. You may not purchase less than the aggregate number of shares specified in the Grant Notice.
2. CLOSING. The purchase and sale of the shares shall be consummated as follows:
(a) You may purchase the shares by delivering the Total Purchase Price specified in your Grant Notice to the Secretary of the Company, or to such other person as the Company may designate, during regular business hours, on the Closing Date specified in the Grant Notice (or at such other time and place as you and the Company may mutually agree upon in writing) along with such additional documents as the Company may then require.
(b) You agree to execute two (2) copies of the Assignment Separate From Certificate (with date and number of shares blank) substantially in the form attached to the Grant Notice as Attachment III and to execute Joint Escrow Instructions substantially in the form attached to the Grant Notice as Attachment IV and to deliver the same to the Company on the Closing Date, along with the certificate or certificates evidencing the shares, for use by the Escrow Agent pursuant to the terms of the Joint Escrow Instructions.
3. METHOD OF PAYMENT. You may elect to make payment of the Purchase Price as follows:
(a) In cash or by check.
(b) By delivery of already-owned shares of Common Stock that either have been held for the period required to avoid a charge to the Company's reported earnings (generally six months) or were not acquired, directly or indirectly from the Company, that are
owned free and clear of any liens, claims, encumbrances or security interests, and that are valued at Fair Market Value on the date of exercise as determined by the Company. "Delivery" for these purposes shall include delivery to the Company of your attestation of ownership of such shares of Common Stock in a form approved by the Company. Notwithstanding the foregoing, you may not pay for the shares by tender to the Company of Common Stock to the extent such tender would constitute a violation of the provisions of any law, regulation or agreement restricting the redemption of the Company's stock.
4. VESTING. Subject to the limitations contained herein, the shares you purchase will vest as provided in the Grant Notice, provided that vesting will cease upon the termination of your Continuous Service.
5. NUMBER OF SHARES AND PURCHASE PRICE. The number of shares subject to your Award and your Purchase Price may be adjusted from time to time for Capitalization Adjustments, as provided in the Plan.
6. SECURITIES LAW COMPLIANCE. You will not be issued any shares under your Award unless the shares are either (a) then registered under the Securities Act or (b) the Company has determined that such issuance would be exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Your Award must also comply with other applicable laws and regulations governing the Award, and you will not receive such shares if the Company determines that such receipt would not be in material compliance with such laws and regulations.
7. RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL. Shares that are received under your Award are subject to any right of first refusal that may be described in the Company's bylaws in effect at such time the Company elects to exercise its right.
8. PURCHASE OPTION.
(a) To the extent provided in the Company's bylaws, as amended from time to time, the Company shall have the right to reacquire all or any part of the shares received pursuant to your Award (a "Purchase Option").
(b) To the extent a Purchase Option is not provided in the Company's bylaws, as amended from time to time, the Company shall have a Purchase Option as to the shares you received pursuant to your Award that have not as yet vested in accordance with the Vesting Schedule on the Grant Notice ("Unvested Shares") on the following terms and conditions:
(i) The Company shall, simultaneously with termination of your Continuous Service, automatically reacquire for your original Purchase Price as specified in the Grant Notice all of the Unvested Shares, unless the Company agrees to waive its Purchase Option as to some or all of the Unvested Shares. Any such waiver shall be exercised by the Company by written notice to you or your representative (with a copy to the Escrow Agent) within ninety (90) days after the termination of your Continuous Service, and the Escrow Agent may then release to you the number of Unvested Shares not being reacquired by the Company. If the Company does not waive its Purchase Option as to all of the Unvested Shares, then upon such termination of your Continuous Service, the Escrow Agent shall transfer to the Company the number of shares the Company is reacquiring.
(ii) The Company shall pay for the reacquired Unvested Shares in cash within ninety (90) days after the termination of your Continuous Service.
(iii) The shares issued under your Award shall be held in escrow pursuant to the terms of the Joint Escrow Instructions attached to the Grant Notice as Attachment IV.
(iv) Subject to the provisions of your Award, you shall exercise all rights and privileges of a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares deposited in escrow. You shall be deemed to be the holder of the shares for purposes of receiving any dividends that may be paid with respect to such shares and for purposes of exercising any voting rights relating to such shares, even if some or all of such shares have not yet vested and been released from the Company's Purchase Option.
(v) If, from time to time, there is any stock dividend, stock split or other change in the character or amount of any of the outstanding stock of the corporation the stock of which is subject to the provisions of your Award, then in such event any and all new, substituted or additional securities to which you are entitled by reason of your ownership of the shares acquired under your Award shall be immediately subject to the Purchase Option with the same force and effect as the shares subject to this Purchase Option immediately before such event.
9. RESTRICTIVE LEGENDS. The shares issued under your Award shall be endorsed with appropriate legends determined by the Company.
10. AWARD NOT A SERVICE CONTRACT. Your Award is not an employment or service contract, and nothing in your Award shall be deemed to create in any way whatsoever any obligation on your part to continue in the employ of the Company or an Affiliate, or on the part of the Company or an Affiliate to continue your employment. In addition, nothing in your Award shall obligate the Company or an Affiliate, their respective shareholders, boards of directors, Officers or Employees to continue any relationship that you might have as a Director or Consultant for the Company or an Affiliate.
11. WITHHOLDING OBLIGATIONS.
(a) At the time your Award is made, or at any time thereafter as requested by the Company, you hereby authorize withholding from payroll and any other amounts payable to you, and otherwise agree to make adequate provision for any sums required to satisfy the federal, state, local and foreign tax withholding obligations of the Company or an Affiliate, if any, which arise in connection with your Award.
(b) Unless the tax withholding obligations of the Company and/or any Affiliate are satisfied, the Company shall have no obligation to issue a certificate for such shares or release such shares from any escrow provided for herein.
12. TAX CONSEQUENCES. The acquisition and vesting of the shares may have adverse tax consequences to you that may avoided or mitigated by filing an election under Section 83(b) of the Code. Such election must be filed within thirty (30) days after the date your
purchase the shares pursuant to your Award. YOU ACKNOWLEDGE THAT IT IS YOUR OWN
RESPONSIBILITY, AND NOT THE COMPANY'S, TO FILE A TIMELY ELECTION UNDER CODE
SECTION 83(B), EVEN IF YOU REQUEST THE COMPANY TO MAKE THE FILING ON YOUR
BEHALF.
13. NOTICES. Any notices provided for in your Award or the Plan shall be given in writing and shall be deemed effectively given upon receipt or, in the case of notices delivered by the Company to you, five (5) days after deposit in the United States mail, postage prepaid, addressed to you at the last address you provided to the Company.
14. MISCELLANEOUS.
(a) The rights and obligations of the Company under your Award shall be transferable to any one or more persons or entities, and all covenants and agreements hereunder shall inure to the benefit of, and be enforceable by the Company's successors and assigns. Your rights and obligations under your Award may only be assigned with the prior written consent of the Company.
(b) You agree upon request to execute any further documents or instruments necessary or desirable in the sole determination of the Company to carry out the purposes or intent of your Award.
(c) You acknowledge and agree that you have reviewed your Award in its entirety, have had an opportunity to obtain the advice of counsel prior to executing and accepting your Award and fully understand all provisions of your Award.
15. GOVERNING PLAN DOCUMENT. Your Award is subject to all the provisions of the Plan, the provisions of which are hereby made a part of your Award, and is further subject to all interpretations, amendments, rules and regulations which may from time to time be promulgated and adopted pursuant to the Plan. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of your Award and those of the Plan, the provisions of the Plan shall control.
EXHIBIT 10.28
AMERICAN REPROGRAPHICS COMPANY
2005 STOCK PLAN
FORM OF RESTRICTED STOCK UNIT AWARD AGREEMENT
Pursuant to the Restricted Stock Unit Award Grant Notice (the "Grant Notice") and this Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (collectively, the "Award"), American Reprographics Company (the "Company") hereby awards you stock units under its 2005 Stock Plan (the "Plan") representing the number of shares of the Company's Common Stock as indicated in the Grant Notice. Defined terms not explicitly defined in this Agreement but defined in the Plan shall have the same definitions as in the Plan.
The details of your award are as follows:
1. VESTING. Subject to the limitations contained herein, your Award will vest as provided in the Grant Notice, provided that vesting will cease upon the termination of your Continuous Service. Any unvested portion of your Award will be forfeited upon termination of your Continuous Service.
2. NUMBER OF SHARES. The number of shares subject to your Award may be adjusted from time to time for Capitalization Adjustments, as provided in the Plan. In addition, your Award will be credited with Dividend Equivalents on stock units under your Award to the extent of dividends issued on Common Stock, provided the record date for such dividend is on or after the end of the quarter in which occurs the Award's grant date. Dividend Equivalent credits shall be deemed reinvested in additional shares of stock units (or fraction thereof) and shall be added to the number of stock units subject to your Award. Any such additional stock units (or fraction thereof) resulting from Dividend Equivalent credits shall be treated the same as other stock units under your Award and shall be subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement and the Plan. For purposes of this Agreement, "Dividend Equivalent" means a credit to your Award, based on the number of stock units subject to the Award, equivalent to the cash, stock or other property dividends paid on shares of Common Stock.
3. SECURITIES LAW COMPLIANCE. You may not be issued any shares under your Award unless the shares are either (i) then registered under the Securities Act or (ii) the Company has determined that such issuance would be exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act. Your Award must also comply with other applicable laws and regulations governing the Award, and you will not receive such shares if the Company determines that such receipt would not be in material compliance with such laws and regulations.
4. PAYMENT. Payment of your Award shall be made in either cash, or in shares of Common Stock with any fractional shares to be distributed in cash in whole shares of Common Stock, as determined by the Board or Committee in its sole discretion. Payment of each stock unit under your Award will be made upon vesting of that unit at the following times:
(a) Within 30 days after the end of the calendar quarter in which the stock unit becomes vested, as a lump sum payment.
(b) Commencing as of January 1 of the calendar year following the year in which the stock unit becomes vested (or as soon as reasonably practicable thereafter), in annual installments not exceeding five. If stock units are paid in shares of Common Stock, the amount of shares paid in each installment shall be determined by dividing your total remaining stock units by the remaining number of installments to be paid, such that the divisor shall be reduced by one in each subsequent year. Fractional shares shall be rounded down to the nearest whole number, except that in the final year in which an installment is to be paid, any fractional shares shall be distributed in cash.
5. RIGHTS AND RESTRICTIONS OF PARTICIPANT. You will have no rights as a shareholder with respect to any stock unit unless and until you become the holder of record of shares of Common Stock following payment of that stock unit in Common Stock.
6. TRANSFERABILITY. Your Award is not transferable, except by will or by the laws of descent and distribution, and is exercisable during your life only by you. Notwithstanding the foregoing, by delivering written notice to the Company, in a form satisfactory to the Company, you may designate a third party who, in the event of your death, shall thereafter be entitled to receive any amounts owed with respect to vested stock units under your Award.
7. WITHHOLDING OBLIGATIONS.
(a) At the time your Award is made, or at any time thereafter as requested by the Company, you hereby authorize withholding from payroll and any other amounts payable to you, and otherwise agree to make adequate provision for any sums required to satisfy the federal, state, local and foreign tax withholding obligations of the Company or an Affiliate, if any, which arise in connection with your Award.
(b) Unless the tax withholding obligations of the Company and/or any Affiliate are satisfied, the Company shall have no obligation to issue a certificate for such shares or release such shares from any escrow provided for herein.
8. AGREEMENT NOT A SERVICE CONTRACT. Your Award is not an employment or service contract, and nothing in your Award shall be deemed to create in any way whatsoever any obligation on your part to continue in the employ of the Company or an Affiliate, or on the part of the Company or an Affiliate to continue your employment. In addition, nothing in your Award shall obligate the Company or an Affiliate, their respective shareholders, boards of directors, Officers or Employees to continue any relationship that you might have as a Director or Consultant for the Company or an Affiliate.
9. NOTICES. Any notices provided for in your Award or the Plan shall be given in writing and shall be deemed effectively given upon receipt or, in the case of notices delivered by the Company to you, five (5) days after deposit in the United States mail, postage prepaid, addressed to you at the last address you provided to the Company.
10. MISCELLANEOUS.
(a) The rights and obligations of the Company under your Award shall be transferable to any one or more persons or entities, and all covenants and agreements hereunder shall inure to the benefit of, and be enforceable by the Company's successors and assigns. Your rights and obligations under your Award may only be assigned with the prior written consent of the Company.
(b) You agree upon request to execute any further documents or instruments necessary or desirable in the sole determination of the Company to carry out the purposes or intent of your Award.
(c) You acknowledge and agree that you have reviewed your Award in its . entirety, have had an opportunity to obtain the advice of counsel prior to executing and accepting your Award and fully understand all provisions of your Award.
11. GOVERNING PLAN DOCUMENT. Your Award is subject to all the provisions of the Plan, the provisions of which are hereby made a part of your Award, and is further subject to all interpretations, amendments, rules and regulations which may from time to time be promulgated and adopted pursuant to the Plan. In the event of any conflict between the provisions of your Award and those of the Plan, the provisions of the Plan shall control.
Exhibit 23.1
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC
ACCOUNTING FIRM
We hereby consent to the use in this Registration
Statement on Form S-1/ A of our report dated
February 25, 2004, relating to the consolidated financial
statements and financial statement schedule of American
Reprographics Holdings, LLC, which appears in such Registration
Statement. We also consent to the reference to us under the
heading Experts in such Registration Statement.
/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Los Angeles, California
Exhibit 23.2
CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC
ACCOUNTING FIRM
We consent to the reference to our firm under the
caption Experts and to the use of our report dated
February 28, 2003, with respect to the consolidated
financial statements and schedule of American Reprographics
Holdings, L.L.C. included in Amendment No. 1 to the
Registration Statement (Form S-1 No. 333-119788) and
related Prospectus of American Reprographics Company dated
December 3, 2004.
Woodland Hills, California
/s/ Ernst & Young LLP